| 	
		 AREA CODE CHANGE   
					Please note that the area code for   
					Paradyne Corporation in Largo, Florida   
					has changed from 813 to 727.   
					For any Paradyne telephone number that   
					appears in this manual with an 813 area   
					code, dial 727 instead.   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					ACCULINK   
					316x Data Service Unit/Channel Service Unit   
					Operator’s Guide   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					6th Edition (January 1997)   
					Changes and enhancements to the product and to the information herein will be documented and issued as a new release.   
					Standalone   
					FCC Registration number:   
					See label on unit   
					Ringer Equivalence number (REN): See label on unit   
					Canadian Certification number:   
					Canadian DOC Load number:   
					See label on unit   
					See label on unit   
					Carrier Card   
					FCC Registration number:   
					See label on unit   
					Ringer Equivalence number (REN): See label on unit   
					Canadian Certification number:   
					Canadian DOC Load number:   
					See label on unit   
					See label on unit   
					Warranty, Sales, and Service Information   
					Contact your sales or service representative directly for any help needed. For additional information concerning warranty,   
					sales, service, repair, installation, documentation, or training, use one of the following methods:   
					• Via the Internet: Visit the Paradyne World Wide Web site at http://www.paradyne.com   
					• Via Telephone: Call our automated call system to receive current information via fax or to speak with a company   
					representative.   
					— Within the U.S.A., call 1-800-870-2221   
					— International, call 813-530-2340   
					Trademarks   
					All products and services mentioned herein are the trademarks, service marks, registered trademarks or registered service   
					marks of their respective owners.   
					Printed on recycled paper   
					COPYRIGHT E 1997 Paradyne Corporation. All rights reserved.   
					This publication is protected by federal copyright law. No part of this publication may be copied or distributed, transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system,   
					ortranslatedintoanyhumanorcomputerlanguageinanyformorbyanymeans, electronic, mechanical, magnetic, manualorotherwise, ordisclosedtothirdparties   
					without the express written permission of Paradyne Corporation, 8545 126th Avenue North, P.O. Box 2826, Largo, Florida 33779-2826.   
					ParadyneCorporationmakesnorepresentationorwarrantieswithrespecttothecontentshereofandspecificallydisclaimsanyimpliedwarrantiesofmerchantability   
					or fitness for a particular purpose. Further, Paradyne Corporation reserves the right to revise this publication and to make changes from time to time in the contents   
					hereof without obligation of Paradyne Corporation to notify any person of such revision or changes.   
					A 
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Important Instructions   
					Important Safety Instructions   
					1. Read and follow all warning notices and instructions marked on the product or included in the   
					manual.   
					2. When an ac power source is used, this product is intended to be used with a three-wire   
					grounding type plug – a plug which has a grounding pin. This is a safety feature. Equipment   
					grounding is vital to ensure safe operation. Do not defeat the purpose of the grounding type   
					plug by modifying the plug or using an adapter.   
					Prior to installation, use an outlet tester or a voltmeter to check the ac receptacle for the   
					presence of earth ground. If the receptacle is not properly grounded, the installation must not   
					continue until a qualified electrician has corrected the problem.   
					If a three-wire grounding type power source is not available, consult a qualified electrician to   
					determine another method of grounding the equipment.   
					3. Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation. To ensure reliable operation of   
					the product and to protect it from overheating, these slots and openings must not be blocked   
					or covered.   
					4. Do not allow anything to rest on the power cord and do not locate the product where persons   
					will walk on the power cord.   
					5. Do not attempt to service this product yourself, as opening or removing covers may expose   
					you to dangerous high voltage points or other risks. Refer all servicing to qualified service   
					personnel.   
					6. General purpose cables may be provided with this product. Special cables, which may be   
					required by the regulatory inspection authority for the installation site, are the responsibility   
					of the customer.   
					7. When installed in the final configuration, the product must comply with the applicable Safety   
					Standards and regulatory requirements of the country in which it is installed. If necessary,   
					consult with the appropriate regulatory agencies and inspection authorities to ensure   
					compliance.   
					8. A rare phenomenon can create a voltage potential between the earth grounds of two or more   
					buildings. If products installed in separate buildings are interconnected, the voltage potential   
					may cause a hazardous condition. Consult a qualified electrical consultant to determine   
					whether or not this phenomenon exists and, if necessary, implement corrective action prior to   
					interconnecting the products.   
					9. Input power to the ac voltage configuration of this product must be provided by a UL-listed or   
					CSA-certified power source with a Class 2 or Limited Power Source (LPS) output. Input   
					power to the dc voltage configurations of this product must be provided by a National Electric   
					Code (NEC) or a Canadian Electric Code (CEC) Class 2 circuit.   
					10. This product contains a coin cell lithium battery that is only to be replaced at the factory.   
					Caution: There is a danger of explosion if the battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace only   
					with the same type. Dispose of used batteries according to the battery manufacturer’s   
					instructions. Attention: Il y a danger d’explosion s’il y a remplacement incorrect de la   
					batterie. Remplacer uniquement avec une batterie du même type. Mettre au rebut les batteries   
					usagées conformément aux instructions du fabricant.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					B 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					11. In addition, if the equipment is to be used with telecommunications circuits, take the   
					following precautions:   
					– Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.   
					– Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically designed for   
					wet locations.   
					– Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been   
					disconnected at the network interface.   
					– Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.   
					– Avoid using a telephone (other than a cordless type) during an electrical storm. There may   
					be a remote risk of electric shock from lightning.   
					– Do not use the telephone to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak.   
					Notices   
					WARNING   
					THIS EQUIPMENT HAS BEEN TESTED AND FOUND TO COMPLY WITH THE LIMITS FOR A CLASS A DIGITAL DEVICE,   
					PURSUANT TO PART 15 OF THE FCC RULES. THESE LIMITS ARE DESIGNED TO PROVIDE REASONABLE   
					PROTECTION AGAINST HARMFUL INTERFERENCE WHEN THE EQUIPMENT IS OPERATED IN A COMMERCIAL   
					ENVIRONMENT. THIS EQUIPMENT GENERATES, USES, AND CAN RADIATE RADIO FREQUENCY ENERGY AND, IF   
					NOT INSTALLED AND USED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE INSTRUCTION MANUAL, MAY CAUSE HARMFUL   
					INTERFERENCE TO RADIO COMMUNICATIONS. OPERATION OF THIS EQUIPMENT IN A RESIDENTIAL AREA IS   
					LIKELY TO CAUSE HARMFUL INTERFERENCE IN WHICH CASE THE USER WILL BE REQUIRED TO CORRECT THE   
					INTERFERENCE AT HIS OWN EXPENSE.   
					THE AUTHORITY TO OPERATE THIS EQUIPMENT IS CONDITIONED BY THE REQUIREMENTS THAT NO   
					MODIFICATIONS WILL BE MADE TO THE EQUIPMENT UNLESS THE CHANGES OR MODIFICATIONS ARE EXPRESSLY   
					APPROVED BY PARADYNE.   
					WARNING   
					TO USERS OF DIGITAL APPARATUS IN CANADA:   
					THIS CLASS A DIGITAL APPARATUS MEETS ALL REQUIREMENTS OF THE CANADIAN INTERFERENCE-CAUSING   
					EQUIPMENT REGULATIONS.   
					CET APPAREIL NUMÉRIQUE DE LA CLASSE A RESPECTE TOUTES LES EXIGENCES DU RÉGLEMENT SUR LE   
					MATÉRIEL BROUILLEUR DU CANADA.   
					C 
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Important Instructions   
					Government Requirements and Equipment Return   
					Certain governments require that instructions pertaining to CSU and modem connection to the   
					telephone network be included in the installation and operation manual. Specific instructions are   
					listed in the following sections.   
					United States   
					NOTICE TO USERS OF THE UNITED STATES TELEPHONE NETWORK   
					1. This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules. On the equipment is a label that   
					contains, among other information, the FCC registration number and ringer equivalence   
					number (REN) for this equipment. The label is located on the bottom of the 3150 CSU, and   
					on the 3151 CSU’s circuit card. If requested, this information must be provided to the   
					telephone company.   
					2. There are two types of telephone lines associated with the standalone equipment. The T1   
					network connection should be made using a Universal Service Order Code (USOC) type   
					RJ48C jack. The Service Order Code 6.0F should be specified to the telephone company   
					when ordering the T1 line. In addition, the proper Facility Interface Code must be specified   
					to the Telephone Company. The CSU can be configured to support any of the following   
					framing format and line signaling techniques. The CSU’s configuration must correspond to   
					the T1 line’s parameters. The 3150 CSU’s internal modem connects to the Public Switched   
					Telephone Network using a USOC Type RJ11C jack. The Facility Interface Code 02LS2   
					along with the RJ11C jack should be specified to the telephone company when ordering a   
					dial line for the modem. The 3151 CSU connects to the T1 network using the multi-line   
					USOC-type RJ48H jack and does not have a PSTN interface.   
					315x CSU Facility Interface Codes   
					Code   
					04DU9-BN   
					04DU9-DN   
					04DU9-1KN   
					04DU-1SN   
					Description   
					1.544 Mbps superframe format (SF) without line power   
					1.544 Mbps SF and B8ZS without line power   
					1.544 Mbps ANSI ESF without line power   
					1.544 Mbps ANSI ESF and B8ZS without line power   
					3. The ringer equivalence number (REN) is used to determine the quantity of devices which   
					may be connected to the telephone line. Excessive RENs on the telephone line may result   
					in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call. In most, but not all areas, the   
					sum of the RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that   
					may be connected to the line, as determined by the total RENs, contact the telephone   
					company to determine the maximum RENs for the calling area.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					D 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. If the 315x CSU causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify   
					you in advance that temporary discontinuance of service may be required. But if advance   
					notice is not practical, the telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible.   
					Also, you will be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you believe it is   
					necessary.   
					5. The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations, or   
					procedures that could affect the operation of the equipment. If this happens, the telephone   
					company will provide advance notice in order for you to make the necessary modifications   
					in order to maintain uninterrupted service.   
					6. If you experience trouble with this equipment, please contact your sales or service   
					representative (as appropriate) for repair or warranty information. If the product needs to   
					be returned to the company service center for repair, contact them directly for return   
					instructions using one of the following methods:   
					• 
					• 
					Via the Internet: Visit the Paradyne World Wide Web site at http://www.paradyne.com   
					Via Telephone: Call our automated call system to receive current information via fax or   
					to speak with a company representative.   
					— Within the U.S.A., call 1-800-870-2221   
					— International, call 813-530-2340   
					If the trouble is causing harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may   
					request that you remove the equipment from the network until the problem is resolved.   
					7. The equipment’s modem cannot be used on public coin service provided by the telephone   
					company. Connection to Party Line Service is subject to state tariffs. (Contact the state   
					public utility commission, public service commission or corporation commission for   
					information.)   
					8. FCC compliant telephone line cords with modular plugs are provided with this equipment.   
					This equipment is designed to be connected to the telephone network or premises wiring   
					using a compatible modular jack which is Part 68 compliant.   
					Canada   
					NOTICE TO USERS OF THE CANADIAN TELEPHONE NETWORK   
					The Canadian Department of Communications label identifies certified equipment. This   
					certification means that the equipment meets certain telecommunications network protective,   
					operational and safety requirements. The Department does not guarantee the equipment will   
					operate to the user’s satisfaction.   
					Before installing this equipment, users should ensure that it is permissible to be connected to the   
					facilities of the local telecommunications company. The equipment must also be installed using an   
					acceptable method of connection. In some cases, the company’s inside wiring associated with a   
					single line individual service may be extended by means of a certified connector assembly   
					(telephone extension cord). The customer should be aware that compliance with the above   
					conditions may not prevent degradation of service in some situations.   
					E 
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Important Instructions   
					Repairs to certified equipment should be made by an authorized Canadian maintenance facility   
					designated by the supplier. Any repairs or alterations made by the user to this equipment, or   
					equipment malfunctions, may give the telecommunications company cause to request to disconnect   
					the equipment.   
					CAUTION   
					Users should not attempt to make such connections themselves, but   
					should contact the appropriate electric inspection authority, or   
					electrician, as appropriate.   
					If your equipment is in need of repair, return it using the procedures described on page A in the   
					front of this document.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					F 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					G 
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Table of Contents   
					
					
					Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii   
					Reference Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii   
					
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1   
					Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1   
					Physical Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3   
					
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1   
					Application Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1   
					
					Important Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5   
					Optional Power Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5   
					Cabling Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8   
					Power-Up Self-Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9   
					
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2   
					Using the Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2   
					Displaying Unit Identity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8   
					Setting Customer Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9   
					
					Displaying LED Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10   
					
					
					Configuring SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19   
					Configuring DS0 Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21   
					Providing Backup Capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31   
					Selecting the Timing Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32   
					
					Setting a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					Resetting the DSU/CSU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43   
					Download Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					i 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1   
					Self-Test Health . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2   
					Device Health and Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3   
					Performance Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5   
					Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9   
					SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10   
					Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11   
					Test Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13   
					Test Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15   
					Remote Loopback Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15   
					Local Loopback Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17   
					Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22   
					Lamp Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25   
					
					Appendices   
					
					
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. A.Ć1 .   
					.BĆ1.   
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					
					
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. CĆ.1 .   
					. DĆ.1 .   
					.EĆ.1 .   
					. F.Ć1 .   
					.GĆ1.   
					H. Ć1.   
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					
					
					
					
					
					
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					
					
					
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. I.Ć1 .   
					. 
					. 
					. 
					. 
					
					
					ii   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Preface   
					Objectives and Reader   
					Assumptions   
					This operator’s guide contains installation, operation,   
					and maintenance information for the ACCULINK 3160,   
					3161, 3164, or 3165 Data Service Unit (DSU)/Channel   
					Service Unit (CSU).   
					Reference Documents   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					AT&T Technical Reference 54016   
					AT&T Technical Reference 62411   
					ANSI T1.403-1989   
					Industry Canada CS-03   
					CSA-22.2 No. 950   
					It is assumed that you are familiar with the operation of   
					digital data communication equipment. You should also   
					be familiar with Simple Network Management Protocol   
					(SNMP) if you want your DSU/CSU to be managed by an   
					SNMP manager.   
					Industry Canada (ICES)-003   
					FCC Part 15   
					FCC Part 68   
					UL 1950   
					Related Documents   
					Management Information Base for Network   
					Management of TCP/IP-Based Internets: MIBII.   
					RFC 1213, March 1991   
					3000-A2-GA31   
					COMSPHERE 3000 Series   
					Carrier Installation Manual   
					3000-A2-GB41   
					COMSPHERE –48 VDC   
					Central Office Power Unit   
					Installation Guide   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Definitions of Managed Objects for the DS1 and E1   
					Interface Types. RFC 1406, January 1993   
					Definitions of Managed Objects for RS-232-like   
					Hardware Devices. RFC 1317, April 1992   
					3100-A2-GK40   
					3162-A2-GB20   
					ACCULINK 3151 CSU and   
					3161 DSU/CSU General   
					Information Guide   
					Extensions to the Generic-Interface MIB.   
					RFC 1229, May 1991   
					ACCULINK 3162 Data Service   
					Unit/Channel Service Unit   
					User’s Guide   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					iii   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					iv   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Introduction   
					1 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1   
					Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					Alarm Message Capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					Front Panel Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					Integral Modem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					Async Terminal Interface Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					Telnet Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					SNMP Management Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2   
					Physical Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3   
					Standalone DSU/CSU Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3   
					Standalone DSU/CSU Rear Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5   
					Overview   
					Features   
					The DSU/CSU acts as an interface between the T1   
					digital network and the customer premises equipment,   
					converting signals received from the DTE (Data Terminal   
					Equipment) to bipolar signals that can be transmitted over   
					T1 lines. Typical applications include shared access to   
					network-based services, Local Area Network (LAN)/Wide   
					Area Network (WAN) interconnection, and fractional T1   
					network applications.   
					The DSU/CSU optimizes network performance with a   
					wide range of features such as the following:   
					• 
					Software configuration menu displayed via a liquid   
					crystal display (LCD) to permit quick and easy   
					operation, and elimination of complicated hardware   
					strapping.   
					• 
					• 
					Local or remote configuration and operation   
					flexibility.   
					In addition to the T1 network interface and the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, the Model 3160 provides   
					two synchronous data ports while the Model 3164   
					provides four synchronous data ports. The Model 3165   
					provides one synchronous data port, but does not provide   
					the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Several loopback capabilities and test pattern   
					generators.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) capability.   
					Alarm message display/print capability.   
					The Model 3161 (carrier-mounted DSU/CSU) provides   
					two ports in addition to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface and is designed to fit into the COMSPHERE   
					3000 Series Carrier.   
					Front panel emulation via Windows-based Front   
					Panel Emulation software.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Integral modem for standalone DSU/CSUs.   
					For more information about the carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSU, refer to the ACCULINK 3151 CSU and 3161   
					DSU/CSU General Information Guide and the   
					Asynchronous (async) terminal interface support.   
					Telnet access for remote async terminal operations.   
					COMSPHERE 3000 Series Carrier Installation Manual.   
					Network management provided through   
					industry-standard Simple Network Management   
					Protocol (SNMP).   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					1-1   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface   
					Telnet Access   
					The DTE Drop/Insert interface allows DTEs/PBXs that   
					support the DS1 signal format to share the T1 network   
					with other high-speed equipment. This is available on   
					2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					Remote async terminal operations can be performed   
					using Telnet access. Telnet is a Transmission Control   
					Protocol/Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) service that supports   
					a virtual terminal interface.   
					Alarm Message Capability   
					SNMP Management Support   
					The DSU/CSU can be attached, either locally or   
					remotely, to an ASCII terminal or printer to display or   
					print alarm messages. Alarms can also be displayed on a   
					PC that is using a terminal emulation package.   
					SNMP is a network management protocol that is used   
					to monitor network performance and status, and to report   
					alarms (i.e., traps). To function, SNMP requires a manager   
					consisting of a software program housed within a   
					workstation or PC; an agent consisting of a software   
					program housed within a device (e.g., the DSU/CSU); and   
					a Management Information Base (MIB) consisting of a   
					database of managed objects. The DSU/CSU can be   
					managed by any industry-standard SNMP manager.   
					Front Panel Emulation   
					The DSU/CSU offers functionality through Front Panel   
					Emulation software that is similar to that provided by the   
					DSU/CSU front panel. The functionality of the front panel   
					is available by clicking on the function keys with the   
					mouse rather than by pressing keys from the actual front   
					panel.   
					Two link layer protocols, Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP)   
					and Serial Line Internet Protocol (SLIP), are supported for   
					connection to an external SNMP manager or network   
					device (e.g., a router).   
					The SNMP manager or network device can be directly   
					connected to the communications (COM) port. An   
					external LAN Adapter can be connected to either the   
					COM port or the auxiliary (AUX) port to provide Ethernet   
					connectivity. Also, the DSU/CSU can be daisy chained   
					together by connecting the COM port of one device to the   
					AUX port of the other, providing SNMP connectivity.   
					Integral Modem   
					The standalone DSU/CSUs contain an integral   
					low-speed (2400 bps), V.22bis dial modem that enables   
					communication with remote devices such as another 316x   
					DSU/CSU, an ASCII terminal or printer, or a PC running   
					the 3100 Series Front Panel Emulation software.   
					The SNMP management system can communicate to   
					the DSU/CSU remotely through the Facility Data Link   
					(FDL) or (for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs) the   
					Async Terminal Interface Support   
					synchronous data port’s Embedded Data Link (EDL).   
					The DSU/CSU can be configured and managed from   
					an asynchronous (async) terminal. The async terminal’s   
					full screen display uses a menu hierarchy similar to the   
					DSU/CSU’s front panel. You can perform device   
					management and configuration operations as if you are   
					using the DSU/CSU’s front panel, but you do not have the   
					limitation of the 2-line, 16-character LCD.   
					1-2   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Introduction   
					Standalone DSU/CSU Front Panel   
					Physical Description   
					The standalone DSU/CSU front panel contains,   
					The 316x Series consists of a Model 3160 DSU/CSU   
					(2-port), a Model 3164 DSU/DSU (4-port), a Model 3165   
					DSU/CSU (1-port), and a Model 3161 (carrier-mounted)   
					DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					One 2-line, 16-alphanumeric-character-per-line   
					liquid crystal display (LCD)   
					• 
					One 7-button keypad (three Function and four   
					directional keys)   
					For more information about the carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSU, refer to the ACCULINK 3151 CSU and 3161   
					DSU/CSU General Information Guide and the   
					• 
					• 
					Twelve light-emitting diodes (LEDs)   
					COMSPHERE 3000 Series Carrier Installation Manual.   
					Six test jacks for the Model 3160/3164 DSU/CSU,   
					and two test jacks for the Model 3165 DSU/CSU   
					
					
					LCD   
					ACCULINK   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					MON EQPT   
					NET   
					In   
					In   
					In   
					OK FAIL TEST SIG OOF ALRM EER SIG OOF ALRM PDV BPV   
					NETWORK DTR TXD RXD CTS RTS   
					3160   
					Out   
					Out   
					Out   
					496-14936   
					Figure 1-1. 3160 DSU/CSU Front Panel   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					1-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					LCD   
					ACCULINK   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					MON EQPT   
					NET   
					In   
					In   
					In   
					OK FAIL TEST SIG OOF ALRM EER SIG OOF ALRM PDV BPV   
					NETWORK DTR TXD RXD CTS RTS   
					3164   
					Out   
					Out   
					Out   
					496-14937   
					Figure 1-2. 3164 DSU/CSU Front Panel   
					LCD   
					ACCULINK   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					NET   
					MON   
					In   
					OK FAIL TEST SIG OOF ALRM EER   
					NETWORK   
					DTR TXD RXD CTS RTS   
					PORT   
					3165   
					Out   
					495-14567-01   
					Figure 1-3. 3165 DSU/CSU Front Panel   
					1-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Introduction   
					
					
					Standalone DSU/CSU Rear Panel   
					The standalone DSU/CSU rear panel contains the   
					connectors required for the operation of the DSU/CSU   
					COM PORT MODEM   
					NETWORK   
					POWER   
					AUX PORT   
					DTE   
					NEC   
					CLASS 2   
					INPUT   
					CAUTION:AUX PORT OR COM PORT MUST NOT BE CONNECTED TO PSTN OR T1 NETWORK   
					CLOCK IN   
					PORT 1   
					PORT 2   
					494-14540   
					Figure 1-4. 3160 DSU/CSU Rear Panel   
					COM PORT MODEM   
					AUX PORT   
					NETWORK   
					POWER   
					DTE   
					NEC   
					CLASS 2   
					INPUT   
					CAUTION:AUX PORT OR COM PORT MUST NOT BE CONNECTED TO PSTN OR T1 NETWORK   
					PORT 3   
					PORT 4   
					CLOCK IN   
					PORT 1   
					PORT 2   
					494-14564   
					Figure 1-5. 3164 DSU/CSU Rear Panel   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					1-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					COM PORT MODEM   
					NETWORK   
					POWER   
					PORT 1   
					NEC   
					CLASS 2   
					INPUT   
					CAUTION:AUX PORT OR COM PORT MUST NOT BE CONNECTED TO PSTN OR T1 NETWORK   
					495-14565-01   
					Figure 1-6. 3165 DSU/CSU Rear Panel   
					Table 1-1   
					Standalone DSU/CSU Rear Panel Connectors   
					Name   
					Function   
					POWER   
					Supplies power to the DSU/CSU by providing an attachment for the ac power   
					module or the optional dc power cable (+24 or –48 Vdc).   
					AUX PORT   
					COM PORT   
					Supports SNMP LAN Adapter or daisy-chain connections.   
					Provides access to a locally connected PC, ASCII terminal or printer, SNMP   
					management link, or async terminal interface.   
					MODEM   
					Provides a connection to the integral modem for access to a remotely connected   
					PC, ASCII terminal or printer, SNMP management link, or async terminal   
					interface.   
					NETWORK   
					Provides access to the T1 network.   
					DTE (Model 3160/3164)   
					CLOCK IN (Models 3160/3164)   
					PORTs 1–4   
					Provides access to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Used to attach an external clock to the DSU/CSU.   
					Used to connect the customer’s synchronous data DTE to the DSU/CSU.   
					1-6   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Installation   
					2 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1   
					Application Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1   
					SNMP or Telnet Connection Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3   
					Important Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5   
					Optional Power Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5   
					Installing the +24 Vdc Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5   
					Installing the Single –48 Vdc Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6   
					Installing the Redundant –48 Vdc Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7   
					Cabling Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8   
					Power-Up Self-Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9   
					Overview   
					Application Examples   
					This chapter contains information for installing your   
					standalone DSU/CSU. It includes application examples,   
					cabling, and power-up information.   
					The DSU/CSU acts as an interface between the T1   
					digital network and the customer’s equipment.   
					The DSU/CSU is connected to the customer’s   
					equipment through one of the synchronous data ports   
					(PORTs 1– 4) or the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					It is connected to the T1 digital network through the   
					network interface.   
					NOTE   
					Installation instructions for the   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSU are   
					located in the ACCULINK 3151   
					CSU and 3161 DSU/CSU General   
					Information Guide and the   
					COMSPHERE 3000 Series   
					Carrier Installation Manual.   
					NOTE   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface is only available on   
					2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					Some common applications for the DSU/CSU are:   
					
					• 
					
					
					(Figure 2-2).   
					
					
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					2-1   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					NETWORK   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					DSU/CSU   
					DSU/CSU   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					496-15003-01   
					Figure 2-1. Point-to-Point Application Example   
					PBX   
					NETWORK   
					SERVICES   
					DSU/CSU   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					496-15004-01   
					Figure 2-2. Shared Access Application Example   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					DSU/CSU   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					FRACTIONAL   
					NETWORK   
					DSU/CSU   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					DSU/CSU   
					496-15005-01   
					Figure 2-3. Fractional T1 Application Example   
					2-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Installation   
					• 
					• 
					
					AUX port of the other (Figure 2-7).   
					SNMP or Telnet Connection   
					Examples   
					The DSU/CSU can be connected to an SNMP or Telnet   
					system in a number of ways. Some examples include:   
					Remotely accessing the DSU/CSU through the   
					
					port’s Embedded Data Link (EDL) (Figure 2-8).   
					
					• 
					
					
					Telnet device (Figure 2-4).   
					NOTE   
					
					a router) (Figure 2-5).   
					EDL is only available on 2-port   
					and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					
					external LAN Adapter for Ethernet connectivity   
					(Figure 2-6).   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					ETHERNET   
					DSU/CSU   
					NETWORK   
					PPP/SLIP   
					496-15006-01   
					Figure 2-4. Direct Connection   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					ETHERNET   
					DSU/CSU   
					Paradyne   
					NETWORK   
					PPP/SLIP   
					496-15007-01   
					Figure 2-5. Connection through a Router   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					2-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					DSU/CSU   
					ETHERNET   
					NETWORK   
					PPP   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					496-15008-01   
					Figure 2-6. Connection through a LAN Adapter   
					DSU/CSU   
					PPP   
					DSU/CSU   
					NETWORK   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					PPP   
					PPP   
					ETHERNET   
					DSU/CSU   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					496-15009-01   
					Figure 2-7. LAN Adapter and Daisy Chaining   
					LAN   
					ROUTER   
					DSU/CSU   
					DSU/CSU   
					ETHERNET   
					NETWORK   
					FDL/EDL   
					PPP   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					496-15010-01   
					Figure 2-8. Remote Access through FDL/EDL   
					2-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Installation   
					Important Instructions   
					Optional Power Sources   
					Read and follow all warning notices and instructions   
					marked on the DSU/CSU or included in this guide.   
					The DSU/CSU is typically powered by the ac power   
					module. Use the following procedures only if you want   
					to use an optional dc power source.   
					For a complete listing of the safety instructions, see the   
					
					this guide.   
					Using the optional dc power cable, the DSU/CSU is   
					capable of operating on either a +24 Vdc power source,   
					–48 Vdc single source battery, or –48 Vdc redundant   
					source batteries (for power backup). To use dc power,   
					choose one of the following power supply types.   
					HANDLING PRECAUTIONS   
					FOR   
					STATIC-SENSITIVE DEVICES   
					Installing the +24 Vdc Power Supply   
					This product is designed to protect   
					sensitive components from damage   
					due to electrostatic discharge (ESD)   
					during normal operation. When   
					performing installation procedures,   
					however, take proper static control   
					precautions to prevent damage to   
					equipment. If you are not sure of the   
					proper static control precautions,   
					contact your nearest sales or service   
					representative.   
					To install the DSU/CSU using a +24 Vdc power   
					
					procedure.   
					To install the +24 Vdc power supply,   
					1. Connect the green wire to a suitable earth ground.   
					2. Connect the white wire to the +24 Vdc return.   
					3. Connect the orange wire to the +24 Vdc source.   
					4. Cut the black, red, and blue wires off at the outer   
					insulation.   
					5. Plug the power connector into the DSU/CSU.   
					DSU/CSU POWER   
					PLUG   
					TO CUSTOMER-SUPPLIED BATTERY   
					BLACK   
					1 
					X 
					RED   
					GREEN   
					WHITE   
					ORANGE   
					BLUE   
					2 
					3 
					4 
					5 
					6 
					X 
					EARTH GROUND   
					+24 VDC RETURN   
					+24 VDC SOURCE   
					X 
					496-14298-01   
					Figure 2-9. +24 Vdc Power Supply Pinouts   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					2-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					2. Connect the green wire to a suitable earth ground.   
					Installing the Single –ā48 Vdc Power Supply   
					To install the DSU/CSU using a single source –48 Vdc   
					
					procedure.   
					3. Connect the orange and blue wires to the –ā48 Vdc   
					input source.   
					4. Cut the white wire off at the outer insulation.   
					5. Plug the power connector into the DSU/CSU.   
					To install the –48 Vdc single source power supply,   
					1. Connect the black and red wires to the –48 Vdc   
					return source.   
					DSU/CSU POWER   
					PLUG   
					TO CUSTOMER-SUPPLIED BATTERY   
					BLACK   
					1 
					–48 VDC RETURN   
					EARTH GROUND   
					RED   
					2 
					GREEN   
					3 
					WHITE   
					4 
					X 
					ORANGE   
					5 
					6 
					–48 VDC INPUT   
					BLUE   
					496-14299-01   
					Figure 2-10. –ā48 Vdc Single Source Power Supply Pinouts   
					2-6   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Installation   
					3. Connect the green wire to a suitable earth ground.   
					Installing the Redundant –ā48 Vdc Power   
					Supply   
					4. Connect the orange wire to the –48 Vdc input   
					source B.   
					To install the DSU/CSU using a redundant –48 Vdc   
					
					procedure.   
					5. Connect the blue wire to the –48 Vdc input   
					source A.   
					To install the redundant –48 Vdc power supply,   
					6. Cut the white wire off at the outer insulation.   
					7. Plug the power connector into the DSU/CSU.   
					1. Connect the black wire to the –48 Vdc return   
					source B.   
					2. Connect the red wire to the –48 Vdc return   
					source A.   
					DSU/CSU POWER   
					PLUG   
					TO CUSTOMER-SUPPLIED BATTERY   
					BLACK   
					1 
					–48 VDC RETURN B   
					–48 VDC RETURN A   
					EARTH GROUND   
					RED   
					2 
					GREEN   
					3 
					WHITE   
					4 
					X 
					ORANGE   
					5 
					–48 VDC INPUT B   
					–48 VDC INPUT A   
					BLUE   
					6 
					496-14300-01   
					Figure 2-11. –ā48 Vdc Redundant Source Power Supply Pinouts   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					2-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					
					
					Cabling Examples   
					The DSU/CSU is supplied with an ac power module   
					and a VF cable for the integral modem.   
					
					OR   
					MODEM   
					OR   
					MODEM   
					PSTN   
					PC   
					TERMINAL   
					SNMP   
					MANAGER   
					MODEM   
					PORT   
					FRONT   
					PANEL   
					3164 DSU/CSU   
					COM   
					PORT   
					NETWORK   
					PORT   
					MODEM   
					PORT   
					COM PORT MODEM   
					NETWORK   
					POWER   
					AUX PORT   
					DTE   
					3160   
					DSU/CSU   
					NEC   
					CLASS   
					INPUT   
					2 
					CAUTION:AUX PORT OR COM PORT MUST NOT BE CONNECTED TO PSTN OR T1 NETWORK   
					NETWORK   
					PORT   
					CLOCK IN   
					PORT   
					1 
					PORT   
					2 
					T1 NETWORK   
					NETWORK   
					PORT   
					COM PORT   
					COM PORT MODEM   
					NETWORK   
					POWER   
					AUX PORT   
					DTE   
					POWER   
					3164   
					DSU/CSU   
					NEC   
					CLASS   
					INPUT   
					2 
					CAUTION:AUX PORT OR COM PORT MUST NOT BE CONNECTED TO PSTN OR T1 NETWORK   
					PORT   
					3 
					PORT   
					4 
					SERIAL   
					PORT   
					CLOCK IN   
					PORT   
					1 
					PORT   
					2 
					POWER   
					TO   
					ROUTER   
					OR   
					OR   
					T1 OR SERIAL CONNECTIONS   
					DIAL CONNECTIONS   
					SNMP   
					MANAGER   
					TERMINAL   
					496-14935   
					Figure 2-12. Cabling Examples   
					2-8   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Installation   
					If the self-test fails, the Failed screen appears for   
					five seconds. The Fail LED lights, and an   
					Power-Up Self-Test   
					eight-digit failure code (xxxxxxxx) is displayed for   
					use by service personnel to determine the cause of   
					the self-test failure. The DSU/CSU continues to   
					try to operate. If you are in doubt about the results   
					of the self-test, use the Self-Test Health command   
					
					
					After you connect the DSU/CSU to a power source, the   
					unit performs the power-up self-test to ensure that it is in   
					good working order. The DSU/CSU performs this test on   
					itself upon power-up or after a device reset, unless it has   
					been disabled by the Self-Test configuration option (see   
					
					The self-test includes a basic processor test, a limited   
					memory test, a code checksum test, and basic verification   
					tests of the internal components. The front panel LCD   
					displays the progress and pass/fail status of these   
					power-up tests.   
					Self-Test:   
					Failed xxxxxxxx   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The power-up self-test consists of the following steps:   
					1. Once the DSU/CSU is plugged in, the In Progress   
					screen appears and the Fail LED blinks ON and   
					Off continuously.   
					Self-Test:   
					4. The top-level menu screen appears.   
					In Progress   
					DSU ESF   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Stat   
					Test   
					Cnfig   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					2. All the LEDs then start to flash simultaneously in   
					the pattern twice ON, then Off. Then, the LCD   
					begins to flash characters and numbers in the same   
					pattern, alternating with the flashing LEDs.   
					3. If the self-test is successful, the Passed screen   
					appears for one second, the Fail LED turns Off   
					and the OK LED lights.   
					Self-Test:   
					Passed   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					2-9   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					2-10   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Operation   
					3 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2   
					Using the Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2   
					LCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3   
					Keypad. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3   
					Test Jacks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4   
					LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4   
					Displaying Unit Identity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8   
					Setting Customer Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9   
					Selecting the DTE Drop/Insert or Data Port for LED Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9   
					Displaying LED Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10   
					Changing Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11   
					Displaying/Editing Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12   
					Saving Edit Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13   
					Selecting/Copying to a Specific Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13   
					Configuring the DSU/CSU for SNMP or Telnet Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14   
					Selecting the Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14   
					Setting the IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15   
					Selecting the Link Layer Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16   
					Specifying the Community Name(s) and Access Type(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17   
					Configuring SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19   
					Enabling SNMP Trap Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19   
					Selecting the Number of Trap Managers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19   
					Configuring a Destination for SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20   
					Configuring DS0 Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21   
					Displaying DS0 Channel Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26   
					Allocating Data Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27   
					Block or ACAMI Assignment Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28   
					Individual Channel Assignment Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29   
					Allocating DS0 Channels from the DTE Drop/Insert Interface to the Network Interface . . . . . . . . . 3-29   
					Clearing DS0 Channel Allocation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31   
					Providing Backup Capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31   
					Selecting the Timing Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32   
					Configuring for Network Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33   
					Configuring for External Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33   
					Establishing Access Security on a Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34   
					Setting a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34   
					Entering a Password to Gain Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35   
					Acquiring/Releasing the User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35   
					Acquiring the Active User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35   
					Releasing the Active User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36   
					Enabling/Disabling the Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36   
					Using the Integral Modem in Standalone DSU/CSUs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37   
					Entering Numbers in the Phone Directories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37   
					Initiating a Call for Front Panel Pass-Through Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39   
					Initiating a Call for PC, ASCII Terminal/Printer, or SNMP Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39   
					Disconnecting the Modem Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40   
					Enabling the Communication Port for Carrier-Mounted DSU/CSUs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41   
					Deactivating the Alarm Relay for Carrier-Mounted DSU/CSUs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43   
					Resetting the DSU/CSU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43   
					Download Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Overview   
					Using the Front Panel   
					This chapter contains information for operating your   
					DSU/CSU. It includes a description of the front panel and   
					sample procedures for configuring the DSU/CSU.   
					
					consists of an LCD, a keypad, test jacks, and 12 LEDs.   
					The carrier-mounted DSU/CSU faceplate contains test   
					jacks and 12 LEDs, however, the LCD and keypad are   
					located on the Shared Diagnostic Control Panel (SDCP)   
					of the 3000 Series Carrier. For more information about the   
					SDCP, refer to the COMSPHERE 3000 Series Carrier   
					Installation Manual.   
					NOTE   
					Additional information for the   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSU is   
					located in the ACCULINK 3151   
					CSU and 3161 DSU/CSU General   
					Information Guide and the   
					NOTE   
					COMSPHERE 3000 Series   
					Carrier Installation Manual.   
					You can display a graphical   
					representation of the DSU/CSU   
					front panel on an attached PC   
					
					
					LCD   
					ACCULINK   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					MON EQPT   
					NET   
					In   
					In   
					In   
					OK FAIL TEST SIG OOF ALRM EER SIG OOF ALRM PDV BPV   
					NETWORK DTR TXD RXD CTS RTS   
					3160   
					Out   
					Out   
					Out   
					496-14936   
					Figure 3-1. Standalone DSU/CSU Front Panel   
					3-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					LCD   
					Keypad   
					
					
					navigate through the menu tree and select choices   
					presented on the second line of the LCD.   
					• 
					Messages such as alarms, command/test   
					completion, and action in progress   
					• 
					Front panel menu tree information (see   
					
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Figure 3-3. Keypad   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Use the   
					key to move up the menu.   
					Figure 3-2. LCD   
					The LCD displays status messages as requested via the   
					Device Health and Status branch of the front panel menu   
					
					Maintenance). In addition, the highest level status   
					message appears on the front panel automatically if no   
					front panel action has occurred at the DSU/CSU for the   
					past five minutes.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Use the   
					key to exit any part of the menu in which   
					you may be operating. You immediately return to the   
					top-level menu screen shown on the front panel menu (see   
					
					The LCD also lists commands, configuration options,   
					and test results. In most cases, the top line shows the   
					command or option name and default value, while the   
					second line displays options and responses. When a   
					response is required, select from the options displayed   
					directly above the Function keys (F1, F2, F3); make your   
					choice by pressing the corresponding Function key.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Use the Function (F1, F2, F3) keys to make selections   
					from the choices presented on the second line of the LCD.   
					When this line presents choices, it is generally divided   
					into three sections, each displayed directly above one of   
					the Function keys. When your choice appears above one   
					of the Function keys, press that key to select that choice.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-3   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					The scroll keys ( and ) serve one of two functions,   
					depending on whether a menu screen or a data entry   
					screen appears on the front panel.   
					LEDs   
					There are twelve LEDs on the DSU/CSU front panel.   
					
					between the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface and the   
					
					
					choose which port’s status the LEDs display.   
					For data entry screens, the   
					character to the left while the   
					character to the right.   
					key scrolls one   
					key scrolls one   
					For menu screens, the   
					key scrolls to the previous   
					menu choice while the   
					choice.   
					key scrolls to the next menu   
					NOTE   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface is only available on   
					2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					If a choice is available to the left of the screen, the   
					character ← appears on the top line. If a choice is   
					available to the right of the screen, the → character   
					appears on the top line. If choices are available to both the   
					right and the left of the screen, two arrows appear ( ).   
					The arrows indicate that you must use the scroll keys to   
					bring the additional options onto the screen.   
					Figure 3-5. DSU/CSU LEDs   
					Test Jacks   
					A green LED indicates normal operation. A yellow   
					LED indicates a warning (for the DTE Drop/Insert   
					interface) or activity (for the data ports). Conditions are   
					sampled every tenth of a second.   
					Test jacks are located on the DSU/CSU front panel   
					
					in Chapter 4, Maintenance. (The 3165 provides only the   
					Network Monitor In and Network Monitor Out test jacks.)   
					The twelve front panel LEDs are grouped into four   
					sections to indicate the status of the:   
					• 
					• 
					
					
					
					NET MON EQPT   
					
					
					
					In   
					In   
					In   
					Out   
					Out   
					Out   
					496-14808   
					Figure 3-4. Test Jacks (Standalone DSU/CSU)   
					3-4   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Table 3-1   
					System LEDs   
					Name   
					Color   
					Meaning   
					OK   
					Green   
					Indicates the current operational state of the DSU/CSU.   
					ON:   
					The DSU/CSU is operational and has power.   
					OFF:   
					The DSU/CSU is performing a power-up self-test or a system failure   
					has occurred.   
					BLINKING:   
					A software download is in progress.   
					FAST BLINK: The carrier-mounted DSU/CSU is currently selected by the SDCP.   
					FAIL   
					Yellow   
					Yellow   
					Indicates a system failure or a self-test.   
					ON:   
					A device error/fault is detected or a reset has just occurred.   
					No system failures are detected.   
					OFF:   
					BLINKING:   
					A self-test is in progress.   
					TEST   
					A system test is in progress.   
					ON:   
					A loopback or pattern test has been initiated either locally, by the   
					network, or externally.   
					OFF:   
					No tests are active.   
					Table 3-2   
					Network Interface LEDs   
					Name   
					Color   
					Meaning   
					SIG   
					Green   
					Yellow   
					Yellow   
					Monitors the signal being received from the network.   
					ON:   
					A recoverable signal is being received from the network.   
					OFF:   
					The signal cannot be recovered from the network (a Loss of Signal   
					condition exists).   
					OOF   
					ALRM   
					Monitors Out Of Frame (OOF) conditions on the received network signal.   
					ON:   
					At least one OOF was detected on the signal during the sampling   
					period.   
					OFF:   
					No OOFs were detected on the signal during the sampling period.   
					Indicates whether an alarm condition exists on the received network signal.   
					ON:   
					An alarm condition (LOS, LOF, EER, Yellow, AIS) exists on the   
					received network signal. Use the Device Health and Status   
					command to determine the alarm type.   
					OFF:   
					No alarm condition exists on the network interface signal.   
					EER   
					Yellow   
					Indicates the Excessive Error Rate (EER) has been exceeded on the network interface.   
					NOTE: This LED is only valid when ESF framing is being used.   
					ON:   
					The EER has been exceeded on the network interface.   
					The EER has not been exceeded on the network interface.   
					OFF:   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					NOTE   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface is only available on   
					2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					Table 3-3   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface LEDs   
					Name   
					Color   
					Meaning   
					SIG   
					Green   
					Monitors the signal being received from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					ON:   
					A recoverable signal is being received from the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface.   
					OFF:   
					The signal cannot be recovered from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface (a Loss of Signal condition exists).   
					OOF   
					Yellow   
					Yellow   
					Monitors Out Of Frame (OOF) conditions on the received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					signal.   
					ON:   
					At least one OOF was detected on the signal during the sampling   
					period.   
					OFF:   
					No OOFs were detected on the signal during the sampling period.   
					ALRM   
					Indicates whether an alarm condition exists on the received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					signal.   
					ON:   
					An alarm condition (LOS, LOF, EER, Yellow, AIS) exists on the   
					received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) signal. Use the Device Health   
					and Status command to determine the alarm type.   
					OFF:   
					No alarm condition exists on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface   
					signal.   
					PDV   
					BPV   
					Yellow   
					Yellow   
					Monitors Pulse Density Violations (PDV) on the received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					signal.   
					ON:   
					At least one PDV was detected (and corrected) on the received DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) signal during the sampling period.   
					OFF:   
					No PDVs were detected on the received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					signal during the sampling period.   
					Monitors Bipolar Violations (BPV) on the received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) signal.   
					ON:   
					At least one BPV was detected (and corrected) on the received DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) signal during the sampling period.   
					OFF:   
					No BPVs were detected on the received DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					signal during the sampling period.   
					3-6   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Table 3-4   
					Data Port LEDs   
					Name   
					Color   
					Meaning   
					DTR   
					Green   
					Monitors the state of interchange circuit CD (CCITT 108/1, /2) – Data Terminal Ready   
					received from the synchronous data DTE.   
					ON:   
					DTR is being asserted by the synchronous data DTE.   
					DTR is not being asserted.   
					OFF:   
					TXD   
					RXD   
					Yellow   
					Yellow   
					Monitors activity on interchange circuit BA (CCITT 103) – Transmitted Data. This is the   
					data sent from the synchronous data DTE to the data port on the DSU/CSU.   
					ON:   
					Ones are being received from the synchronous data DTE.   
					Zeros are being received from the synchronous data DTE.   
					OFF:   
					CYCLING:   
					Both ones and zeros are being received from the synchronous data   
					DTE.   
					Monitors activity on interchange circuit BB (CCITT 104) – Received Data. This is data   
					sent to the synchronous data DTE from the data port on the DSU/CSU.   
					ON:   
					Ones are being sent to the synchronous data DTE.   
					OFF:   
					Zeros are being sent to the synchronous data DTE.   
					Both ones and zeros are being sent to the synchronous data DTE.   
					CYCLING:   
					CTS   
					RTS   
					Yellow   
					Yellow   
					Monitors the state of interchange circuit CB (CCITT 106) – Clear-to-Send sent to the   
					synchronous data DTE.   
					ON:   
					CTS is being asserted by the DSU/CSU.   
					CTS is not being asserted.   
					OFF:   
					Monitors the state of interchange circuit CA (CCITT 105) – Request-to-Send received   
					from the synchronous data DTE.   
					ON:   
					RTS is being asserted by the synchronous data DTE.   
					RTS is not being asserted.   
					OFF:   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. The following screens appear in the order listed   
					NOTE   
					each time you press the   
					key.   
					The following procedures are   
					examples only. Screen displays   
					may vary depending on the   
					model of the DSU/CSU.   
					Identity:   
					Ser=xxxxxxx   
					F3   
					F3   
					F3   
					F3   
					F3   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Displaying Unit Identity   
					Identity:   
					Mod=xxxx-xx-xxx   
					The identity of the DSU/CSU (serial number, model   
					number, software revision level, hardware revision level,   
					and customer identification) is available through the   
					Status branch of the front panel menu (see Appendix A,   
					
					F1   
					F2   
					The customer identification is the only identity number   
					you can change.   
					Identity:   
					Cust ID=xxxxxxxx   
					To display the DSU/CSU’s identity (ID),   
					F1   
					F2   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Stat.   
					DSU ESF   
					Identity:   
					SRev=xx.xx.xx   
					Stat   
					Test   
					Cnfig   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F1   
					F2   
					2. From the Status screen, press the   
					ID selection appears on the screen.   
					key until the   
					Identity:   
					CCA1=xxxx-xxx   
					3. Select ID.   
					F1   
					F2   
					Status:   
					TStat   
					LED   
					ID   
					Identity:   
					CCA2=xxxx-xxx   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-8   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Setting Customer   
					Identification   
					Selecting the DTE Drop/Insert   
					or Data Port for LED Display   
					The customer identification is the only identity number   
					you can change. It is used to uniquely identify the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					Use the LED command on the Control branch to select   
					which port’s (DTE Drop/Insert or data port) status appears   
					on the five shared LEDs on the front panel.   
					To select a port for LED display,   
					To change the customer identification (CID),   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					1. From the top-level menu, press the   
					key until   
					the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					3. From the Control screen, select LED.   
					3. From the Control screen, press the   
					key until   
					the CID selection appears on the screen.   
					Control:   
					Call   
					4. Select CID.   
					Rel   
					LED   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Control:   
					Reset CID Passwd   
					The currently selected port name appears on the   
					top line of the LCD. DTE indicates the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. Use the   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					LED Dsply: DTE   
					under the desired character. You must enter a   
					DTE   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					character before the   
					moves the cursor to the   
					next space to the right.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					CustID:xxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					4. From the LED Dsply screen, press the Function   
					key that corresponds to the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) or data port for which you want the   
					LEDs to display. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Select DTE to monitor the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) port’s SIG, OOF, ALRM, PDV, and BPV   
					status signals on the shared LEDs.   
					6. Enter the desired ID. Press F1 (Up) and F2   
					(Down) to scroll up and down through the valid   
					characters/numbers for the customer ID. Valid   
					characters are 0 through 9, #, -, ., /, A to Z, and   
					blank space. Press F3 (Save) to save the ID.   
					Select a particular data port to monitor the data   
					port’s DTR, TXD, RXD, CTS, and RTS control   
					signals on the shared LEDs.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-9   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. From the Select LEDs screen, press the Function   
					key that corresponds to T1 interface or the data   
					port for which you want to display LEDs. Use the   
					scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Displaying LED Conditions   
					The same conditions monitored by the front panel   
					LEDs can also be monitored by the LED command. This   
					command is most useful when the DSU/CSU is being   
					
					
					are shown on the PC’s screen; you must use the Stat   
					command procedure described below to get LED   
					information.   
					Select LEDs:   
					T1   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					NOTE   
					If you chose T1, the LED Display screen lists the   
					LED signals, two at a time, on the second line. A   
					vertical bar at the left of the LED name indicates   
					the condition is ON, while an underscore indicates   
					the condition is Off.   
					The following procedure is an   
					example only. Screen displays   
					may vary depending on the   
					model of the DSU/CSU.   
					LED Display:   
					_Test _NetSig   
					To display LED conditions on the front panel screen,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Stat.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					2. From the Status screen, press the   
					LED selection appears on the screen.   
					key until the   
					If you chose a port, the Port n LEDs screen lists   
					the LED signals, two at a time, on the second line.   
					A vertical bar at the left of the LED name   
					indicates the condition is ON, while an underscore   
					indicates the condition is Off.   
					3. From the Status screen, select LED.   
					Status:   
					Perf   
					TStat LED   
					Port n LEDs:   
					_DTR _TXD   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. Use the   
					and   
					keys to scroll LED names   
					onto the screen.   
					3-10   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					The configuration options are divided into functional   
					
					options and defaults. These groups are:   
					Changing Configuration   
					Options   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					DTE (DSX-1) Interface   
					Port   
					The DSU/CSU is an intelligent device that displays   
					only valid options for the current configuration.   
					Therefore, you are only presented with menu choices that   
					are consistent with the current configuration and   
					operational state of the DSU/CSU; invalid combinations   
					of configuration options do not appear. For example,   
					menus displayed for the Model 3160 (2 ports) and the   
					Model 3164 (4 ports) differ due to the number of ports   
					available. Also, if the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface   
					selection is disabled, many of the menu choices do not   
					appear. Be aware that although all options are shown in   
					this guide, what you see on your DSU/CSU varies with   
					your configuration.   
					Network Interface   
					Channel   
					General   
					User Interface   
					Alarm   
					General Management   
					Management Trap   
					The DSU/CSU offers configuration options located in   
					the following memory areas:   
					The DSU/CSU arrives with two preset factory default   
					configuration settings. These settings are based on the   
					following:   
					• 
					Active (Activ). This is the configuration option set   
					currently active for the DSU/CSU. Before a   
					configuration option set becomes active for the   
					DSU/CSU, you must save the set to the Active area.   
					When the DSU/CSU is shipped from the factory,   
					the Active configuration option set is identical to   
					the Factory set. This area can be written to and   
					controls the current operation of the device.   
					• 
					Factory 1 – ESF framing format with B8ZS line   
					coding format for both the network and the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interfaces. Data ports are   
					unassigned.   
					• 
					Factory 2 – D4 framing format with AMI line   
					coding format for both the network and the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interfaces. Data ports are   
					unassigned.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Customer 1 (Cust1). This is the first of two sets of   
					customer-defined configuration options. This area   
					can be written to.   
					If neither of the factory default settings support your   
					network’s configuration, you can customize the   
					configuration options to better suit your application.   
					Customer 2 (Cust2). This is the second of two sets   
					of customer-defined configuration options. This   
					area can be written to.   
					Use the Configuration (Cnfig) branch of the front panel   
					menu tree to display or change DSU/CSU configuration   
					
					Factory 1 (Fact1). This is a set of configuration   
					options preset at the factory. This set is determined   
					by what is considered to be the most common   
					configuration used in the DSU/CSU market.   
					Factory 1 options are read-only.   
					• 
					Factory 2 (Fact2). This is a set of configuration   
					options preset at the factory. This set is determined   
					by what is considered to be the second most   
					common configuration used in the DSU/CSU   
					market. Factory 2 options are read-only.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-11   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. From the Edit screen, select the functional group   
					you want to edit by pressing the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					(The NET selection is shown as an example only.)   
					Displaying/Editing Configuration Options   
					To display/edit configuration options,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					Edit:   
					DTE   
					DSU ESF   
					Port   
					NET   
					Stat   
					Test   
					Cnfig   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The configuration options for the selected   
					functional group appear on the front panel one   
					option at a time. The option name appears on   
					Line 1 with the current value next to it. To reach   
					other options, use the Next and Previous selections   
					to scroll forward and backward through the group   
					of options.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Load from:   
					Activ Cust1   
					NET Framing: ESF   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Next D4   
					ESF   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. Select Edit.   
					5. Press the appropriate Function key to choose   
					another value. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Choose Funct:   
					Edit   
					Save   
					6. Use the Save procedure to save your changes to   
					the Active or Customer area.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-12   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Saving Edit Changes   
					Selecting/Copying to a Specific Port   
					Save edit changes to the Active area when you want   
					those changes to take effect immediately. Save edit   
					changes to the Customer area when you want to overwrite   
					the existing Customer configuration options and store   
					these changes for future use.   
					For the DSU/CSU, you have the capability of selecting   
					a specific port to configure, and then (for 2-port and   
					4-port DSU/CSUs) copying the configuration options   
					from that port to another port (or to all ports).   
					NOTE   
					NOTE   
					The following procedure is an   
					example only. Screen displays   
					may vary depending on the   
					model and configuration of the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					If you attempt to exit the Edit   
					function after making changes   
					without performing a Save, the   
					DSU/CSU prompts you with Save   
					Options? Choose Yes or No.   
					To select a specific port to configure,   
					To save edit changes,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					1. From the Choose Funct screen (one level above   
					the Edit screen, two levels below the top-level   
					menu screen), select Save.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Choose Funct:   
					3. Select Edit.   
					Edit   
					Save   
					4. From the Edit screen, select Port.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Edit:   
					DTE   
					Port   
					NET   
					2. Choose whether you want to save to the Active,   
					Customer 1, or Customer 2 area. Use the scroll   
					keys, if necessary.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Save Edit to:   
					Activ Cust1   
					5. From the Port Select screen, press the Function   
					key that corresponds to the port you want to   
					configure. Use the   
					onto the screen, if necessary. Configure the port   
					key to scroll addition ports   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					
					Port Select:   
					Copy Prt1   
					Prt2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-13   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					To copy the configuration options to one or all ports,   
					1. From the Port Select screen, select Copy.   
					Configuring the DSU/CSU for   
					SNMP or Telnet Access   
					To configure the DSU/CSU for SNMP or Telnet   
					access,   
					Port Select:   
					Copy Prt1   
					Prt2   
					• 
					Enable the SNMP agent or Telnet server within the   
					
					
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					• 
					• 
					Select and configure the port that provides the link   
					to the SNMP or Telnet system.   
					2. Select the port from which you want to copy the   
					configuration options using the corresponding   
					Function key.   
					Set the Internet Protocol (IP) address and subnet   
					mask needed to access the DSU/CSU (see   
					
					• 
					• 
					Select the link layer protocol (PPP or SLIP) for the   
					port that provides the link to the SNMP or Telnet   
					system.   
					Copy From:   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Prt3   
					For SNMP links, specify the two community names   
					(and their access levels) that are allowed to access   
					the device’s Management Information Base (MIB).   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					• 
					• 
					For SNMP links, configure the device to send traps   
					to the SNMP manager, if desired.   
					3. Select the port to which you want to copy the   
					configuration options using the corresponding   
					Function key. Or, press F1 (All) to choose to copy   
					to all ports.   
					Specify the Telnet password or SNMP validation   
					
					
					Copy To:   
					All   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Selecting the Port   
					The SNMP manager, Telnet device, or network device   
					(e.g., a router) can be directly connected to the   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					communications (COM) port. An external LAN Adapter   
					can be connected to either the COM port or the auxiliary   
					(AUX) port to provide Ethernet or Token Ring   
					connectivity. Also, the DSU/CSU can be daisy chained   
					together by connecting the COM port of one device to the   
					AUX port of the other, providing SNMP or Telnet   
					connectivity. Use the MODEM port when accessing the   
					DSU/CSU through a dial-up connection.   
					The COM port can support either synchronous or   
					asynchronous PPP, or asynchronous SLIP at data rates of   
					up to 38,400 bps. The AUX port can support data rates up   
					to 38,400 bps. The MODEM port can support either   
					synchronous or asynchronous PPP, or asynchronous SLIP   
					at data rates of up to 2400 bps.   
					3-14   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					The example shown below assumes that the COM port   
					is being used as the link to the SNMP or Telnet system.   
					Setting the IP Address   
					The IP address is the address used by the SNMP or   
					Telnet system to access the DSU/CSU (see Appendix F,   
					
					PPP, the IP address can be negotiated if the network   
					device (e.g., router or SNMP manager) supports such   
					negotiation. The IP address is composed of four fields   
					with three digits per field (xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx).   
					To select the COM port as the SNMP or Telnet link,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					The IP address is set for the MODEM port, the COM   
					port, or the AUX port (with LAN Adapter or daisy chain),   
					depending on which one has been chosen as the SNMP or   
					Telnet communication link. The example below assumes   
					that an IP address of 010.155.111.222 is being set for the   
					COM port. You can use the same principles to assign any   
					value (between 000 and 255 for each digit field) to other   
					ports.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					User selection appears on the screen.   
					5. Select User.   
					To assign an IP address to the COM port,   
					Edit:   
					Chan Gen   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					User   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					6. Press F1 (Next) until the Com Use configuration   
					option appears.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Mgmt selection appears on the screen.   
					7. Select Mgmt to configure the COM port as the   
					SNMP or Telnet link.   
					5. Select Mgmt.   
					Com Use:   
					Next Mgmt ASCII   
					Edit:   
					User Alarm Mgmt   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					6. From the Mgmt Config screen, select Gen.   
					Mgmt Config:   
					Gen   
					Trap   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-15   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					7. Press F1 (Next) until the Com IP Adr   
					configuration option appears.   
					Selecting the Link Layer Protocol   
					Two link layer protocols, Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP)   
					and Serial Line Internet Protocol (SLIP), are supported for   
					connection to an external SNMP manager, Telnet device,   
					or network device (e.g., a router). PPP can be used for   
					synchronous or asynchronous operation. SLIP can be used   
					for asynchronous operation only.   
					NOTE   
					Steps 8 and 9 describe the   
					process for entering an IP   
					address. This process applies to   
					any IP address.   
					NOTE   
					The carrier-mounted DSU/CSU   
					does not support synchronous   
					operation on the COM port.   
					8. Press F2 (Edit) to edit the IP address. You have the   
					option of using F3 (Clear) to reset the IP address   
					to the factory default 000.000.000.000.   
					The standalone DSU/CSU implementation of PPP   
					supports the following:   
					Com IP Adr:   
					Next Edit   
					Clear   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Full negotiation of PPP’s Link Control Protocol   
					(LCP).   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Active negotiation of LCP when the connection is   
					established.   
					9. Use the   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					Maximum Request Unit (MRU) sizes up to   
					1500 bytes, but the DSU/CSU will attempt to   
					negotiate down to 500 bytes.   
					under the digit you want to change. Press F1 (Up)   
					to increment the digit or F2 (Down) to decrement   
					the digit. In this example, you would press   
					once to place the cursor under the middle digit in   
					the first digit field, then press F1 (Up) once to   
					change the 0 to a 1. Continue in this manner to   
					change the other digits.   
					• 
					The DSU/CSU provides a unique LCP magic   
					number derived from the unit serial number and the   
					elapsed time.   
					• 
					Full negotiation of escape characters.   
					The DSU/CSU implementation of PPP does not   
					support Link Quality Reports (LQR), compression,   
					encryption, Password Authentication Protocol (PAP) or   
					Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (CHAP).   
					000.000.000.000   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The DSU/CSU implementation of SLIP supports a   
					fixed MRU size of 1006 bytes.   
					Before selecting the protocol, you must first select the   
					port to be used as the communications link. Refer to the   
					
					assumes that the COM port is being used as the   
					communications link.   
					10. When you are through changing the IP address,   
					you must press F3 (Save) to save the value.   
					Otherwise, the original value will be retained.   
					010.155.111.222   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-16   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					To select the link layer protocol,   
					Specifying the Community Name(s) and   
					Access Type(s)   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					You have the capability of specifying up to two   
					community names (community name 1 and community   
					name 2) to be used by external SNMP managers when   
					trying to access objects in the DSU/CSU’s MIB. Once you   
					specify the community name(s), you must then specify the   
					type of access to the MIB that SNMP managers in the   
					community are permitted to have.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					To specify the community name 1 and its access type,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					Mgmt selection appears on the screen.   
					5. Select Mgmt.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Edit:   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					User Alarm Mgmt   
					3. Select Edit.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Mgmt selection appears on the screen.   
					6. From the Mgmt Config screen, select Gen.   
					5. Select Mgmt.   
					Mgmt Config:   
					Edit:   
					Gen   
					Trap   
					User Alarm Mgmt   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					7. Press F1 (Next) until the Com Link configuration   
					option appears.   
					6. From the Mgmt Config screen, select Gen.   
					8. Press F2 (PPP) or F3 (SLIP).   
					Mgmt Config:   
					Gen   
					Trap   
					Com Link:   
					Next PPP   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					SLIP   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					7. Press F1 (Next) until the CommunityName1   
					configuration option appears.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-17   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					8. Press F2 (Edit) to edit the community name.   
					The F1 (Up) key scrolls through the ASCII   
					character set in the following order: numbers   
					(0–9), lowercase letters (a–z), uppercase letters   
					(A–Z), space character, ASCII symbols (ascending   
					order, based on ASCII code), and the End of Line   
					symbol (←). The ← erases all characters to the   
					right of the cursor.   
					CommunityName1:   
					Next Edit   
					Clear   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					10. When you are through changing the community   
					name, you must press F3 (Save) to save the value.   
					Otherwise, the original value will be retained.   
					NOTE   
					11. Press F1 (Next) until the Access 1 configuration   
					option appears.   
					Steps 9 and 10 describe the   
					process for entering text strings   
					for Mgmt configuration options.   
					This process applies to entering   
					any text strings into Mgmt   
					configuration options.   
					12. Press F2 (Read) or F3 (R/W).   
					Access 1:   
					Next Read R/W   
					9. Use the   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					under the character you want to change. Press   
					F1 (Up) or F2 (Down) to scroll through the valid   
					numbers/characters for the text string.   
					The Read selection allows read-only access   
					(SNMP “Get”) to the accessible objects in the   
					MIB when community name 1 is used. The R/W   
					selection allows Read/Write access (SNMP “Get”   
					and “Set”) to the objects in the MIB. Write access   
					is allowed for all objects specified as read/write in   
					the MIB. Read access is allowed for all objects   
					specified as read-only or read/write.   
					public   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-18   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Operation   
					6. Press F1 (Next) until the SNMP Trap   
					configuration option appears.   
					Configuring SNMP Traps   
					A trap is an unsolicited message that is sent from the   
					DSU/CSU to an SNMP manager when the DSU/CSU   
					detects certain pre-specified conditions. These traps   
					enable the SNMP manager to monitor the state of the   
					network.   
					7. Press F2 (Enab) to enable trap messages over the   
					SNMP management link.   
					SNMP Trap:   
					Next Enab   
					The SNMP Trap configuration option must be enabled   
					for trap messages to be sent over the communications   
					link. You must specify the number of SNMP managers   
					that are to receive traps from this DSU/CSU, an IP   
					address for each SNMP manager specified, and the type   
					of traps to be sent from this DSU/CSU. For more   
					Disab   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					
					
					Selecting the Number of Trap Managers   
					If you intend to issue traps to an SNMP manager(s)   
					from this device, you must specify the number of SNMP   
					managers that are to receive the traps.   
					Enabling SNMP Trap Messages   
					To enable SNMP trap messages from this DSU/CSU,   
					To specify the number of SNMP managers to receive   
					traps from this device,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Alarm selection appears on the screen.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Mgmt selection appears on the screen.   
					5. Select Alarm.   
					5. Select Mgmt.   
					Edit:   
					User Alarm Mgmt   
					Edit:   
					User Alarm Mgmt   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-19   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					6. From the Mgmt Config screen, select Trap.   
					5. Select Mgmt.   
					Mgmt Config:   
					Edit:   
					User Alarm Mgmt   
					Gen   
					Trap   
					F3   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F1   
					F2   
					7. Select the number of SNMP managers to receive   
					traps (from 1 through 6) by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					6. From the Mgmt Config screen, select Trap.   
					Mgmt Config:   
					Gen   
					Trap   
					Num Trap Mgrs:1   
					Next   
					1 
					2 
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					7. Press F1 (Next) until the Trapn IP Address   
					configuration option appears.   
					Configuring a Destination for SNMP Traps   
					8. Press F2 (Edit) to edit the IP address. You have the   
					option of using F3 (Clear) to reset the IP address   
					to the factory default 000.000.000.000. Refer to   
					
					more information on setting an IP address.   
					A destination must be configured for each SNMP trap   
					manager specified. This configuration option is displayed   
					for the number of trap managers specified by the Number   
					of Trap Managers configuration option.   
					To configure an IP address for the SNMP trap   
					manager,   
					9. Press F1 (Next) until the Trapn Destination   
					configuration appears, and select the destination   
					for the SNMP trap by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Trapn Dst:   
					Next None Com   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Mgmt selection appears on the screen.   
					3-20   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					DTE DROP/INSERT   
					(DSX-1) INTERFACE   
					Configuring DS0 Channels   
					The DSU/CSU provides channel configuration options   
					that allow you to do the following:   
					D1   
					D2   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Display the DS0 assignments for the network, DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1), and data port interfaces.   
					D3   
					N1   
					D4   
					N2   
					D5   
					Allocate DS0 channels on the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface to the network interface.   
					N3   
					D6   
					N4   
					D7   
					Allocate DS0 channels on the network or DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface to particular data   
					ports.   
					N5   
					D8   
					N6   
					D9   
					N7   
					D10   
					D11   
					D12   
					D13   
					D14   
					D15   
					D16   
					D17   
					D18   
					D19   
					D20   
					D21   
					D22   
					D23   
					D24   
					• 
					Clear (deallocate) all DS0 channels from the   
					network, DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1), or data port   
					interface.   
					N8   
					N9   
					N10   
					N11   
					N12   
					N13   
					N14   
					N15   
					N16   
					N17   
					N18   
					N19   
					N20   
					N21   
					N22   
					N23   
					N24   
					• 
					Map data from one port to another.   
					To allocate DS0 channels, begin by defining the logical   
					channel configuration for the network interface, and then   
					the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, and then any   
					
					conceptual diagram of a channel configuration.   
					Blank configuration worksheets are provided at the   
					
					the configuration worksheets for DS0 channel allocation:   
					1. Complete the Network Interface and the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface tables (unless the   
					DTE Drop/Insert interface is disabled) as shown in   
					
					PORTS   
					PRT 1   
					PRT 2   
					PRT 3   
					PRT 4   
					2. Complete the Robbed Bit Signaling (RBS)   
					information worksheet as shown in the example in   
					
					496-14907-01   
					
					and 3-10, circle the configuration options needed   
					to implement the logical channel configuration.   
					Figure 3-6. Example of Channel Allocation   
					Once you have completed the worksheets, enter this   
					
					
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-21   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Network Interface   
					Network Channel Allocation   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface   
					DTE (DSX-1) Channel Allocation   
					N1   
					N2   
					N3   
					N4   
					N5   
					N6   
					N7   
					N8   
					N9   
					D1   
					D2   
					D3   
					D4   
					D5   
					D1   
					N1   
					N2   
					N3   
					N4   
					N5   
					D2   
					D3   
					D4   
					D5   
					D6   
					D7   
					D8   
					D9   
					D9   
					N9   
					N10   
					N11   
					D10   
					D11   
					D12   
					D15   
					Prt1   
					Prt1   
					Prt1   
					Prt3   
					Prt2   
					Prt2   
					Prt2   
					Prt2   
					Prt2   
					Prt2   
					Prt3   
					D10   
					D11   
					D12   
					D13   
					D14   
					D15   
					D16   
					D17   
					D18   
					D19   
					D20   
					D21   
					D22   
					D23   
					D24   
					Allocations   
					N10   
					N11   
					N12   
					N12   
					N13   
					N14   
					N15   
					N16   
					N17   
					N18   
					N19   
					N20   
					N21   
					N22   
					N23   
					N24   
					Allocations   
					N13   
					D1 – D24 indicates allocation to DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) channels.   
					N1 – N24 indicates allocation to network   
					channels.   
					Prt1 – Prt4 indicates allocation to   
					synchronous data ports.   
					Figure 3-7. Example of Interface Worksheet   
					3-22   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Operation   
					DTE Chan   
					Config   
					Assign:   
					(N1 – 24)   
					Voice   
					(RBS or Data)   
					D1   
					N1   
					N2   
					N3   
					N4   
					N5   
					RBS   
					RBS   
					RBS   
					RBS   
					Data   
					D2   
					D3   
					D4   
					D5   
					D6   
					D7   
					D8   
					D9   
					N9   
					RBS   
					RBS   
					Data   
					Data   
					D10   
					D11   
					D12   
					D13   
					D14   
					D15   
					D16   
					D17   
					D18   
					D19   
					D20   
					D21   
					D22   
					D23   
					D24   
					N10   
					N11   
					N12   
					N13   
					Data   
					Figure 3-8. Example of RBS Information Worksheet   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-23   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Port Chan   
					Conf   
					Options   
					Value   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt2, Prt3, Prt4   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 1   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Prt3, Prt4   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 2   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					Figure 3-9. Port Channel Configuration Worksheet (Ports 1 and 2)   
					3-24   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Operation   
					Port Chan   
					Conf   
					Options   
					Value   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Prt2, Prt4   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 3   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Prt2, Prt3   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 4   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					Figure 3-10. Port Channel Configuration Worksheet (Ports 3 and 4)   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-25   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					NOTE   
					Chan selection appears on the screen.   
					The following procedures are   
					examples only. Screen displays   
					may vary depending on the   
					model and configuration of the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					5. Select Chan.   
					Edit:   
					Port   
					NET   
					Chan   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Displaying DS0 Channel Assignments   
					Use the Display command (in the Channel   
					Configuration branch) to view how the DS0 channels are   
					currently allocated.   
					6. From the Channel Config screen, select Dsply.   
					Line 1 of the display shows the 24 channels of the   
					Channel Config:   
					Dsply Clear DTE   
					selected interface. Pressing the   
					or   
					key scrolls the   
					channels onto the screen in groups of three. Line 2   
					displays what is allocated to the DS0 channel listed in   
					Line 1. Symbols used in the display are shown in   
					
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					7. From the Display Chan screen, select NET to   
					display the channels allocated to the network   
					interface. Or, select DTE to display the channels   
					allocated to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface.   
					Table 3-5   
					Display Channel Symbols   
					Symbol   
					Meaning   
					– 
					The DS0 channel is not allocated.   
					Display Chan:   
					Prtn   
					The DS0 channel is allocated to Port n,   
					where n is 1, 2, 3, or 4.   
					NET   
					DTE   
					Ports   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Nn   
					The DS0 channel is allocated to the   
					network interface DS0 channel n, where   
					n can be any number from 1 through 24.   
					Dn   
					The DS0 channel is allocated to the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface DS0   
					channel n, where n can be any number   
					from 1 through 24.   
					8. If you selected NET the channels allocated to the   
					network interface are displayed. Line 1 displays   
					the 24 channels for the network interface, while   
					Line 2 displays what is allocated to the DS0   
					channel shown in Line 1. Pressing the   
					or   
					key scrolls the channels onto the screen in groups   
					of three.   
					To display the DS0 channel allocation,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					N1   
					D2   
					N2   
					D3   
					N3   
					Prt1   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					If you selected DTE, the channels allocated to the   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface are displayed.   
					3-26   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Line 1 displays the 24 channels for the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, while Line 2   
					displays what is allocated to the DS0 channel   
					shown in Line 1.   
					Once a port is selected, you have access to the   
					configuration options to complete the port allocation   
					procedure. These configuration options enable you to,   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Assign the selected port to the desired interface.   
					Select the desired method for channel allocation.   
					D1   
					– 
					D2   
					N1   
					D3   
					N2   
					Select the port rate and starting channel (if the   
					allocation method is block or ACAMI).   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					• 
					Select the specific channels (if the allocation   
					method is by individual channel).   
					To select the data port,   
					Allocating Data Ports   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					By using the configuration options, assign a specific   
					port to DS0 channels on either the network interface or   
					the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. The following   
					methods are available to assign DS0 channels to the port:   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Block – Allows a block of contiguous channels to be   
					assigned by specifying a data port rate and an initial DS0   
					channel (the first DS0 channel in a block of DS0   
					channels). The number of channels assigned is determined   
					by the port rate. Only those initial DS0 channel numbers   
					that provide enough bandwidth (based on the port’s data   
					rate) are displayed on the screen. These channels are   
					automatically assigned to the destination T1 interface   
					(Network or DTE Drop/Insert) when the initial DS0   
					channel is selected.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Chan selection appears on the screen.   
					5. Select Chan.   
					Edit:DTE   
					Port   
					NET   
					Chan   
					ACAMI (Alternate Channel Alternate Block   
					Inversion) – Allows a block of contiguous channels to be   
					assigned by specifying a data port rate and an initial DS0   
					channel (the first DS0 channel in a block of DS0   
					channels). However, with ACAMI, the number of   
					channels assigned is twice the number needed for the port   
					rate. This is because with ACAMI, every alternate DS0   
					channel (starting with the n+1 DS0 channel), does not   
					carry data from the port, but instead always transmits and   
					receives all ones.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					6. From the Channel Config screen, press the   
					key to scroll the ports onto the screen.   
					7. Select the desired port by pressing its   
					corresponding Function key.   
					Chan (Channel) – Individually selects the DS0   
					channels to allocate to the data port. The data port rate is   
					automatically determined based on the number of   
					channels selected.   
					Channel Config:   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Prt3   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-27   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					8. The configuration option for the data port channel   
					allocation destination appears on the screen. Select   
					NET to assign this port to the network interface,   
					select DTE to assign this port to the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, or press the   
					key and the appropriate Function key to assign this   
					port to another port.   
					2. Press F1 (Next) to display the next configuration   
					option (Port Rate).   
					3. Use the   
					or   
					key to scroll the desired port   
					rate onto the screen. Rates scroll in groups of   
					three. Available selections depend on the current   
					base rate selected for the port. Press the   
					corresponding Function key to select the port rate.   
					Then, select Next to display the Start At   
					configuration option on the screen.   
					Assign To:NET   
					Next   
					NET   
					DTE   
					Port Rate:384   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Next   
					64   
					128   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					9. Press F1 (Next) to display the appropriate   
					configuration options on the screen. Use one of   
					the following examples, depending on whether   
					you are assigning by block, ACAMI, or individual   
					channel.   
					NOTE   
					For port-to-port mapping, the   
					procedure is complete after the   
					port rate is selected.   
					Block or ACAMI Assignment Method   
					The Assign By configuration option screen appears   
					after you select a port.   
					To assign by the block or ACAMI method,   
					1. Press F2 for Block or F3 for ACAMI.   
					4. The Start At screen displays the configuration   
					option used to select the starting DS0 channel. If   
					the destination selected is the network interface,   
					then the network channels appear on the screen. If   
					the destination selected is the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface, then these channels appear on   
					the screen.   
					Assign By:   
					Next   
					Block ACAMI   
					The following screen shows an example for the   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					network interface. Use the   
					or   
					key to   
					scroll the desired channel onto the screen. Use the   
					Function keys to select the starting channel. Only   
					those DS0 channel numbers that provide enough   
					bandwidth (based on the configured data rate) to   
					be used as a starting channel number are   
					or   
					Assign By:   
					displayed. Channel allocation for this port can   
					only be cleared by selecting Clear.   
					Next   
					Block ACAMI   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Start At:Clear   
					Next   
					Clear N1   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-28   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Individual Channel Assignment Method   
					Allocating DS0 Channels from the DTE   
					Drop/Insert Interface to the Network   
					Interface   
					The Assign By configuration option screen appears   
					after you select a port.   
					By using the configuration options, you can allocate   
					DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface to the network interface and specify which DS0   
					channels carry Robbed Bit Signaling (RBS) information   
					for voice channels.   
					To assign by the individual channel method,   
					1. Press the   
					key once to bring the Chan selection   
					onto the screen.   
					To allocate DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface to the network interface,   
					Assign By:Block   
					Next   
					Block ACAMI   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					2. Press F3 (Chan).   
					3. Select Edit.   
					Assign By:Chan   
					Block ACAMI Chan   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Chan selection appears on the screen.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. Select Chan.   
					Edit:   
					Port   
					3. Press F1 (Next) to display the next configuration   
					option (channel allocation).   
					NET   
					Chan   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. Line 1 displays the 24 channels for the network   
					interface or the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface, depending on which destination was   
					chosen. This example assumes that the network is   
					the destination. Line 2 displays what is allocated   
					to the DS0 channel shown in Line 1. Pressing the   
					6. From the Channel Config screen, select DTE.   
					or   
					key scrolls the channels onto the screen   
					Channel Config:   
					Dsply Clear DTE   
					in groups of three. Select the channel by pressing   
					the Function key under the desired number. Portn   
					appears. The port is assigned to that channel. To   
					deallocate a port, press the Function key under   
					that port number. Pressing the Function key under   
					channels assigned to other ports has no effect.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					N1   
					Prt1   
					N2   
					Prt2   
					Next   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-29   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					7. From the DTE Channels screen, press F1 to select   
					Assign.   
					To specify DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) channels used to   
					carry voice information,   
					1. Press   
					from the channel allocation screen to   
					DTE Channels:   
					Assign Voice   
					return to the DTE Channels screen.   
					F3   
					N1   
					D1   
					N2   
					D2   
					N3   
					– 
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					8. Press the Function key below the network channel   
					desired. Each time that you press the Function key,   
					the DTE channel number will scroll up one   
					number. If the network channel is currently   
					2. From the DTE Channels screen, press F2 to select   
					Voice.   
					unassigned (‘‘–” is displayed on Line 2), the DTE   
					channel number initially displays the same number   
					as the corresponding network channel number.   
					However, if the network channel is currently   
					assigned, the DTE channel number is shown as   
					Dn. Pressing the Function key for D24 wraps the   
					display back to D1. Only those channels that are   
					not already assigned will appear on the LCD when   
					scrolling. The network channels assigned to ports   
					(Prt1...Prt4) are unavailable for assignment.   
					DTE Channels:   
					Assign Voice   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. Line 1 displays the 24 DS0 channels for the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. Pressing the   
					key scrolls the channels onto the screen in   
					groups of three. Line 2 displays whether the DS0   
					channel in Line 1 is a data channel (Data) or a   
					voice (RBS) channel. Each time that you press the   
					Function key located below the desired channel,   
					the display in Line 2 toggles between Data and   
					RBS.   
					or   
					N1   
					D1   
					N2   
					D2   
					N3   
					– 
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					D1   
					RBS   
					D2   
					RBS   
					D3   
					RBS   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-30   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				Operation   
					7. From the Clear Channel screen, select NET to   
					Clearing DS0 Channel Allocation   
					clear all DS0 channels assigned to the network   
					interface. Or, select DTE to clear all DS0 channels   
					assigned to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface. Or, select a port to clear all assignments   
					for that data port.   
					You can clear (deallocate) all the DS0 channels   
					currently allocated to either the network interface, the   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, or the synchronous   
					data ports.   
					To clear DS0 channel allocation,   
					Clear Channel:   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					NET   
					DTE   
					Port1   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					Providing Backup Capability   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Chan selection appears on the screen.   
					If the T1 network fails, the DSU/CSU provides the   
					ability to reconfigure the unit and restore (at least   
					partially) priority data circuits through an external backup   
					device.   
					5. Select Chan.   
					You can store backup configuration options in the   
					Customer 2 set of customer-defined configuration options.   
					The Enterprise MIB variable devConfigAreaCopy allows   
					the entire contents of one configuration area to be copied   
					into another configuration area via SNMP.   
					Edit:   
					Port   
					NET   
					Chan   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					By cross-connecting two synchronous data ports to   
					each other, one port can provide a backup path for the   
					other. As soon as the ports are configured to be mapped to   
					each other, Data Set Ready (DSR) for the ports is turned   
					on. The external backup device can be configured to   
					initiate dialing when it detects the off-to-on transition of   
					DSR.   
					6. From the Channel Config screen, select Clear.   
					Channel Config:   
					Dsply Clear DTE   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-31   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					common clocking configurations. Two sample procedures   
					for configuring timing are given in the following sections,   
					
					
					
					Selecting the Timing Source   
					The DSU/CSU provides the ability to select a master   
					clock (timing) source that is used to synchronize all of the   
					T1 and data port interfaces on the DSU/CSU. The clock   
					for each interface is at the appropriate rate for that   
					interface (e.g., 1.544 Mbps for the T1 interfaces, the   
					configured port rate for the data ports), and it is   
					independent of the master clock rate. This means that the   
					master clock rate and the DSU/CSU interface rates may   
					be different.   
					NOTE   
					The external clock source is only   
					available for 2-port and 4-port   
					DSU/CSUs. For carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs, the external clock   
					provides timing for up to eight   
					slots in the carrier. Each Auxiliary   
					Backplane must have its own   
					external clock input.   
					The clock source configuration options enable you to   
					select either the network interface, a synchronous data   
					port, the internal clock, the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface, or an external clock. If external clocking is   
					selected, you must use the clock rate configuration option   
					
					NETWORK   
					CLOCK: NETWORK   
					CLOCK: NETWORK   
					CLOCK: INTERNAL   
					CLOCK: NETWORK   
					CLOCK: EXTERNAL   
					CLOCK: NETWORK   
					CLOCK: NETWORK   
					PBX   
					CLOCK: DTE (G.703) CONNECTOR   
					TERMINAL   
					EQUIPMENT   
					CLOCK: PORT 1, 2, 3, OR 4   
					CLOCK: NETWORK   
					496-14341-03   
					Figure 3-11. Common Clocking Configurations   
					3-32   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					3. Select Edit.   
					Configuring for Network Timing   
					To configure for network timing,   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Gen selection appears on the screen.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					5. Select Gen.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Edit:   
					NET   
					Chan Gen   
					3. Select Edit.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					Gen selection appears on the screen.   
					6. Press F1 (Next) to display the next configuration   
					option (Clock Src).   
					5. Select Gen.   
					7. Select the master clock source. For external, press   
					Edit:   
					NET   
					the   
					key until the Ext selection appears on the   
					Chan Gen   
					screen.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					8. Select Ext (external timing).   
					6. Press F1 (Next) to display the next configuration   
					option (Clock Src).   
					Clock Src:Ext   
					Prt1   
					Int   
					Ext   
					7. Select the master clock source. For network, press   
					F2 (note that network is also the default).   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					9. Select the appropriate external clock rate by   
					pressing the corresponding Function key. This step   
					is mandatory if you have chosen external clocking.   
					Clock Src:NET   
					Next   
					NET   
					DTE   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Clock Rate:1544   
					Next   
					2048 1544   
					Configuring for External Timing   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To configure 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs for external   
					timing,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-33   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Establishing Access Security   
					on a Port   
					Setting a Password   
					In addition to establishing access security on a port   
					
					
					specify otherwise, the password is null.   
					Although the password feature is available, it is not   
					required as a factory default. If used, it ensures access   
					security before device control is passed to a device   
					connected to a port. The password configuration option   
					can be individually set for the COM or MODEM port, or   
					both if security is needed on both port types. The default   
					is None. The password itself is set separately (refer to the   
					
					To set a password,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					To establish access security on a port,   
					3. From the Control screen, press the   
					key until   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					the Passwd selection appears on the screen.   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					4. Select Passwd.   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Control:   
					Reset CID Passwd   
					3. Select Edit.   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					User selection appears on the screen.   
					5. Select User.   
					5. Use the   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					under the desired character. You must enter a   
					Edit:   
					Chan Gen   
					character before the   
					moves the cursor to the   
					User   
					next space to the right.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Passwd: xxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					6. Press F1 (Next) until the Password configuration   
					option appears.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					7. Select port(s) to receive access security (None,   
					Com, Modem, or Both). Use the scroll keys, if   
					necessary.   
					6. Enter the desired password. Press F1 (Up) and   
					F2 (Down) to scroll up and down through the   
					valid characters/numbers for the password. Valid   
					password characters are 0–9, a–z, A–Z, #, –, .,   
					and /. Press F3 (Save) to save the password.   
					Password:None   
					Next None Com   
					Passwd: xxxxxxxx   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3-34   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					Entering a Password to Gain   
					Access   
					Acquiring/Releasing   
					the User Interface   
					You are prompted to enter a password (up to   
					8 characters) when you are accessing a port whose   
					Password configuration option is set (refer to the previous   
					
					You can access the user interface from either the front   
					panel, the COM port, the MODEM port (for standalone   
					DSU/CSUs), or the SDCP (for carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs). The DSU/CSU allows only one user   
					interface to be active at a time. The front panel is the   
					default user interface at power-up or after a reset. It is also   
					the default during a software download or when a failure   
					occurs at either the local or remote PC interface.   
					Valid password characters are 0–9, a–z, A–Z, #, -, .,   
					and /. The existing password is not shown on the screen.   
					An underscore in the first position shows where to enter   
					the first character. If the password is set to all null   
					characters (default value), press F3 (Done) when the   
					password screen first appears.   
					You can switch an inactive user interface to active if,   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					The current active user interface has had no activity   
					(no key was pressed) for at least five minutes.   
					The following screen appears when you access a   
					DSU/CSU that has a password enabled.   
					The active user interface has been released with the   
					Release command.   
					Passwd:_   
					The active interface connection is broken. This   
					includes the call disconnect for a modem interface   
					or the termination of the front panel emulation   
					program on a locally-attached PC (if the PC   
					supports DTR) or the termination of the async   
					terminal interface on a remote or locally-attached   
					terminal.   
					Up   
					Down Done   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To enter a password,   
					1. Use the   
					under the desired character. You must enter a   
					character before the key moves the cursor to   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					Acquiring the Active User Interface   
					To acquire the active user interface, press any key. If   
					you are using the PC interface, use the mouse to click on   
					the desired Function key.   
					the next space to the right. The   
					destructive.   
					key is not   
					The top-level menu screen appears on the active user   
					interface, regardless of what screen was displayed at the   
					previous active user interface.   
					Passwd:xxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Done   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					DSU ESF   
					Stat   
					Test   
					Cnfig   
					2. Enter the required password. Press F1 (Up) and F2   
					(Down) to scroll up and down through the valid   
					characters/numbers for the password. You have   
					five minutes to enter the correct password before   
					the DSU/CSU ends the session.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. Press F3 (Done) to indicate you are done entering   
					the password. If you enter an invalid password, the   
					message Invalid Password appears.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-35   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					The inactive interface displays the following message   
					when a Function key is pressed or a connection is made   
					on the inactive user interface and control cannot be   
					switched because the currently active interface is in use.   
					On the screen, either Ft. Panel (front panel), Com Port,   
					Modem, or SDCP is displayed in the user interface (User   
					I/F) field.   
					Enabling/Disabling the Front   
					Panel   
					You can enable or disable the display of information on   
					the front panel. This feature is useful for ensuring that   
					other users do not inadvertently change the device’s   
					configuration options while you are using an external   
					device (e.g., a PC or async terminal). The factory default   
					is Enable.   
					DSU ESF   
					User I/F active   
					NOTE   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					If you disable the front panel, be   
					sure not to alter the configuration   
					options for using an external   
					device (e.g., a PC or async   
					terminal). If this happens, you   
					lose the ability to communicate   
					with the device. You will need to   
					contact your service   
					The inactive interface displays the following message   
					after control has been released from the previously active   
					interface and another interface has not become active.   
					DSU ESF   
					User I/F idle   
					representative.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To enable or disable the front panel:   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					Releasing the Active User Interface   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					To release the current active user interface, either allow   
					five minutes to elapse without pressing any key or use the   
					Release command.   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3. Select Edit.   
					To use the Release command,   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					User selection appears on the screen.   
					5. Select User.   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					6. Press F1 (Next) until the FP Access configuration   
					option appears.   
					3. From the Control screen, select Rel (Release).   
					7. Press F2 to enable the front panel or F3 to disable   
					the front panel.   
					Control:   
					Call   
					Rel   
					LED   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					FP Access:   
					Next Enab   
					Disab   
					F1   
					F3   
					F2   
					The active user interface is released. The message   
					Released appears. No user interface is active until   
					input is received from a user interface.   
					3-36   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Operation   
					To enter or change numbers in the phone directories,   
					Using the Integral Modem in   
					Standalone DSU/CSUs   
					The standalone DSU/CSU’s integral modem enables   
					your DSU/CSU to communicate with remote devices to   
					display alarm messages or to function as the user   
					interface. The carrier-mounted DSU/CSU does not   
					have an integral modem.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					3. From the Control screen, select Call.   
					The Call command, available from the Control branch   
					of the menu tree, provides the following functions to   
					initiate and terminate modem connections:   
					Control:   
					Call   
					Rel   
					LED   
					• 
					Pass – Initiates a call through the integral modem   
					to access a far-end DSU/CSU’s front panel from   
					your DSU/CSU’s front panel (or PC attached to the   
					COM port).   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the Call Setup screen, select ChDir.   
					• 
					Dial – Initiates a call through the integral modem to   
					a printer, ASCII terminal, or PC. Sets up a   
					semipermanent connection to route alarm messages   
					to the specified destination.   
					Call Setup:   
					Pass Dial   
					ChDir   
					• 
					• 
					Disconnect – Disconnects an active modem   
					connection.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Change Directory – Allows entry of phone   
					numbers into the internal phone directories.   
					The Directory 1 displays first, along with its   
					phone number if one has been entered.   
					
					
					5. Press F1 (Next) to display the next directory (2, in   
					this case). Press F2 (Previous) to display the   
					previous directory (A, in this case). Directories   
					appear in order, 1 through 5 and then A.   
					Entering Numbers in the Phone Directories   
					The DSU/CSU has five general directories   
					(1 through 5) and one alarm directory (A). Use the general   
					directories to store phone numbers for remote devices   
					such as standalone DSU/CSUs and ASCII printers. Use   
					the alarm directory to store the phone number of the   
					primary ASCII terminal or printer you use to display or   
					print alarms. This function is not available for   
					1: xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx   
					Next Prev   
					Edit   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs because the integral modem   
					is not available for carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					3-37   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					6. Press F3 (Edit) to change the displayed directory’s   
					phone number (phone numbers can be up to   
					40 characters). If you select Edit, the Edit screen   
					appears.   
					
					rules that apply to entering phone numbers.   
					Example: P9W8135551212   
					8. Press F3 (Save) to store your changes in   
					nonvolatile memory. If you press   
					before saving the phone number you just changed,   
					the previous phone number remains in effect.   
					or   
					1: xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx   
					Next Prev   
					Edit   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					1: xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Save   
					7. Use the   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					under the digit(s) you want to change. Press F1 to   
					scroll up to a higher digit. Press F2 to scroll down   
					to a lower digit. The   
					(default characters) while the   
					key inserts blanks   
					key invokes the   
					End Of Number (EON) character which   
					terminates the dial string and erases any characters   
					to the right when you use the Save function.   
					Table 3-6   
					Valid Phone Number Characters   
					Valid Characters   
					Meaning   
					Restrictions   
					0 to 9   
					* #   
					DTMF or pulse digits   
					— 
					— 
					DTMF digits   
					P 
					Selects Pulse dialing   
					Pulse or Tone must be specified, otherwise   
					Tone is the default. This must be the first   
					character in the string, unless the first character   
					is B. Then, it must immediately follow the B.   
					T 
					Selects Tone (DTMF) dialing   
					Wait for dial tone   
					Tone or Pulse must be specified, otherwise   
					Tone is the default. This must be the first   
					character in the string, unless the first character   
					is B. Then, it must immediately follow the B.   
					W 
					B 
					— 
					Blind dialing (you need not wait for a dial tone   
					before entering the dialing sequence)   
					To be valid, this must be the first character in   
					the string.   
					, 
					Creates a 2-second pause in the dialing   
					sequence   
					— 
					— 
					— 
					<space> ( ) -   
					<-   
					Extra characters for readability. The space is   
					the default character.   
					End Of Number (EON) character, terminates   
					the dial string and erases all characters to the   
					right after F3 (Save) is pressed   
					3-38   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Operation   
					5. From the Pass Directory screen, press F1 (Up) to   
					display the next higher numbered directory or   
					press F2 (Down) to select the next lower   
					numbered directory.   
					Initiating a Call for Front Panel   
					Pass-Through Operation   
					Front panel pass-through initiates a call through the   
					integral modem to access a far-end DSU/CSU’s front   
					panel from your DSU/CSU’s front panel (or PC attached   
					to the COM port).   
					Pass n: xxxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Dial   
					NOTE   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Pass is only available when the   
					FP Pass configuration option has   
					been enabled (see Appendix C,   
					
					physical interface is either the   
					front panel or the PC, and the   
					integral modem is not already in   
					use.   
					6. When the number of the desired directory appears   
					on the screen, press F3 (Dial) to place the call.   
					Pass n: xxxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Dial   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To initiate front panel pass-through at the near-end   
					DSU/CSU,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					Initiating a Call for PC, ASCII   
					Terminal/Printer, or SNMP Operation   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					Use the Dial command to set up a semipermanent   
					connection to route alarm messages to the specified   
					destination. The Dial command initiates a call through the   
					integral modem to a printer, ASCII terminal, or PC.   
					3. From the Control screen, select Call.   
					Control:   
					To initiate a call at the local DSU/CSU,   
					Call   
					Rel   
					LED   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					4. From the Call Setup screen, select Pass.   
					3. From the Control screen, select Call.   
					Call Setup:   
					Pass Dial   
					Control:   
					ChDir   
					Call   
					Rel   
					LED   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-39   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. From the Call Setup screen, select Dial. This   
					selection is not available if the DSU/CSU’s   
					integral modem is already in use.   
					To disconnect an established modem connection using   
					the Disconnect command,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					Call Setup:   
					Pass Dial   
					ChDir   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. From the Control screen, select Call.   
					Control:   
					5. From the Dial Directory screen, press F1 (Up) to   
					display the next higher numbered directory or   
					press F2 (Down) to select the next lower   
					numbered directory.   
					Call   
					Rel   
					LED   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Dial n: xxxxxxxxx   
					4. From the Call Setup screen, select Disc.   
					Up   
					Down Dial   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Call Setup:   
					Disc   
					ChDir   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					6. When the number of the desired directory appears   
					on the screen, press F3 (Dial) to place the call.   
					The modem call is disconnected and the   
					Command Complete screen appears.   
					Dial n: xxxxxxxxx   
					Up   
					Down Dial   
					Disconnect:   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Command Complete   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Disconnecting the Modem Connection   
					To disconnect a modem connection using two front   
					panel keys,   
					The Disconnect command enables you to force a   
					disconnect of an active modem connection from the front   
					panel of the DSU/CSU. This command is only available   
					when the DSU/CSU modem is connected.   
					1. Press the   
					and   
					keys simultaneously and   
					hold for two seconds.   
					Disconnect methods include:   
					• 
					Using the Disconnect command via the front panel   
					menu (for all dial connections, or when a   
					pass-through connection is established to another   
					316x DSU/CSU).   
					Call Setup:   
					Disc   
					ChDir   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					• 
					Pressing and holding the   
					and   
					front panel   
					keys simultaneously (when a pass-through   
					connection is established to a remote device other   
					than a 316x DSU/CSU).   
					The modem call is disconnected and the   
					Command Complete screen appears.   
					3-40   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Operation   
					6. Press F1 (Next) until the Com Port configuration   
					option appears.   
					Enabling the Communication   
					Port for Carrier-Mounted   
					DSU/CSUs   
					7. Select Enab to enable the COM port for the   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSU.   
					Communication between the carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs and an external PC, ASCII device, SNMP   
					manager, or async terminal interface (attached either   
					locally or through an external modem) occurs through a   
					shared communication (COM) port. (For COM port   
					cabling information, refer to the COMSPHERE 3000   
					Series Carrier Installation Manual.) Unlike standalone   
					DSU/CSUs, the carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs do not have a   
					dedicated COM port for external access. Once the COM   
					port is enabled, other COM port configuration options can   
					be selected. These options are used to configure Port 2 on   
					the Auxiliary Backplane as a COM port for the carrier.   
					Com Port:   
					Next Enab   
					Disab   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The carrier COM port provides the following   
					functionality:   
					• 
					If configured for ASCII, only one ASCII device   
					may be used for the carrier. (If two COM ports are   
					configured for ASCII, neither will work.)   
					NOTE   
					• 
					If configured for Mgmt, each device in the carrier   
					can support an Mgmt COM port; however, each   
					Mgmt COM port must be connected to a different   
					subnet. To facilitate IP data routing, the device with   
					the closest link to the SNMP manager or Telnet   
					client should be configured as the IP Bus Master.   
					If a Model 3161 DSU/CSU has   
					the COM port enabled, Port 2   
					cannot be used as a data port.   
					To enable the COM port on the carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSU,   
					• 
					If configured for either ASCII or Mgmt, the carrier   
					COM port may be configured to control an external   
					device (e.g., modem, x.25 PAD) through the use of   
					AT or user-specified commands.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Cnfig.   
					The set of valid characters for control of the carrier   
					external COM port device is as follows:   
					2. Select the configuration option set to be copied   
					into the Edit area by using the appropriate   
					Function key. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					The numbers: 0–9   
					3. Select Edit.   
					The lowercase letters: a–z   
					The uppercase letters: A–Z   
					The space (“ ”) character   
					4. From the Edit screen, press the   
					key until the   
					User selection appears on the screen.   
					The ASCII symbols (in ascending order, based on   
					the ASCII code)   
					5. Select User.   
					• 
					• 
					The End Of Line (EOL) symbol: ←   
					Edit:   
					Chan Gen   
					The caret (‘‘^”) control character is used to select   
					non-printable ASCII characters. The caret ‘‘^” must   
					be followed by one character which together form   
					
					available control sequences.   
					User   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-41   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table 3-7   
					Control Sequences   
					Sequence   
					ASCII   
					SOH   
					STX   
					ETX   
					EOT   
					ENQ   
					ACK   
					BEL   
					BS   
					HEX   
					^A or ^a   
					0x01   
					0x02   
					0x03   
					0x04   
					0x05   
					0x06   
					0x07   
					0x08   
					0x09   
					0x0A   
					0x0B   
					0x0C   
					0x0D   
					0x0E   
					0x0F   
					0x10   
					0x11   
					0x12   
					0x13   
					0x14   
					0x15   
					0x16   
					0x17   
					0x18   
					0x19   
					0x1A   
					0x1B   
					0x1C   
					0x1D   
					0x1E   
					0x1F   
					^B or ^b   
					^C or ^c   
					^D or ^d   
					^E or ^e   
					^F or ^f   
					^G or ^g   
					^H or ^h   
					^I or ^i   
					^J or ^j   
					^K or ^k   
					^L or ^l   
					^M or ^m   
					^N or ^n   
					^O or ^o   
					^P or ^p   
					^Q or ^q   
					^R or ^r   
					^S or ^s   
					^T or ^t   
					^U or ^u   
					^V or ^v   
					^W or ^w   
					^X or ^x   
					^Y or ^y   
					^Z or ^z   
					^{   
					HT   
					LF or NL   
					VT   
					FF or NP   
					CR   
					SO   
					SI   
					DLE   
					DC1   
					DC2   
					DC3   
					DC4   
					NAK   
					SYN   
					ETB   
					CAN   
					EM   
					SUB   
					ESC   
					FS   
					^\   
					^}   
					GS   
					^^   
					RS   
					^_   
					US   
					3-42   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Operation   
					Deactivating the Alarm Relay   
					for Carrier-Mounted   
					DSU/CSUs   
					The Alarm Cut-off command forces a deactivation of   
					the alarm relay on the 3000 Series Carrier during an alarm   
					condition. Since this function only affects the 3000 Series   
					Carrier, it is only available for carrier-mounted   
					Resetting the DSU/CSU   
					Use the Reset command to perform a power-on reset of   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					To reset the DSU/CSU,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					DSU/CSUs. The alarm relay function must first be   
					enabled by the Alarm Relay configuration option (refer to   
					
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					3. From the Control screen, press the   
					key until   
					To deactivate the alarm relay,   
					the Reset selection appears on the screen.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					4. Select Reset.   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					Control:   
					ClrReg Reset   
					3. From the Control screen, select ACO.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Control:   
					ACO Rel   
					LED   
					5. From the Device Reset screen, press F1 to initiate   
					a reset of the DSU/CSU (the power-up sequence   
					screen appears). Press F2 instead to return to the   
					Control screen without initiating a reset.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. The Command Complete screen appears.   
					Device Reset:   
					Yes   
					No   
					Alarm Cut-Off:   
					Command Complete   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Download Operations   
					NOTE   
					The Download command is for   
					use by service personnel only.   
					Loss of primary data could result   
					from improper use.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-43   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					3-44   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Operation   
					Changing User Interface Access Security   
					User Interface Access   
					Security for Standalone   
					DSU/CSUs   
					To change user interface access security,   
					1. Press the   
					screen.   
					key two times from the top-level   
					NOTE   
					DSU ESF   
					Test   
					This page of the manual is self-   
					supporting and can be removed to   
					prevent unwanted knowledge of the   
					security access levels and their   
					selection.   
					Stat   
					Cnfig   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					2. Press the   
					key three times.   
					The user interface access security option allows you to   
					limit access to the DSU/CSU to display-only and   
					non-intrusive functions. The user access security   
					function is not available for carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs.   
					DSU ESF   
					Stat   
					Test   
					Cnfig   
					Level 1 (Lvl1) access security allows access to all   
					functions available through the menu tree. This is the   
					default setting.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Level 2 (Lvl2) access security restricts access to only   
					those functions that cannot affect the operation of the   
					DSU/CSU in any way. At this level,   
					3. Press the   
					key once.   
					DSU ESF   
					• 
					None of the functions in the Test or Ctrl branches   
					are available.   
					Stat   
					Test   
					Cnfig   
					• 
					• 
					All functions on the Stat branch are available.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					All functions on the Cnfg branch are available for   
					display, but they cannot be used to save to a   
					configuration area.   
					The Security screen appears.   
					You can only reach the screen that controls security   
					access using the front panel.   
					Security:   
					Lvl1   
					Lvl2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. Press F1 to select Lvl1, or press F2 to select Lvl2.   
					After you make a selection, the top-level screen   
					appears.   
					If you do not make a selection within 5 minutes,   
					the Automatic Device Health/Status screen   
					appears.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3-45   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					3-46   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Maintenance   
					4 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1   
					Self-Test Health . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2   
					Device Health and Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3   
					Performance Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5   
					Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9   
					SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10   
					Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11   
					Test Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13   
					Test Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15   
					Remote Loopback Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15   
					Sending a Line Loopback Up or Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15   
					Sending a V.54/ANSI FT1 Activation/Deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16   
					Local Loopback Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17   
					Starting a Line Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18   
					Starting a Payload Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18   
					Starting a DTE Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19   
					Starting a Repeater Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19   
					Starting a Data Channel Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20   
					Starting a Data Terminal Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20   
					Aborting Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21   
					Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22   
					Sending Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22   
					Monitoring Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23   
					Aborting Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24   
					Lamp Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25   
					Starting a Lamp Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25   
					Aborting a Lamp Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25   
					Displaying DSU/CSU Test Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26   
					Overview   
					The DSU/CSU can detect and report faults, and   
					perform diagnostic tests. These features ensure that your   
					DSU/CSU is giving you optimum performance in your   
					network.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-1   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					2. From the Status screen, select STest.   
					Self-Test Health   
					Use the Self-Test Health command to display the   
					results of the power-up self-test. Possible messages are   
					
					information about power-up self-test.   
					Status:   
					DevHS STest Perf   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To display power-up self-test results,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Stat.   
					3. View the results of the last power-up self-test. If   
					no problems were found during power-up, the   
					following message appears.   
					DSU ESF   
					Test   
					Stat   
					Cnfig   
					STest Health:   
					Passed   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Table 4-1   
					Self-Test Health Messages   
					Message   
					Description   
					Passed   
					No problems were found during power-up.   
					CPU fail   
					The central processing unit failed internal testing.   
					Device fail   
					B8ZS/LOS fail   
					Alarm fail   
					One or more of the unit’s integrated circuit chips failed to pass internal device level testing.   
					The unit failed to encode data properly or to detect Loss Of Signal.   
					The unit failed to transmit AIS or to detect an Yellow alarm.   
					The unit failed program checksum verification.   
					Memory fail   
					LCD fail   
					The front panel liquid crystal display (LCD) failed.   
					NET T1 fail   
					DTE T1 fail   
					DSU fail   
					The unit failed to internally loop data on the network T1 circuit.   
					The unit failed to internally loop data on the DTE T1 (DSX-1) circuit.   
					The unit failed to internally loop data on the DSU.   
					DSU Portn fail   
					Modem fail   
					Port’s integrated circuitry failed to pass device internal testing.   
					Unit failed to internally loop data through the modem circuit.   
					Unknown Exp Dev The unit is not able to recognize the expansion device connected to the main circuit card.   
					Failure xxxxxxxx   
					An 8-digit hexadecimal failure code is provided for service personnel.   
					4-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					3. Use the scroll keys, if necessary, to scroll   
					Device Health and Status   
					Use the Device Health and Status branch to view the   
					current health and status messages for the DSU/CSU.   
					
					additional device health and status messages onto   
					the LCD.   
					Device H/S:   
					OOF at DTE   
					To display device health and status,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Stat.   
					2. From the Status screen, select DevHS.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The Auto Device Health and Status screen appears   
					when there is no activity (no keys pressed) on the   
					active physical interface for five minutes. Only the   
					highest priority message appears on Line 2 of the   
					LCD.   
					Status:   
					DevHS STest Perf   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Auto Dev H/S   
					OOF at DTE   
					Alarm/status messages appear on Line 2 of the   
					LCD in priority order (highest to lowest). The   
					DSU/CSU is polled for current status every ten   
					seconds. If the status has changed from the last   
					poll, the Health and Status screen is updated and   
					the highest priority message is displayed.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Table 4-2   
					(1 of 2)   
					Health and Status Messages   
					Message   
					Description   
					LOS at Net   
					A Loss Of Signal condition (175 consecutive zeros) has been detected on the network interface.   
					The condition is cleared when the density of ones to zeros received is 12.5%.   
					LOS at DTE   
					OOF at Net   
					OOF at DTE   
					A Loss Of Signal condition (175 consecutive zeros) has been detected on the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface. The condition is cleared when the density of ones to zeros received is 12.5%.   
					An Out Of Frame condition (2 out of 4 frame synchronization bits in error) has been detected on   
					the network interface. The condition is cleared when a reframe occurs.   
					An Out Of Frame condition has been detected on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. The   
					condition is cleared when a reframe occurs.   
					AIS at Net   
					AIS at DTE   
					EER at Net   
					An Alarm Indication Signal (unframed all ones signal) is being received by the network interface.   
					An Alarm Indication Signal is being received by the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					An Excessive Error Rate condition has been detected on the network interface (the bit error rate   
					has exceeded the configured threshold for ESF framing). The condition is cleared when the error   
					rate falls below the threshold value.   
					Yellow at Net   
					Yellow at DTE   
					A Yellow Alarm signal is being received by the network interface.   
					A Yellow Alarm signal is being received by the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					4-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table 4-2   
					(2 of 2)   
					Health and Status Messages   
					Message   
					Description   
					OOF at Prtn   
					An Out Of Frame condition has been detected on data port Prtn (where n is the port number). This   
					condition only occurs if the synchronous data port’s Embedded Data Link (EDL) is enabled (only   
					available for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs).   
					EER at Prtn   
					The error rate of the received signal has exceeded the configured threshold for data port Prtn   
					(where n is the port number). This condition only occurs if the synchronous data port’s Embedded   
					Data Link (EDL) is enabled (only available for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs). The condition is   
					cleared when the error rate falls below the synchronous data port’s configured threshold value.   
					PORT IP Down   
					The IP management link is in a down state for PORT (where PORT is COM, MODEM, or AUX).   
					This condition occurs if the PORT is configured for Mgmt, and communication between the   
					management system and the DSU/CSU is not currently possible for this port. For the AUX port, this   
					condition is detected only when a device reset or power-up occurs.   
					Selftest failed   
					A failure was detected during the power-on self-test. Select STest (in the Stat branch) to display   
					more information about the failure.   
					DevFail xxxxxxxx   
					Download failed   
					An internal error has been detected by the operating software. An 8-digit code appears for use by   
					service personnel. The condition is cleared by resetting the device.   
					A download attempt was interrupted and failed to complete. The condition is cleared by resetting   
					the device.   
					Test in progress   
					A test is currently active. Select Tstat (in the Stat branch) to display more test information.   
					Modem Connected   
					The integral modem is currently connected. This message is only displayed for standalone   
					DSU/CSUs.   
					Master Clk fail   
					The master clock has failed. Timing for the DSU/CSU is provided by the internal clock.   
					This message only appears if there are no valid alarm or status messages.   
					DSU Operational   
					4-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Maintenance   
					To display User Network Interface (User) performance,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Stat.   
					2. From the Status screen, select Perf.   
					Performance Reports   
					When the network interface is configured for ESF   
					operation, network performance is continuously   
					monitored and maintained in two sets of aggregate   
					registers: Carrier Network Interface Registers (Telco) and   
					User Network Interface Registers (User). The User   
					registers contain an extra status register (Status Event).   
					Registers shown on the front panel LCD are listed in   
					Table 4-3. These registers are status registers that collect   
					performance data for the previous 24-hour period.   
					Performance data is updated in 15-minute intervals. After   
					15 minutes, the current interval is rolled over into a set of   
					accumulator registers that represent the previous 96   
					15-minute intervals for the register. An interval total of   
					how many of the 96 registers contain valid data is also   
					kept, as well as a 24-hour total for each accumulator   
					register.   
					Status:   
					DevHS STest Perf   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. Select User registers.   
					Performance:   
					Telco User   
					Prt1   
					For 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs, port performance is   
					continuously monitored and maintained in memory   
					registers when the port is configured to use EDL. The   
					DSU/CSU maintains two sets of port registers for each   
					synchronous data port: far-end port registers and near-end   
					port registers. These registers are status registers that   
					collect performance data for the previous 8-hour period.   
					Port data is updated in 15-minute intervals. After   
					15 minutes, the current interval is rolled over into a set of   
					accumulator registers that represent the previous 32   
					15-minute intervals for the register. An interval total of   
					how many of the 32 registers contain valid data is also   
					kept, as well as a 8-hour total for each accumulator   
					register.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the User Registers screen, press F1 to view   
					current registers (go to Step 5), press F2 to view   
					24-Hour Totals (go to Step 6), or press F3 to view   
					15-Minute Interval Registers (go to Step 7).   
					User Registers:   
					Cur   
					24Tot Intvl   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					NOTE   
					The following procedure is an   
					example only. Screen displays   
					may vary depending on the   
					model and configuration of the   
					DSU/CSU. The procedures for   
					displaying Telco and port registers   
					are similar to this example.   
					5. When you press F1 from the User Registers   
					screen, the User registers for the current   
					15-minute interval appear.   
					User Current:   
					Event = xx,xxx   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					4-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					6. When you press F2 from the User Registers   
					screen, the User registers for the 24-hour total   
					interval appear.   
					To clear the performance registers,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, press the   
					until the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					key   
					User 24 Hour:   
					VldIntvl = xx   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					3. From the Control screen, press the   
					key until   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					the ClrReg selection appears on the screen.   
					4. Select ClrReg.   
					7. When you press F3 from the User Registers   
					screen, the interval screen appears. Use this screen   
					to choose the specific 15-minute interval.   
					Control:   
					Rel   
					LED ClrReg   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					User Intvl: 01   
					Up   
					Down Dsply   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. From the Clear Prf Regs screen, press F1 to clear   
					the User registers.   
					8. Use the   
					and   
					keys to position the cursor   
					Clear Prf Regs:   
					under the first or second digit in the interval   
					number displayed, then use the F1 (Up) and   
					F2 (Down) keys to increment/ decrement the   
					number.   
					User   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					9. When you have selected the number of the interval   
					you want to display, press F3 (Dsply) to display   
					the registers for the interval selected. Use the   
					scroll keys to view additional register information.   
					If you selected User, the User performance   
					registers are cleared, all accumulators are reset to   
					zero, and all status registers are cleared. The   
					current interval timer, the number of valid   
					intervals count, and the total 24-hour counts are   
					reset to zero. The Command Complete message   
					then appears.   
					User Intvl: xx   
					ES=xxx   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					You can reset the performance registers via the ClrReg   
					command in the Control branch of the front panel menu.   
					4-6   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Maintenance   
					Table 4-3   
					(1 of 2)   
					Performance Registers   
					Register   
					Interval Description   
					Totals Description   
					Event   
					ESF error events counter. An error event is an   
					ESF frame with either a Cyclic Redundancy   
					Check (CRC) error or an Out Of Frame (OOF)   
					event. The maximum count is 65,535. This   
					register is only reset as a result of a reset   
					command from the network. This register is   
					valid for the current interval only.   
					N/A   
					CurTimer   
					VldIntvl   
					Current interval timer. This register records the   
					number of seconds in the current 15-minute   
					interval. The maximum is 900 seconds. This   
					register is valid for the current interval only.   
					N/A   
					N/A   
					Valid interval total. Records the number of valid   
					15-minute intervals in the previous x hours, where x   
					is 24 hours for aggregate performance and 8 hours   
					for port performance. This register is not valid for the   
					current interval.   
					ES   
					The number of errored seconds for the current   
					interval. An errored second is any second with   
					The total number of errored seconds for the previous   
					x hours, where x is 24 hours for aggregate   
					one or more ESF error events. The maximum is performance and 8 hours for port performance.   
					900 seconds.   
					UAS   
					The number of unavailable seconds for the   
					current interval. An unavailable second is any   
					one second interval when service is   
					unavailable. (Detection occurs with   
					10 consecutive unavailable seconds.) The   
					maximum is 900 seconds.   
					The total number of unavailable seconds for the   
					previous x hours, where x is 24 hours for aggregate   
					performance and 8 hours for port performance.   
					SES   
					The number of severely errored seconds for the The total number of severely errored seconds for the   
					current interval. A severely errored second is   
					any second with 320 or more CRC errors, or   
					any second with one or more OOF events. The   
					maximum is 900 seconds.   
					previous x hours, where x is 24 hours for aggregate   
					performance and 8 hours for port performance.   
					BES   
					The number of bursty errored seconds for the   
					current interval. A bursty errored second is any   
					second with more than one, but less than 320,   
					CRC errors. The maximum is 900 seconds.   
					The total number of bursty errored seconds for the   
					previous x hours, where x is 24 hours for aggregate   
					performance and 8 hours for port performance.   
					LOFC   
					The loss of frame count for the current interval. The total loss of frame count for the previous x   
					This is a count of the number of times that an   
					LOF is declared. The maximum count is 255.   
					hours, where x is 24 hours for aggregate   
					performance and 8 hours for port performance.   
					CSS   
					(Not valid for   
					Port registers.)   
					The number of controlled slip seconds for the   
					current interval.   
					The total number of controlled slip seconds for the   
					previous x hours, where x is 24 hours for aggregate   
					performance and 8 hours for port performance.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					4-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table 4-3   
					(2 of 2)   
					Performance Registers   
					Register   
					Interval Description   
					Totals Description   
					StEvnt   
					(Only valid for   
					User registers.)   
					The status events register records whether one N/A   
					or more of the following events have occurred   
					at least once during the interval. The event is   
					identified by a letter as follows:   
					Y – A Yellow Alarm signal has been received   
					on the network interface.   
					L – Loss Of Signal has occurred on the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					E – The Excessive Error Rate threshold has   
					been exceeded.   
					F – A Frame Synchronization Bit Error has   
					been detected.   
					V – A Bipolar Violation has been detected.   
					If none of these events occurred during the   
					interval, StEvnt=none will be displayed.   
					Complete   
					Bad line conditions or loopback tests may   
					prevent far-end port statistics from reaching the   
					DSU/CSU. This field indicates whether the   
					15-minute interval contains 900 seconds of   
					statistics. If one or more seconds of far-end   
					statistics are missing, this field will display   
					Complete=No, otherwise it will display   
					N/A   
					(Only valid for   
					far-end port   
					registers.)   
					Complete=Yes. This field is only displayed   
					when Far is selected from the Prtn screen.   
					4-8   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Maintenance   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Continuous Out Of Frame condition detected at   
					synchronous data port n (where n is the port   
					number).   
					Alarms   
					The DSU/CSU can be attached, either locally or   
					remotely, to an ASCII terminal or printer to display or   
					print alarm messages. Alarms can also be displayed on a   
					PC that is using a terminal emulation package.   
					Alarm Cleared. Out Of Frame condition at   
					synchronous data port n (where n is the port   
					number).   
					For standalone DSU/CSUs, you can route these alarms   
					to the MODEM port, the COM port, or both. For   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, you can route them to the   
					COM port or dial them out using an external device.   
					An Excessive Error Rate has been detected at   
					synchronous data port n (where n is the port   
					number).   
					Alarm Cleared. An Excessive Error Rate at   
					synchronous data port n (where n is the port   
					number).   
					Each alarm message contains a customer identification   
					to indicate which remote DSU/CSU is reporting an alarm.   
					For information about customer identification, refer to the   
					
					If two alarm conditions are detected at once, the higher   
					priority alarm is reported. However, if an even higher   
					priority alarm is detected before the first alarm is cleared,   
					the later alarm is not reported. (The alarms listed above   
					are in priority order with the highest priority listed first.)   
					Possible alarm messages are as follows:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Continuous Loss Of Signal detected at the x   
					Interface (where x is either Network or DTE).   
					Alarm Cleared. Loss Of Signal condition at the x   
					Interface (where x is either Network or DTE).   
					Alarms remain active until the alarm condition is   
					cleared. Also, an alarm clear message is only sent when   
					there are no other alarms active.   
					Continuous Out Of Frame condition detected at   
					the x Interface (where x is either Network or   
					DTE).   
					For information about alarm configuration options,   
					
					Appendix C, Configuration Options.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Alarm Cleared. Out Of Frame condition at the x   
					Interface (where x is either Network or DTE).   
					For troubleshooting information, refer to the   
					
					Alarm Indication Signal received at the x   
					Interface (where x is either Network or DTE).   
					Alarm Cleared. Alarm Indication Signal at the x   
					Interface (where x is either Network or DTE).   
					An Excessive Error Rate has been detected at   
					the Network Interface.   
					Alarm Cleared. An Excessive Error Rate at the   
					Network Interface.   
					Yellow Alarm signal received at the x Interface   
					(where x is either Network or DTE).   
					Alarm Cleared. Yellow Alarm signal at the x   
					Interface (where x is either Network or DTE).   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-9   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					SNMP Traps   
					Table 4-4   
					Enterprise-Specific Trap Definitions   
					SNMP traps are unsolicited messages that are sent   
					from the DSU/CSU to an SNMP manager when the   
					DSU/CSU detects certain pre-specified conditions. These   
					traps enable the SNMP manager to monitor the state of   
					the network.   
					Trap Value   
					Event   
					enterpriseClockFail(1)   
					The currently configured   
					master clock source has   
					failed.   
					The SNMP Trap configuration option must be enabled   
					for trap messages to be sent over the communications   
					link. You must specify the number of SNMP managers   
					that are to receive traps from this DSU/CSU, an IP   
					address for each SNMP manager specified, and the type   
					of traps to be sent from this DSU/CSU. For more   
					
					
					Operation.   
					enterpriseSelfTestFail(2)   
					A DSU/CSU hardware   
					failure is detected at   
					self-test. This trap is   
					generated after DSU/CSU   
					initialization.   
					enterpriseDeviceFail(3)   
					enterpriseTestStart(5)   
					An internal DSU/CSU   
					failure is detected by the   
					operating software.   
					A test is initiated.   
					Trap types consist of the following:   
					enterpriseConfigChange(6) A configuration option is   
					changed.   
					• 
					General traps – include warmStart and   
					authenticationFailure. The DSU/CSU sends a   
					warmStart trap after it has been reset to indicate   
					that it has just reinitialized itself. The DSU/CSU   
					sends an authenticationFailure trap when it has   
					received an SNMP protocol message that has not   
					been properly authenticated. These traps are set by   
					the Gen Trap configuration option.   
					enterpriseTestClear(105)   
					A test is concluded.   
					Table 4-5   
					SNMP Trap per Interface   
					• 
					• 
					Enterprise Specific traps – signify that the   
					DSU/CSU has recognized an enterprise-specific   
					
					These traps are set by the Entp Trap configuration   
					option.   
					Interface Trap Meaning   
					T1 Network   
					Up = No alarm or test   
					conditions.   
					Link Traps – identify the condition of the   
					Down = Alarm or test   
					communications interface, either linkDown (one of   
					the communications interfaces has failed) or linkUp   
					(one of the communications interfaces has just   
					come up). These traps are set by the Link Trap   
					configuration option. The communications   
					interfaces for which these traps can be generated   
					are specified by the Trap I/F configuration option.   
					
					conditions.   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					Synchronous Data Ports   
					Up = No alarm or test   
					conditions, and the   
					interface is enabled.   
					Down = Alarm or test   
					conditions, or the interface   
					is disabled.   
					Up = No test conditions,   
					the port is assigned to a   
					network interface, and both   
					CTS and DSR are ON.   
					Down = Test conditions,   
					the port is unassigned, or   
					either CTS or DSR is off.   
					4-10   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					For problems other than those listed in the table, please   
					contact your service representative.   
					Troubleshooting   
					The DSU/CSU is designed to provide you with   
					
					direction if a problem occurs.   
					Table 4-6   
					(1 of 2)   
					Troubleshooting   
					Symptom   
					Possible Cause   
					Solutions   
					No power   
					1. The power module is not securely attached.   
					2. The wall receptacle has no power.   
					1. Check the power module attachment.   
					2. Check the wall receptacle power by plugging   
					in some equipment that is known to be   
					working.   
					Power-Up   
					Self-Test fails   
					The DSU/CSU has detected an internal hardware Contact your service representative.   
					failure.   
					Message LOS at 1. Network cable problem.   
					NET appears   
					1. Check that the network cable is securely   
					attached at both ends.   
					2. No signal is being transmitted at the far-end.   
					2. Check the far-end status.   
					3. Facility problem.   
					3. Contact your facility provider.   
					Message LOS at 1. DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) cable problem.   
					DTE appears   
					1. Check that the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) cable   
					is securely attached at both ends.   
					2. No signal being transmitted from the DTE.   
					2. Check the DTE status.   
					Message OOF at 1. Incompatible framing format between the   
					1. Check that the framing format for the network   
					interface is correct.   
					Net appears   
					network and the DSU/CSU.   
					2. Network cabling problem.   
					2. Check that the network cable is securely   
					attached at both ends.   
					3. Facility problem.   
					3. Contact your facility provider.   
					Message OOF at 1. Incompatible framing format between the   
					1. Check that the framing format for the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface is correct.   
					DTE appears   
					Drop/Insert port on the customer premises   
					equipment and the DSU/CSU.   
					2. DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) cabling problem.   
					1. Network cable problem.   
					2. Check that the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) cable   
					is securely attached at both ends.   
					Message   
					Yellow at Net   
					1. Check that your network cable is securely   
					attached at both ends.   
					appears   
					2. Far-end device has lost framing sync on the   
					line.   
					2. Check the status of the far-end device.   
					3. Facility problem.   
					3. Contact your facility provider.   
					1. Check the status of the DTE.   
					Message   
					DTE has detected an LOS or LOF condition.   
					Yellow at DTE   
					appears   
					2. Check that the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) cable   
					is securely attached at both ends.   
					Message   
					AIS at Net   
					appears   
					1. Upstream device is transmitting an AIS.   
					2. The network is transmitting an AIS.   
					1. Check the status of the upstream device(s).   
					2. Contact your facility provider.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					4-11   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table 4-6   
					(2 of 2)   
					Troubleshooting   
					Symptom   
					Possible Cause   
					Solutions   
					Message   
					AIS at DTE   
					appears   
					DTE is sending an AIS.   
					Check the DTE.   
					Message EER at Facility problem.   
					Contact your facility provider.   
					Net appears   
					BPV LED is ON   
					1. Incompatible line coding format between the   
					DTE and the DSU/CSU.   
					1. Check that the line coding format for the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface is correct.   
					2. DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) cable problem.   
					2. Check that the DTE cable is securely attached   
					at both ends.   
					A failure message Internal DSU/CSU problem.   
					appears followed   
					Record the 8-digit code, then contact your   
					service representative.   
					by an 8-digit code   
					(x x x x x x x x )   
					Mgmt link is down 1. The manager configuration is mismatched with 1. Check that the configurations are matched.   
					the DSU/CSU configuration.   
					2. The manager’s link layer protocol is not   
					running.   
					2. Start the link layer protocol.   
					No SNMP   
					communication   
					1. Cable problem.   
					1. Check that the cable is securely attached at   
					both ends.   
					via the AUX port   
					2. The link layer protocol is not running.   
					2. Change the Aux Use configuration option to   
					None, and then back to SNMP or Daisy (as   
					appropriate).   
					Invalid Number   
					No Dial Tone   
					The modem cannot dial because the phone   
					number is invalid or there is no number in the   
					selected directory.   
					Check that the selected phone number is correct.   
					The modem cannot dial because there is no dial   
					tone.   
					Check that the modem is connected properly.   
					Busy Signal   
					The modem is receiving a busy signal.   
					Redial the phone number later.   
					Redial the phone number later.   
					No Answer Tone   
					The remote end does not answer within   
					45 seconds.   
					Modem In Use   
					The modem is in use.   
					Redial the phone number later.   
					4-12   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Maintenance   
					To change the Mon (Monitor) selection in 2-port and   
					4-port DSU/CSUs,   
					Test Jacks   
					For 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs, six test jacks are   
					
					(Monitor) branch of the menu tree allows you to select   
					either EQPT (Equipment) or NET (Network).   
					1. From the top-level menu, press the   
					key until   
					the Ctrl selection appears on the screen.   
					2. Select Ctrl.   
					NOTE   
					3. From the Control screen, press the   
					key until   
					the Mon selection appears on the screen.   
					The single-port DSU/CSU   
					provides only Network Monitor In   
					and Network Monitor Out test   
					jacks. There is no Mon (Monitor)   
					selection in the menu tree.   
					4. Select Mon.   
					Control:   
					Passwd Mon   
					The 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSU test jack functions are   
					
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. From the Mon Jack screen, press F1 to select   
					EQPT (the default), or press F2 to select NET.   
					NET MON EQPT   
					In   
					In   
					In   
					Mon Jack: EQPT   
					EQPT NET   
					Out   
					Out   
					Out   
					496-14808   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Figure 4-1. Test Jacks (Standalone DSU/CSU)   
					EQPT NET   
					MON   
					In   
					In   
					Out   
					Mon Jack: EQPT   
					Mon Jack: NET   
					(Selectable)   
					TERMINAL   
					EQUIPMENT   
					(DTE)   
					INTERNAL   
					CIRCUITRY   
					LINE   
					RECEIVER   
					LINE   
					RECEIVER   
					NETWORK   
					(Selectable)   
					Mon Jack: EQPT   
					Mon Jack: NET   
					EQPT NET   
					MON   
					Out   
					Out   
					In   
					496-14875   
					Figure 4-2. Test Jack Block Diagram   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					4-13   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table 4-7   
					Test Jack Functions   
					Test Jack Name   
					Function   
					NET In   
					(Network In)   
					A break-in test jack that allows a signal to be inserted toward the network by   
					external test equipment.   
					NET Out   
					(Network Out)   
					A break-in test jack that interrupts the signal coming from the network and allows it   
					to be terminated by the external test equipment.   
					EQPT In   
					(Equipment In)   
					A break-in test jack that allows a signal to be inserted toward the terminal   
					equipment (DTE) by external test equipment.   
					EQPT Out   
					(Equipment Out)   
					A break-in test jack that interrupts the signal coming from the terminal equipment   
					(DTE) and allows it to be terminated by the external test equipment.   
					MON In   
					(Monitor In)   
					A monitor jack that is controlled by the Mon (Monitor) branch of the menu tree. If it is   
					set to EQPT (the default), this jack monitors the signal going into the terminal   
					equipment (DTE). If it is set to NET, this jack monitors the signal going into the   
					network.   
					MON Out   
					(Monitor Out)   
					A monitor jack that is controlled by the Mon (Monitor) branch of the menu tree. If it is   
					set to EQPT (the default), this jack monitors the signal coming from the terminal   
					equipment (DTE). If it is set to NET, this jack monitors the signal coming from the   
					network.   
					4-14   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					Test Commands   
					NOTE   
					The test commands enable you to run loopbacks and   
					test patterns on the DSU/CSU, and to test the front panel   
					LEDs. These tests can help you isolate areas of trouble if   
					you are having problems with your DSU/CSU.   
					The following procedures are   
					examples only. Screen displays   
					may vary depending on the   
					model and configuration of the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					To access all Test commands from the Test branch,   
					press F2 to select Test from the top-level menu screen.   
					DSU ESF   
					Test   
					Sending a Line Loopback Up or Down   
					Stat   
					Cnfig   
					To send a Line Loopback Up or Down sequence on the   
					network to a far-end DSU/CSU,   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Rlpbk.   
					Remote Loopback Tests   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					The Remote Loopback tests enable you to troubleshoot   
					your circuit by sending the following to a far-end device:   
					Ptrns   
					For Networks   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					• 
					Line loopback up activation sequence for   
					10 seconds (LLBUP)   
					3. From the Rem Loopback screen, press F1 to select   
					LLBUP (Line Loopback Up), or press F2 to select   
					LLBDN (Line Loopback Down).   
					• 
					Line loopback down activation sequence for   
					10 seconds (LLBDN)   
					For Channels   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					V.54 activation sequence to initiate a V.54 Loop 2   
					(54UP)   
					Rem Loopback:   
					LLBUP LLBDN 54UP   
					V.54 deactivation sequence to terminate a V.54   
					Loop (54DN)   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					ANSI T1.403 (Annex B) activation sequence to   
					initiate a DCLB on the remote device (FT1UP)   
					The Line Loopback sequence is sent up or   
					downstream to the far-end DSU/CSU for   
					10 seconds. During this time, Sending appears on   
					Line 2 of the LCD, followed by Command   
					Complete when 10 seconds have elapsed.   
					ANSI T1.403 (Annex B) deactivation sequence to   
					terminate a DCLB on the remote device (FT1DN)   
					You cannot perform remote loopbacks if any of the   
					local loopbacks are active. If you attempt to do so, the   
					error message Invld Test Combo (Invalid Test   
					Combination) appears.   
					You can press any function key to restore the Rem   
					Loopback screen without affecting transmission of   
					the loopback code.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-15   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					The Rem Loop screen appears.   
					Sending a V.54/ANSI FT1   
					Activation/Deactivation   
					To send a V.54 or ANSI FT1 Activation or   
					Deactivation loopback sequence to the far-end DSU/CSU,   
					Rem Loop: Type   
					Prt1   
					Prt2 Prt3   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Rlpbk.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The 54UP, 54DN, FT1UP, and FT1DN commands   
					send the requested sequence out the network   
					interface on the DS0 channels allocated to the port   
					you select here.   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the Rem Loop screen, press the desired   
					function key to select the specific port. Use the   
					scroll keys, if necessary.   
					3. From the Rem Loopback screen, press the   
					function key that corresponds to the specific   
					loopback test you want to perform. Use the scroll   
					keys, if necessary.   
					After you select a port, the sequence is sent to the   
					far-end DSU/CSU. During this time, Sending   
					appears on Line 2 of the LCD, followed by   
					Command Complete when the sequence is   
					complete.   
					During the Sending message, you can press the   
					Rem Loopback:   
					LLBUP LLBDN 54UP   
					and   
					keys without affecting transmission   
					of the loopback sequence.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4-16   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					The Line Loopback command can be activated and   
					Local Loopback Tests   
					The Local Loopback tests enable you to conduct circuit   
					testing and fault isolation for the digital line. The   
					supported local loopback tests are:   
					deactivated in response to commands received over the   
					network interface. The Network Interface configuration   
					option NET LLB controls whether the DSU/CSU   
					responds to the commands transmitted on the network   
					
					
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Line Loopback (LLB)   
					Payload Loopback (PLB)   
					DTE Loopback (DLB)   
					The data port configuration option NET DCLB   
					controls whether the DSU/CSU responds to inband V.54   
					commands to initiate DCLB for that port (see   
					
					Repeater Loopback (RLB)   
					Data Channel Loopback (DCLB)   
					Data Terminal Loopback (DTLB)   
					Local loopback tests can be aborted (Abort Command)   
					at any time.   
					No more than two local loopbacks can be active at any   
					one time. An additional restriction prohibits certain   
					loopbacks from running at the same time. Valid loopback   
					
					NOTE   
					DLB does not appear when the   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface is disabled.   
					Table 4-8   
					Valid Loopback Combinations   
					LLB   
					N/A   
					NO   
					PLB   
					NO   
					DLB   
					YES   
					YES   
					N/A   
					RLB   
					YES   
					NO   
					DCLB   
					NO   
					DTLB   
					YES   
					YES   
					YES   
					YES   
					LLB   
					PLB   
					N/A   
					YES   
					NO   
					NO   
					DLB   
					RLB   
					DCLB   
					YES   
					YES   
					NO   
					NO   
					YES   
					NO   
					NO   
					N/A   
					NO   
					NO   
					YES   
					YES   
					(on separate   
					ports)   
					YES   
					(on separate   
					ports)   
					DTLB   
					YES   
					YES   
					YES   
					YES   
					YES   
					(on separate   
					ports)   
					YES   
					(on separate   
					ports)   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-17   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Starting a Line Loopback   
					Starting a Payload Loopback   
					The Line Loopback command (LLB) loops the   
					received signal on the network interface back to the   
					network without change.   
					The Payload Loopback command (PLB) loops the   
					received signal on the network interface back to the   
					network. The signal is looped back as close to the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port as possible (after it has passed   
					through the framing circuitry of the DSU/CSU). Framing   
					CRCs and BPVs are corrected.   
					DSU   
					CSU   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					DTE   
					(DSX-1)   
					ALL   
					1s   
					LLB   
					DSU   
					CSU   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					DTE   
					(DSX-1)   
					ALL   
					1s   
					PLB   
					ALL 1s   
					ALL 1s   
					496-14319-02   
					PORT 2 PORT 1   
					ALL 1s   
					ALL 1s   
					496-14316-02   
					To perform a Line loopback,   
					PORT 2 PORT 1   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					To perform a Payload loopback,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Ptrns   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. From the Loopback screen, select LLB.   
					3. From the Loopback screen, select PLB.   
					Loopback:   
					Abort LLB   
					PLB   
					Loopback:   
					Abort LLB   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					PLB   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Test Started appears on Line 2. If a line loopback   
					is already in progress, the Already Active   
					message appears. If an invalid combination of   
					loopbacks is in progress, the error message Invld   
					
					loopback test combinations).   
					Test Started appears on Line 2. If a Payload   
					loopback is already in progress, the Already   
					Active message appears. If an invalid combination   
					of loopbacks is in progress, the error message   
					
					valid loopback test combinations).   
					4-18   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					Starting a DTE Loopback   
					Starting a Repeater Loopback   
					The DTE Loopback command (DLB) loops the   
					received signal on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port   
					back to the DTE without change.   
					The Repeater Loopback command (RLB) loops the   
					signal being sent to the network back to the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) and data ports. The signal is looped   
					back as close to the network interface as possible (after it   
					has passed through the framing circuitry of the   
					DSU   
					CSU   
					DSU/CSU). Framing CRCs and BPVs are corrected.   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					DTE   
					(DSX-1)   
					DLB   
					ALL 1s   
					DSU   
					CSU   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					DTE   
					(DSX-1)   
					RLB   
					ALL 1s   
					496-14317-02   
					PORT 2   
					PORT 1   
					To perform a DTE loopback,   
					496-14318-02   
					PORT 1   
					PORT 2   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					To perform a Repeater loopback,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					Test:   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. From the Loopback screen, press the   
					the DLB selection appears on the screen.   
					key until   
					3. From the Loopback screen, press the   
					the RLB selection appears on the screen.   
					key until   
					4. Select DLB.   
					4. Select RLB.   
					Loopback:   
					LLB   
					PLB   
					DLB   
					Loopback:   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					PLB   
					DLB   
					RLB   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Test Started appears on Line 2. If a DTE   
					loopback is already in progress, the Already   
					Active message appears. If an invalid combination   
					of loopbacks is in progress, the error message   
					
					valid loopback test combinations).   
					Test Started appears on Line 2. If a Repeater   
					loopback is already in progress, the Already   
					Active message appears. If an invalid combination   
					of loopbacks is in progress, the error message   
					
					loopback test combinations).   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-19   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					5. From the DCLB screen, press the Function key for   
					the port for which you want to perform the data   
					channel loopback. Use the scroll keys, if   
					necessary.   
					Starting a Data Channel Loopback   
					The Data Channel Loopback command (DCLB) loops   
					the data received from the network interface, for all DS0   
					channels allocated to the selected port, back to the   
					network. The loopback occurs after the data passes   
					through the port circuitry but before it is sent out the data   
					port.   
					Loopback: DCLB   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Prt3   
					F3   
					DSU   
					CSU   
					F1   
					F2   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					DTE   
					(DSX-1)   
					Test Started appears on Line 2. If a Data Channel   
					loopback is already in progress, the Already   
					Active message appears. If an invalid combination   
					of loopbacks is in progress, the error message   
					
					valid loopback test combinations).   
					DCLB   
					DCLB   
					ALL 1s   
					ALL 1s   
					496-14315-02   
					PORT 2 PORT 1   
					Starting a Data Terminal Loopback   
					To perform a Data Channel loopback,   
					The Data Terminal Loopback command (DTLB) loops   
					the data received from the selected port, for all DS0   
					channels allocated to the port, back out of the port. This   
					loopback occurs after the data passes through the port   
					circuitry but before it reaches the T1 framer.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					DSU   
					CSU   
					Ptrns   
					ALL 1s   
					NETWORK   
					INTERFACE   
					DTE   
					(DSX-1)   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. From the Loopback screen, press the   
					key until   
					the DCLB selection appears on the screen.   
					DTLB   
					PORT 2   
					DTLB   
					PORT 1   
					496-14314-02   
					4. Select DCLB.   
					To perform a Data Terminal loopback,   
					Loopback:   
					DLB   
					RLB   
					DCLB   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4-20   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					3. From the Loopback screen, press the   
					key until   
					3. From the Loopback screen, select Abort.   
					the DTLB selection appears on the screen.   
					Loopback:   
					4. Select DTLB.   
					Abort LLB   
					PLB   
					Loopback:   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					RLB   
					DCLB DTLB   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the Loopback Abort screen, press the   
					desired Function key to abort All or one specific   
					loopback test. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					5. From the DTLB screen, press the Function key for   
					the port for which you want to perform the data   
					terminal loopback. Use the scroll keys, if   
					necessary.   
					Loopback: Abort   
					All   
					LLB   
					PLB   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Loopback: DTLB   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Prt3   
					If you select ALL, LLB, PLB, DLB, or RLB, skip   
					Step 5.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. From the Abort screen, press the Function key that   
					corresponds to the port for which you want to   
					abort the test. Use the scroll keys, if necessary.   
					Test Started appears on Line 2. If a Data   
					Terminal loopback is already in progress, the   
					Already Active message appears. If an invalid   
					combination of loopbacks is in progress, the error   
					message Invld Test Combo appears (see   
					Abort: Test Name   
					
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Prt3   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Aborting Loopbacks   
					The Abort Loopback command stops all loopback tests   
					or any selected loopback test currently active on the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					When abort is complete, the message Command   
					Complete appears on the Abort screen.   
					To abort one or more loopback tests,   
					NOTE   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Lpbk.   
					If you mistakenly choose to abort   
					a loopback test that is not   
					currently running, a Command   
					Complete message will still   
					display and the loopback that is   
					currently active will still be   
					running. Use the TStat branch to   
					view the test status to determine if   
					the abort was successful.   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-21   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					4. From the Patterns Send screen, press F1 to send a   
					QRSS pattern, F2 to send a 1-in-8 pattern, F3 to   
					send a 511 pattern.   
					Test Patterns   
					Use the Test Pattern commands to send, monitor, and   
					abort test patterns. Available test patterns are:   
					• 
					QRSS – A quasi-random signal source   
					approximating live data that can be monitored for   
					logic errors (on the network and the data ports).   
					Patterns: Send   
					QRSS 1in8 511   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					• 
					• 
					1-in-8 – A test pattern consisting of a one (1)   
					followed by seven zeros (on the network only).   
					511 – A pseudo-random bit sequence (PRBS) that is   
					If you send a 1-in-8 pattern, skip Step 5.   
					511 bits long (on the data ports only). This is a   
					9 
					PRBS 2 –1 test.   
					5. From the Send screen, press the Function key that   
					corresponds to network or the port for which you   
					want to send a test pattern. Use the scroll keys, if   
					necessary. (NET does not appear for the 511   
					pattern.)   
					Sending Test Patterns   
					Use the Send command to start transmission of a test   
					pattern.   
					Only one test pattern can be active at a time on one   
					
					combinations. Valid combinations are identified by YES.   
					Send: Name   
					NET   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To send a test pattern,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Ptrns.   
					The Test Started screen appears.   
					Send: Name and Dest   
					Test Started   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					If the DSU/CSU is already sending the test pattern   
					you selected, the message Already active appears.   
					If you selected an incompatible test pattern   
					combination, the message Invld Test Combo   
					
					3. From the Patterns screen, select Send.   
					Patterns:   
					Abort Send   
					Mon   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4-22   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					Table 4-9   
					Valid Send Test Pattern Combinations   
					QRSS (Network)   
					QRSS (Port)   
					1-in-8 (Network)   
					511 (Port)   
					QRSS (Network)   
					QRSS (Port)   
					N/A   
					NO   
					NO   
					NO   
					NO   
					YES (on   
					separate ports)   
					N/A   
					YES (on   
					separate ports)   
					1 in 8 (Network)   
					511 (Port)   
					NO   
					NO   
					NO   
					N/A   
					N/A   
					NO   
					N/A   
					YES (on   
					separate ports)   
					4. From the Patterns Mon screen, press F1 for QRSS   
					or F2 for 511.   
					Monitoring Test Patterns   
					Use the Monitor command to monitor a QRSS test   
					pattern over all the channels on the network interface, or   
					to monitor QRSS or 511 test patterns on the channels   
					allocated to an individual port.   
					Patterns: Mon   
					QRSS 511   
					This command provides the number of errors detected   
					in the test pattern (5 digits, maximum 99999).   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To monitor a QRSS or 511 test pattern,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Ptrns.   
					5. From the Monitor screen, press the Function key   
					that corresponds to network or the port for which   
					you want to send a test pattern. Use the scroll   
					keys, if necessary. (NET does not appear for the   
					511 pattern.)   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					Monitor: Name   
					NET   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. From the Patterns screen, select Mon.   
					The Monitor screen appears with the error count.   
					If the maximum of 99999 is exceeded, OvrFlw   
					appears instead of the count. If the receiver loses   
					synchronization while the monitor is active, No   
					Sync appears.   
					Patterns:   
					Abort Send   
					Mon   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-23   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Aborting Test Patterns   
					NOTE   
					Use the Abort command to stop all test patterns or any   
					selected test pattern active on the DSU/CSU.   
					If you mistakenly choose to abort a   
					test pattern that is not currently   
					running, a Command Complete   
					message still displays and the test   
					pattern currently active still runs. Use   
					the TStat branch to view the test   
					status to determine if the abort was   
					successful.   
					To abort test patterns,   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					2. From the Test screen, select Ptrns.   
					Test:   
					Rlpbk Lpbk   
					Ptrns   
					5. From the Abort screen, press the Function key that   
					corresponds to the network or port for which you   
					want to abort a test pattern. Use the scroll keys, if   
					necessary.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3. From the Patterns screen, select Abort.   
					Abort: Send or Mon   
					NET   
					Prt1   
					Prt2   
					Patterns:   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					Abort Send   
					Mon   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					The DSU/CSU terminates the selected test pattern   
					and displays the message Command Complete.   
					4. From the Patterns Abort screen, press the desired   
					Function key to abort either All active test   
					patterns, active Send test patterns, or the active   
					Monitor (Mon) test pattern.   
					Patterns: Abort   
					All   
					Send   
					Mon   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					If you select All, the DSU/CSU terminates all   
					active test patterns and displays the message   
					Command Complete. Skip Step 5.   
					4-24   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Maintenance   
					6. When you are satisfied that all LEDs are lighting   
					and the LCD is functioning properly, abort the   
					Lamp test from the Lamp Test screen. If there is   
					no activity on the DSU/CSU front panel for five   
					minutes, the Device Health and Status screen   
					appears automatically. However, the Lamp test   
					remains active until it is aborted.   
					Lamp Test   
					Use the Lamp Test commands to start and stop a test of   
					the DSU/CSU front panel LCD and LEDs.   
					Starting a Lamp Test   
					To start a Lamp test,   
					Aborting a Lamp Test   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Test.   
					To abort the Lamp test,   
					2. From the Test screen, press the   
					key until the   
					1. Display the Lamp Test screen. To do this when the   
					LCD is alternating the Lamp test screens, press   
					any Function key. Otherwise, follow Steps 1   
					through 3 for starting a Lamp test.   
					Lamp selection appears on the screen.   
					3. From the Test screen, select Lamp.   
					Test:   
					Lamp Test:   
					Abort Start   
					Lpbk Ptrns Lamp   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					4. From the Lamp Test screen, select Start.   
					2. From the Lamp Test screen, select Abort.   
					Lamp Test:   
					Abort Start   
					Lamp Test:   
					Abort Start   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					5. The following screens alternately appear on the   
					LCD until you press a Function key to return to   
					the Lamp Test screen. In addition, all LEDs blink.   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					0123456789 : ; < = > ?   
					@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNO   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					4-25   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					3. Select TStat.   
					Displaying DSU/CSU Test   
					Status   
					Status:   
					STest Perf   
					Use the Test Status command to display the active tests   
					for the DSU/CSU. Status messages that can display on the   
					
					TStat   
					F3   
					F1   
					F2   
					To display test status,   
					The Test Status screen appears showing you what   
					tests are active for the DSU/CSU.   
					1. From the top-level menu screen, select Stat.   
					2. From the Status screen, press the   
					TStat selection appears on the screen.   
					key until the   
					Table 4-10   
					Test Status Messages   
					Message   
					Description   
					No Test Active   
					LLB Test Active   
					PLB Test Active   
					DLB Test Active   
					RLB Test Active   
					DCLB on Port n   
					DTLB on Port n   
					QRSS on Net   
					No tests are currently active.   
					The network interface is in Line loopback.   
					The network interface is in Payload loopback.   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port is in DTE loopback.   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port is in Repeater loopback.   
					Port n is in a Data Channel loopback.   
					Port n is in a Data Terminal loopback.   
					A QRSS test pattern is being sent on the network interface.   
					A 1-in-8 test pattern is being sent on the network interface.   
					A QRSS test pattern is being sent to the network on the channels allocated to port n.   
					A 511 test pattern is being sent to the network on the channels allocated to port n.   
					A QRSS test pattern is being monitored on the network interface.   
					A QRSS test pattern is being monitored on the channels allocated to port n.   
					A 511 test pattern is being monitored on the channels allocated to port n.   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port is being held in DTE loopback by the external contact.   
					The Lamp test is currently active.   
					1–8 Test Active   
					QRSS on Port n   
					511 on Port n   
					Mon QRSS, Net   
					Mon QRSS, Port n   
					Mon 511, Port n   
					DLB Test, Extrn   
					Lamp Test Active   
					4-26   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Front Panel Menu   
					A 
					DSU ESF   
					Test   
					Ctrl   
					Stat   
					Cnfig   
					ACO   
					▲ 
					LED   
					Reset Passwd Mon   
					DevHS   
					STest Perf TStat LED ID   
					Rel   
					ClrReg   
					CID   
					DL   
					Call   
					Telco User   
					Prtn T1 Prtn   
					EQPT NET   
					Rlpbk   
					Lpbk Ptrns Lamp   
					Near Far   
					Pass Dial Disc ChDir   
					Cur 24Tot Intvl   
					● 
					User Prt1 Prt2 Prt3 Prt4   
					Near Far   
					Cur 8Tot Intvl   
					Abort Send Mon   
					1 . . 5,A   
					(Directory)   
					1 . . 5,A   
					(Directory)   
					QRSS 511   
					LLBUP LLBDN 54UP 54DN FT1UP FT1DN   
					QRSS1in8 511   
					DTE Prt1 Prt2 Prt3 Prt4   
					Abort LLB PLB DLB RLB DCLB DTLB   
					Load Edit Area From:   
					Activ Cust1 Cust2 Fact1 Fact2   
					Choose Function:   
					Edit   
					Save   
					Activ Cust1 Cust2   
					DTE   
					Port   
					NET   
					Chan   
					Gen   
					User   
					Alarm Mgmt   
					Copy Prt1 Prt2 Prt3 Prt4   
					Port Select :   
					Gen Trap   
					Dsply Clear DTE Prt1 Prt2 Prt3 Prt4   
					All Prt1 Prt2 Prt3 Prt4   
					▲ For Carrier-Mounted DSU/CSUs only   
					For Standalone DSU/CSUs only   
					For 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs only   
					● 
					496-14945   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					A-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Technical Specifications   
					B 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1   
					Overview   
					The technical specifications for the standalone   
					
					specifications for the carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs are   
					listed in Appendix B of the ACCULINK 3151 CSU and   
					3161 DSU/CSU General Information Guide.   
					Table B-1   
					(1 of 2)   
					Models 3160/3164/3165 DSU/CSUs Technical Specifications   
					Specifications   
					Criteria   
					POWER REQUIREMENTS   
					Typical:   
					AC Power Module   
					Refer to the labeling on the ac power module for input requirements   
					Optional:   
					+24 Vdc   
					+20 Vdc to +32 Vdc, 0.50A   
					–38 Vdc to –60 Vdc, 0.25A   
					–38 Vdc to –60 Vdc, 0.25A   
					–48 Vdc   
					–48 Vdc Redundant   
					POWER CONSUMPTION AND   
					DISSIPATION   
					16.0 watts, 55.0 Btu per hour at 115 volts (ac power); 12.0 watts, 41 Btu per hour   
					at +24 and –48 Vdc (dc power)   
					DTE DROP/INSERT   
					(DSX-1) INTERFACE   
					(Models 3160/3164)   
					Physical Interface   
					Framing Format   
					Coding Format   
					DTE Line Equalization   
					Send AIS   
					DB15 socket   
					D4, ESF   
					AMI, B8ZS   
					5 selectable ranges from 0 to 655 feet (0 to 196.5 meters)   
					Selectable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					B-1   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table B-1   
					(2 of 2)   
					Models 3160/3164/3165 DSU/CSUs Technical Specifications   
					Specifications   
					Criteria   
					NETWORK T1 INTERFACE   
					Physical Interface (USA)   
					Physical Interface (Canada)   
					Framing Format   
					RJ48C   
					CA81A using adapter cable   
					D4, ESF   
					AMI, B8ZS   
					Coding Format   
					Line Build-Out (LBO)   
					ANSI PRM   
					0.0 dB, –7.5 dB, –15 dB, –22.5 dB   
					Selectable   
					Bit Stuffing   
					Yellow Alarm Generation   
					FCC Part 68, AT&T TR 62411   
					Selectable   
					LOOPBACKS   
					Standard   
					Additional   
					AT&T TR 54016, AT&T TR 62411, ANSI T1.403.1989   
					RLB (Repeater Loopback), DLB (DTE Loopback), V.54 Loop 2 and   
					Loop 3, ANSI T1.403 Annex B Fractional T1 Loopback   
					PORT INTERFACE   
					Standards   
					Rates   
					EIA 530A, V.35, RS-449, X.21   
					Nx64 – 64K-1.536 Mb   
					Nx56 – 56K-1.344 Mb   
					APPROVALS   
					Refer to the product labeling   
					CLOCKING SOURCES   
					T1 network interface, Port 1, internal clock, or (for Models 3160/3164 DSU/CSUs)   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface or external clock   
					MODEM INTERFACE   
					Physical Interface   
					Rate   
					Integral Dial Modem   
					RJ11C (USA), CA11A (Canada)   
					2400 bps   
					V.22   
					PHYSICAL DIMENSIONS   
					Height   
					Models 3160/3164 DSU/CSUs = 3.90 inches (10.0 cm)   
					Model 3165 DSU/CSU = 2.13 inches (5.4 cm)   
					7.63 inches (19.4 cm)   
					Width   
					Depth   
					12.13 inches (30.8 cm)   
					WEIGHT   
					Models 3160/3164 DSU/CSUs = 3.6 pounds (1.7 kg)   
					Model 3165 DSU/CSU = 2.4 pounds (1.1 kg)   
					ENVIRONMENT   
					Operating Temperature   
					Storage Temperature   
					Relative Humidity Shock and   
					Vibration   
					32°F to 122°F (0°C to 50°C)   
					–4°F to 158°F (–20°C to 70°C)   
					5%—95% (noncondensing)   
					Withstands normal shipping and handling   
					B-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					C 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1   
					DTE Interface Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2   
					Port Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-4   
					Network Interface Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-9   
					Channel Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-11   
					General Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-15   
					User Interface Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-17   
					Alarm Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-25   
					Management Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-28   
					Configuration Worksheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-37   
					• 
					• 
					General Configuration Options   
					Overview   
					The General configuration options configure alarms   
					
					The DSU/CSU configuration option tables contain a   
					list of all configuration options and their available   
					selections. The configuration options are arranged into   
					functional groups:   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					The User Interface configuration options configure   
					and control the DSU/CSU user interfaces   
					
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					DTE Interface Configuration Options   
					The DTE Interface configuration options configure   
					the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface on the   
					
					• 
					• 
					Alarm Configuration Options   
					The Alarm configuration options specify how alarm   
					conditions are handled by the DSU/CSU   
					
					Port Configuration Options   
					The Port configuration options configure the   
					synchronous data ports on the DSU/CSU   
					
					Management Configuration Options   
					The Management configuration options configure   
					the DSU/CSU for SNMP or Telnet access   
					
					Network Interface Configuration Options   
					The Network Interface configuration options   
					configure the network interface on the DSU/CSU   
					
					The configuration tables include a description of each   
					configuration function and its available selections. In the   
					tables, the top line of each configuration option entry   
					indicates the factory default setting.   
					Channel Configuration Options   
					The Channel configuration options configure the   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) and synchronous data   
					port channel allocations on the DSU/CSU   
					
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					C-1   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					DTE Interface   
					NOTE   
					Configuration Options   
					These configuration options are   
					only available for 2-port and   
					4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					Table C-1   
					(1 of 2)   
					DTE Interface Configuration Options   
					DTE Port: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Port. Enables the use of the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port.   
					Enab – Allows the use of the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Disab – Prohibits the use of the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					NOTE: When this configuration option is disabled, you cannot display or configure any other DTE Interface   
					configuration options. If the clock source configuration option is set to DTE, it is changed to NET.   
					DTE Framing: ESF (Factory 1) D4 (Factory 2)   
					Next D4 ESF Prev   
					DTE Line Framing Format. Designates the framing format for the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					D4 – Configures for the D4 framing format.   
					ESF – Configures for the Extended Superframe framing format.   
					DTE Coding: B8ZS (Factory 1) AMI (Factory 2)   
					Next AMI B8ZS Prev   
					DTE Line Coding Format. Designates the line coding format to be used on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					AMI – Uses the Alternate Mark Inversion coding format.   
					B8ZS – Uses the Bipolar 8 Zero Suppression coding format.   
					Equal: 0—133   
					Next 0—133 133—266 266—399 399—533 533—655 Prev   
					DTE Line Equalization. Specifies the DTE line equalization compensation parameters that permit a standard DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) signal to be delivered over a distance of up to 655 feet.   
					C-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-1   
					(2 of 2)   
					DTE Interface Configuration Options   
					Extrn DLB: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					DTE Loopback on External Contact. Allows the control of a DTE Loopback (DLB) by an external contact on the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Enab – Allows the DSU/CSU to begin a DLB when the external contact is closed. The DSU/CSU remains in DLB as long   
					as the contact remains closed.   
					Disab – Prevents the state of the external contact from affecting the operation of DLB.   
					Send Ones: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Send All Ones on DTE Failure. Specifies the action to take on the signal transmitted to the network when a valid signal   
					cannot be recovered from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface (due to an LOS, OOF, or AIS condition).   
					Enab – Sends all ones on the DS0 channels allocated to the network interface when an LOS, AIS, or OOF condition   
					occurs on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Disab – Passes the data unchanged to the network interface channels.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Port Configuration Options   
					Table C-2   
					(1 of 5)   
					Port Configuration Options   
					Port Type: E530 (Factory 1) V.35 (Factory 2)   
					Next E530 V.35 RS449 X.21 Prev   
					Data Port Type. Allows selection of the data port interface type.   
					E530 – Configures the port as an EIA 530A compatible interface. EIA 530A DTEs can be directly connected to a port   
					connector on the back of the DSU/CSU.   
					V.35 – Configures the port as a V.35 compatible interface. V.35 DTEs can be connected to a port connector using an   
					EIA 530A-to-V.35 adapter cable.   
					RS449 – Configures the port as an RS449 compatible interface. RS449 DTEs can be connected to a port connector using   
					an EIA 530A-to-RS449 adapter cable.   
					X.21 – Configures the port as an X.21 compatible interface. X.21 DTEs can be connected to a port connector using an   
					EIA 530A-to-X.21 adapter cable.   
					NOTE: If this configuration option is set to X.21, set the All Ones configuration option to RTS or Disab.   
					Base Rate: Nx64   
					Next Nx64 Nx56 Prev   
					Data Port Base Rate. Allows selection of the base rate for the data port. The data rate for the port is a multiple (from   
					1 to 24) of the base rate specified with this configuration option.   
					Nx64 – Sets the base rate for this port to 64 kbps. The data rate is Nx64 kbps, where N is a number from 1 to 24.   
					Nx56 – Sets the base rate for this port to 56 kbps. The data rate is Nx56 kbps, where N is a number from 1 to 24.   
					Net DCLB: Disab (Factory 1) Both (Factory 2)   
					Next Disab V.54 FT1 Both Prev   
					Network Initiated DCLB. Allows the initiation and termination of a Data Channel Loopback (V.54 loop 2) by the receipt of a   
					V.54 DCLB-actuate sequence or DCLB-release sequence from the network or far-end device. The sequences may be   
					either V.54 or FT1 (ANSI) compliant sequences.   
					Disab – Ignores the DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences for this port.   
					V.54 – Enables DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences that comply with the V.54 standard for ‘‘Inter-DCE signaling   
					for point to point circuits.”   
					FT1 – Enables DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences that comply with the ANSI T1.403, Annex B standard for   
					‘‘In-band signaling for fractional-T1 (FT1) channel loopbacks.”   
					Both – Enables DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences that comply with either the ANSI or V.54 standard. The type   
					of actuate and release sequences do not have to match.   
					C-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-2   
					(2 of 5)   
					Port Configuration Options   
					Port LB: Disab (Factory 1) Both (Factory 2)   
					Next Disab DTLB DCLB Both Prev   
					Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks. Allows the initiation and termination of a local Data Terminal Loopback (DTLB) or remote   
					Data Channel Loopback (DCLB) by the DTE connected to this port. (DTLB is equivalent to a V.54 loop 3, and DCLB is   
					equivalent to a V.54 loop 2.) Control of these loopbacks is through the DTE interchange circuits as specified by the V.54   
					standard.   
					Disab – Disables control of local DTLBs and remote DCLBs by the DTE connected to this port.   
					DTLB – Gives control of the local DTLBs for this port to the DTE attached to this port. This loopback is controlled by the   
					Local Loopback interchange circuit LL (CCITT 141).   
					DCLB – Gives control of the remote DCLBs for the far-end port connected to this port to the DTE attached to this port.   
					This loopback is controlled by the Remote Loopback interchange circuit RL (CCITT 140). The far-end equipment must   
					support in-band V.54 loopbacks.   
					Both – Gives control of local DTLBs and remote DCLBs to the DTE connected to this port.   
					All Ones: Both   
					Next Disab DTR RTS Both Prev   
					Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready. Specifies the conditions on the data port that determine when valid data is not   
					being sent from the DTE. When this condition is detected, all ones are sent to the network on the DS0 channels allocated   
					to the port.   
					Disab – Disables the monitoring of interchange circuits from the DTE connected to this port.   
					DTR – Monitors the DTE Ready interchange circuit CD (CCITT 108/1/2). When DTR is interrupted, all ones are sent to   
					the network.   
					RTS – Monitors the Request-to-Send interchange circuit CA (CCITT 105). When RTS is interrupted, all ones are sent to   
					the network.   
					Both – Monitors both DTR and RTS. If either is interrupted, all ones are sent to the network.   
					NOTE: If the Port Type configuration option is set to X.21, set this configuration option to RTS or Disab.   
					Rcv Yellow: Halt   
					Next None Halt Prev   
					Action on Network Yellow Alarm. Specifies the action taken on this port when a Yellow Alarm is received on the network   
					interface.   
					None – Makes the data port unaffected by Yellow Alarms received on the network interface.   
					Halt – Stops the transmission of data on the port and disables the data port when Yellow Alarms are received on the   
					network interface. When Yellow Alarms are received, all ones are sent on the Received Data interchange circuit BB   
					(CCITT 104). The Clear-to-Send interchange circuit CB (CCITT 106) is interrupted.   
					Tx Clock: Int   
					Next Int Ext Prev   
					Data Port Transmit Clock. Specifies whether the transmitted data for the port is clocked using an internal clock provided   
					by the DSU/CSU (synchronized to the clock source specified by the clock source configuration option in the General   
					configuration option group) or an external clock provided by the DTE connected to the port. When an external clock is   
					used, it must be synchronized to the same clock source as the DSU/CSU.   
					Int – Indicates the clock is provided internally by the DSU/CSU on the TXC interchange circuit DB (CCITT 114).   
					Ext – Indicates the clock is provided externally by the DTE on the XTXC interchange circuit DA (CCITT 113). Use this   
					selection when the clock source is set to this data port.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-2   
					(3 of 5)   
					Port Configuration Options   
					InvertTxC: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Invert Transmit Clock. Specifies whether the clock supplied by the DSU/CSU on the TXC interchange circuit DB   
					(CCITT 114) is phase inverted with respect to the Transmitted Data interchange circuit BA (CCITT 103). This   
					configuration option is useful when long cable lengths between the DSU/CSU and the DTE are causing data errors.   
					Enab – Indicates TXC supplied by the DSU/CSU on this port is phase inverted.   
					Disab – Indicates TXC supplied by the DSU/CSU on this port is not phase inverted.   
					InvrtData: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Invert Transmitted and Received Data. Specifies whether the port’s transmitted data and received data are logically   
					inverted before being transmitted or received. This configuration option is useful for applications where HDLC data is   
					being transported. Inverting the data ensures that the density requirements for the network interface are met.   
					Enab – Indicates the transmitted data and received data for this port are inverted.   
					Disab – Indicates the transmitted data and received data for this port are not inverted.   
					EDL: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Embedded Data Link. Specifies whether Embedded Data Link (EDL) is enabled for a particular port. If EDL is enabled,   
					then 8 kbps of the total bandwidth allocated for this port is not available to the synchronous data port. For example, if the   
					port rate is 256 kbps (4 DS0 channels allocated) and EDL is enabled, then only 248 kbps is available to the port. EDL   
					provides the following: detection of frame synchronization, CRC of the data stream (excluding the 8 kbps EDL), and an   
					in-band data link (4 kbps) between the local and remote units. The 4 kbps in-band data link can be used for performance   
					report messages and as an IP link for SNMP or Telnet sessions.   
					Enab – Indicates the port’s EDL is enabled.   
					Disab – Indicates the port’s EDL is disabled.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: If the local DSU/CSU’s EDL is enabled, then the remote DSU/CSU’s EDL must also be enabled.   
					NOTE: EDL is not recommended for networks in which data is examined for routing purposes (e.g., frame relay, x.25).   
					C-6   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-2   
					(4 of 5)   
					Port Configuration Options   
					Err Rate: 10E-4   
					Next 10E-4 10E-5 10E-6 10E-7 10E-8 10E-9 Prev   
					Port Excessive Error Rate Threshold. Sets the error rate threshold that determines when an Excessive Error Rate (EER)   
					condition is declared for a particular port. The error rate selected by this configuration option is determined by the ratio of   
					the number of CRC5 errors to the total number of bits received over a set period of time.   
					10E-4 – 10E-4 Threshold. For example, at 1536 kbps, EER is declared if more than 1,535 CRC5 errors are detected in a   
					10-second period. It is cleared with less than 1,536 errors in ten seconds.   
					10E-5 – 10E-5 Threshold. For example, at 1536 kbps, EER is declared if more than 921 CRC5 errors are detected in a   
					60-second period. It is cleared with less than 922 errors in sixty seconds.   
					10E-6 – 10E-6 Threshold. For example, at 1536 kbps, EER is declared if more than 92 CRC5 errors are detected in a   
					60-second period. It is cleared with less than 93 errors in sixty seconds.   
					10E-7 – 10E-7 Threshold. For example, at 1536 kbps, EER is declared if more than 9 CRC5 errors are detected in a   
					60-second period. It is cleared with less than 10 errors in sixty seconds.   
					10E-8 – 10E-8 Threshold. For example, at 1536 kbps, EER is declared if more than 41 CRC5 errors are detected in three   
					15-minute intervals. It is cleared with less than 42 errors in three 15-minute intervals.   
					10E-9 – 10E-9 Threshold. For example, at 1536 kbps, EER is declared if more than 4 CRC5 errors are detected in three   
					15-minute intervals. It is cleared with less than 5 errors in three 15-minute intervals.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if EDL is disabled.   
					Near-end: Disab   
					Next Disab Maint Send Both Prev   
					Near-End Performance Statistics. Specifies whether the DSU/CSU maintains near-end performance statistics and sends   
					performance report messages (PRMs) for a particular port.   
					Disab – Disables near-end performance statistics and does not send PRMs.   
					Maint – Maintains near-end performance statistics for this port.   
					Send – Sends PRMs over the port’s EDL every second. Each PRM contains the performance statistics for the previous   
					4 seconds.   
					Both – Maintains near-end performance statistics and sends PRMs over the port’s EDL.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if EDL is disabled.   
					NOTE: If the local DSU/CSU is configured to send near-end performance statistics, then the remote device must be   
					configured to maintain far-end performance statistics.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-2   
					(5 of 5)   
					Port Configuration Options   
					Far-end: Disab   
					Next Disab Maint Prev   
					Far-End Performance Statistics. Specifies whether to monitor for far-end performance report messages (PRMs) and   
					maintain far-end performance registers for a particular port.   
					Disab – Disables far-end performance statistics.   
					Maint – Monitors the port’s EDL for PRMs and maintains far-end performance statistics.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if EDL is disabled.   
					NOTE: If the local DSU/CSU is configured to maintain far-end performance statistics, then the remote device must be   
					configured to send near-end performance statistics.   
					Mgmt Link: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					EDL Management Link. Specifies whether the EDL management link is enabled for a particular port. Selecting Enab   
					allows SNMP or Telnet traffic to flow over the 4 kbps in-band data link provided by EDL.   
					Enab – Enables the port’s EDL management link.   
					Disab – Disables the port’s EDL management link.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if EDL is disabled or the FDL is enabled.   
					NOTE: If the local DSU/CSU’s EDL is enabled, then the remote device’s EDL must also be enabled.   
					C-8   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Network Interface   
					Configuration Options   
					Table C-3   
					(1 of 2)   
					Network Interface Configuration Options   
					NET Framing: ESF (Factory 1) D4 (Factory 2)   
					Next D4 ESF Prev   
					Network Line Framing Format. The framing format to be used on the network interface.   
					D4 – Configures for the D4 framing format.   
					ESF – Configures for the Extended Superframe format.   
					NET Coding: B8ZS (Factory 1) AMI (Factory 2)   
					Next AMI B8ZS Prev   
					Network Line Coding Format. The line coding format to be used on the network interface.   
					AMI – Configures for the Alternate Mark Inversion coding format.   
					B8ZS – Configures for the Bipolar 8 Zero Suppression coding format.   
					LBO: 0.0   
					Next 0.0 –7.5 –15 –22.5 Prev   
					Line Build Out. The line build out (LBO) for the signal transmitted to the network (0.0 dB is the factory default).   
					ANSI PRM: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Generate ANSI Performance Report Messages. Specifies whether ANSI T1.403 compliant performance report   
					messages (PRMs) are generated.   
					Enab – Generates and sends ANSI PRMs over the FDL every second.   
					Disab – Prevents the DSU/CSU from generating ANSI PRMs.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available if the framing format is set to ESF.   
					Mgmt Link: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					FDL Management Link. Specifies whether Facility Data Link (FDL) is enabled. Selecting Enab allows SNMP or Telnet   
					traffic to flow over the 4 kbps data link provided by FDL. Running SNMP or Telnet over FDL requires an end-to-end FDL   
					connection and cannot be terminated within the network.   
					Enab – Enables the FDL management link for SNMP or Telnet.   
					Disab – Disables the FDL management link.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available if the framing format is set to ESF.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if EDL is enabled.   
					NOTE: If the local DSU/CSU’s FDL is enabled, the remote DSU/CSU’s FDL must also be enabled.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-9   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-3   
					(2 of 2)   
					Network Interface Configuration Options   
					NET LLB: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Network Initiated Line Loopback (LLB). Allows initiation and termination of the LLB to be controlled by the receipt of   
					LLB-Actuate and LLB-Release commands from the network (or remote DSU/CSU).   
					Enab – Causes the DSU/CSU to enter an LLB (if the DSU/CSU can perform an LLB in its current state) and to cause an   
					LLB-Release command to terminate the LLB.   
					Disab – Causes the DSU/CSU to ignore LLB-Actuate and LLB-Release commands (the DSU/CSU is not in compliance   
					with ANSI T1.403 and AT&T TR 62411).   
					NOTE: When this configuration option is enabled, the DSU/CSU recognizes the in-band LLB-Actuate and LLB-Release   
					codes specified by AT&T as well as the bit-oriented FDL messages specified by ANSI (for ESF only).   
					NET PLB: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Network Initiated Payload Loopback (PLB). Allows initiation and termination of the PLB to be controlled by the receipt of   
					PLB-Actuate and PLB-Release commands from the network (or remote DSU/CSU).   
					Enab – Causes the DSU/CSU to enter a PLB (if the DSU/CSU can perform a PLB in its current state) and to cause a   
					PLB-Release command to terminate the PLB.   
					Disab – Causes the DSU/CSU to ignore PLB-Actuate and PLB-Release commands (the DSU/CSU is not in compliance   
					with ANSI T1.403 and AT&T TR 54016).   
					NOTE: When this configuration option is enabled, the DSU/CSU recognizes the in-band PLB-Actuate and PLB-Release   
					codes specified by AT&T as well as the bit-oriented FDL messages specified by ANSI.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available when the network interface framing is set to ESF.   
					Bit Stuff: 62411   
					Next 62411 Part68 Disab Prev   
					Bit Stuffing. Determines when bit stuffing is performed to meet the ones density requirements for data transmission on the   
					network. You must choose the maximum number of consecutive zeros the DSU/CSU can receive before it inserts a one.   
					62411 – Specifies that a one be inserted in the data stream after 15 consecutive zeros or when the density of ones falls   
					below 12.5% (complies with AT&T TR 62411).   
					Part68 – Specifies that a one be inserted in the data stream after 80 consecutive zeros (complies with FCC Part 68).   
					Disab – Disables bit stuffing so that ones density is not enforced.   
					NOTE: To comply with Canadian DOC CS-03 regulations, equipment installed in Canada must be configured to select   
					62411.   
					NOTE: To comply with USA Part 68 regulations, equipment installed in the USA must be configured to select Part 68.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available if the network interface line coding format is set to AMI.   
					Circuit Ident:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Network Circuit Identifier. Specifies the transmission vendor’s circuit identifier for the purpose of facilitating   
					troubleshooting. The network circuit identifier is an ASCII text string that may be up to 255 characters in length.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the network circuit identifier using the generic text string entry screen.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the network circuit identifier. The network circuit identifier is set to a null string.   
					C-10   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Channel Configuration   
					Options   
					The Channel configuration options are divided into two   
					tables as follows:   
					NOTE   
					
					DTE channel and data port   
					channel configuration options.   
					
					
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) port is   
					enabled and you are using a   
					2-port or 4-port DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					
					Data Port Channel Configuration Options   
					
					Table C-4   
					DTE Channel Configuration Options   
					DTE Channels:   
					Assign Voice   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Channel. Assigns DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface to DS0 channels   
					on the network interface, and specifies which DS0 channels carry voice signaling information.   
					Assign – Assigns DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface to the network interface.   
					Voice – Specifies which DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface are voice channels and should pass   
					Robbed Bit Signaling (RBS) information to the network interface.   
					N1 N2 N3 N4 N5 N6 N7 N8 N9 N10 N11 N12 N13 N14 N15 ... N24   
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					...   
					– 
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Channel Allocation. Assigns DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface to the   
					network interface.   
					Line 1 displays the 24 channels for the network interface. Line 2 displays what is allocated to the DS0 channel indicated   
					in Line 1. Possible values for Line 2 are:   
					Value Meaning   
					– 
					This DS0 channel is not allocated. You can modify this value on this screen.   
					Prtn This DS0 channel is allocated to port n, where n is a number from 1 to 4. You cannot modify this value   
					on this screen.   
					Dn   
					This DS0 channel is allocated to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface DS0 channel n, where n is a   
					number from 1 to 24. You can modify this value on this screen.   
					Assign DTE channels to network channels by pressing the Function key below the network channel desired. The DTE   
					channel number scrolls up one number each time you press the Function key. Only unassigned DTE channels appear   
					during scrolling.   
					D1   
					D2   
					D3   
					D4   
					D5   
					D6   
					D7   
					D8   
					D9   
					D10   
					D11 D12 D13 ... D24   
					RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS RBS ... RBS   
					Specify DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Voice Channels. Specifies which DS0 channels from the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface are voice channels and should pass Robbed Bit Signaling information to the network interface.   
					Line 1 displays the 24 channels for the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. Line 2 displays whether the DS0 channel   
					indicated in Line 1 is a voice or data channel. Possible values for Line 2 are:   
					Value Meaning   
					RBS This DS0 channel is a voice channel carrying RBS information. When this DS0 channel is assigned to a   
					network DS0 channel, RBS information is preserved across the connection.   
					Data This DS0 channel is a data channel that does not contain RBS information. Signaling is not preserved   
					across the connection.   
					Press the Function key below the desired channel to toggle between RBS and Data.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-11   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-5   
					(1 of 3)   
					Data Port Channel Configuration Options   
					Channel Config:   
					Dsply Clear DTE Prt1 Prt2 Prt3 Prt4   
					_______________________   
					NOTE: The configuration options described in this table are made available by selecting Prt1, Prt2, Prt3, or Prt4   
					
					about the operation of Display and Clear, refer to the Configuring DS0 Channels section in Chapter 3,   
					Operation.   
					Data Port Channel. Allows the assignment of a particular port to DS0 channels on either the network interface, the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, or another port (see the Assign To configuration option below).   
					NOTE: For 2-port DSU/CSUs, only Ports 1 and 2 are available; for 1-port DSU/CSUs, only Port 1 is available, and only   
					the Port Rate configuration option appears if you select this port.   
					Assign To: NET   
					Next NET DTE Prtn Prtn Prtn Prev   
					Data Port Channel Allocation Destination. Allows you to assign this port to DS0 channels on either the network interface,   
					the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, or another port.   
					NET – Assigns this port to DS0 channels on the network interface.   
					DTE – Assigns this port to DS0 channels on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. If the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface is disabled, this selection does not appear.   
					Prtn – Assigns this port to another port, where n is the port number of all available ports except the port selected from the   
					Channel Config screen. For example, if you select Prt1 from the Channel Config screen, Prt2, Prt3, and Prt4 appear for   
					4-port DSU/CSUs. Use this feature to designate a port as a backup port. You can attach an external backup device to   
					Prtn and manually assign the selected port to the backup port (i.e., route data from the selected port to the backup port).   
					When a port is assigned to another port, DSR is turned on. Selecting Prtn and Next takes you directly to the Port Rate   
					configuration option, bypassing the Assign By configuration option. EDL (for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs) does not   
					operate when a synchronous data port is assigned to another synchronous data port. Therefore, if EDL is enabled, it is   
					ignored.   
					NOTE: Changing this configuration option from one T1 interface to the other (NET or DTE) deallocates all DS0 channels   
					assigned to the previous interface.   
					Assign By: Block   
					Next Block ACAMI Chan Prev   
					Data Port Channel Allocation Method. If NET or DTE is selected using the Assign To configuration option, this   
					configuration option designates the method for assigning DS0 channels to the destination T1 interface.   
					Block – Allocates DS0 channels to this port by the block method.   
					ACAMI – Allocates DS0 channels to this port by the Alternate Channel Alternate Mark Inversion method. The difference   
					between block and ACAMI is that the number of channels allocated with ACAMI is double the number needed for the port   
					rate. With ACAMI, every alternate DS0 channel does not carry data from the port but always transmits and receives all   
					ones.   
					Chan – Allocates DS0 channels to this port by the individual channel method.   
					NOTE: Changing this configuration option from one method to another (Block, ACAMI, or Chan) deallocates all DS0   
					channels assigned to either the network interface or the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					C-12   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-5   
					(2 of 3)   
					Data Port Channel Configuration Options   
					Port Rate: 384   
					Next 64 128 192 256 320 384 448 512 576 640 704 768 832 896 960 1024 1088   
					1152 1216 1280 1344 1408 1472 1536 Prev   
					OR   
					Next 56 112 168 224 280 336 392 448 504 560 616 672 728 784 840 896 952   
					1008 1064 1120 1176 1232 1288 1344 Prev   
					Data Port Rate (appears when using the block or ACAMI channel allocation method, or when a synchronous data port is   
					assigned to another synchronous data port). Designates the data rate for the port. Available selections depend on the   
					current base rate configured for the port. The factory default for Nx64 is 384 kbps, and Nx56 is 336 kbps.   
					NOTE: This configuration option does not appear if the individual channel allocation method (Chan) is selected using the   
					Assign By configuration option.   
					NOTE: Changing this configuration option from one rate to another deallocates all DS0 channels assigned to either the   
					network interface or the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					NOTE: When you enable EDL (for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs), 8 kbps of the total bandwidth allocated for this port is   
					not available to the synchronous data port. For example, if you select 256 kbps and EDL is enabled, only   
					248 kbps are available.   
					NOTE: When you enable EDL (for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs) on a synchronous data port and the clock source is set   
					to that synchronous data port, the external device must provide a clock of 8 kbps less than the expected data   
					port rate. For example, if you select 64 kbps, the external clock source must supply a 56 kbps clock signal.   
					NOTE: For the 3164 DSU/CSU there is a hardware limitation that limits the combined bandwidth used by Port 1 and   
					Port 3 to a total of 2048 kbps and the combined bandwidth used by Port 2 and Port 4 to 2048 kbps. Thus, when   
					entering this menu, the rate choices are limited due to this constraint. This limitation only occurs in configurations   
					mapping a port to a port or when mapping ports to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface and to the network.   
					Start At:   
					Next Clear N1 N2 N3 N4 N5 N6 N7 N8 N9 N10 N11 ... N24 Prev   
					OR   
					Start At:   
					Next Clear D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 ... D24 Prev   
					Data Port Channel Allocation (appears for the block and ACAMI methods only). Designates the starting DS0 channel,   
					N1–N24 for the network interface and D1–D24 for the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Available selections are only those DS0 channels that provide enough bandwidth (based on the configured data rate) to   
					be used as a starting channel number.   
					Select the desired starting channel number by pressing the Function key under that number. When you make the   
					selection, the DSU/CSU allocates the correct amount of DS0 channels to support the data rate currently configured for   
					the port.   
					Clear – Deallocates all DS0 channels for this port from the network interface or the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the individual channel allocation method (Chan) is selected using the   
					Assign By configuration option, or if Prtn is selected using the Assign To configuration option.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-13   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-5   
					(3 of 3)   
					Data Port Channel Configuration Options   
					N1 N2 N3 N4 N5 N6 N7 N8 N9 N10 N11 N12 ... N24   
					...   
					Next   
					OR   
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					Prev   
					Prev   
					D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 ... D24   
					-– ...   
					Next   
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					– 
					Data Port Channel Allocation (appears for the individual channel method only). Designates the DS0 channel to allocate to   
					this port, N1–N24 for the network interface and D1–D24 for the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Line 1 displays the 24 channels for the network interface or the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. Line 2 displays what   
					is allocated to the DS0 channel indicated in Line 1. Possible values for Line 2 are:   
					Value Meaning   
					– 
					This DS0 channel is not allocated. You can modify this value on this screen.   
					Prtn   
					This DS0 channel is allocated to port n, where n is a number from 1 to 4. You can modify this value   
					on this screen for this port only.   
					Nn   
					Dn   
					This DS0 channel is allocated to the network interface DS0 channel n, where n is a number from   
					1 to 24. You cannot modify this value on this screen.   
					This DS0 channel is allocated to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface DS0 channel n, where n is a   
					number from 1 to 24. You can modify this value on this screen.   
					Select the channel by pressing the Function key under that number. To deallocate a port, press the Function key under   
					that port number. Pressing the Function key under channels assigned to other ports has no effect.   
					NOTE: The DSU/CSU automatically derives the data rate for the port from the number of DS0 channels allocated.   
					NOTE: For the 3164 DSU/CSU there is a hardware limitation that limits the combined bandwidth used by Port 1 and   
					Port 3 to a total of 2048 kbps and the combined bandwidth used by Port 2 and Port 4 to 2048 kbps. If a   
					selection of Prtn causes this limit to be exceeded, the selection is ignored and the “–” continues to be displayed   
					for the channel.   
					C-14   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					General Configuration Options   
					Table C-6   
					(1 of 2)   
					General Configuration Options   
					Gen Yellow: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Generate Yellow Alarm Signals. Determines whether the DSU/CSU generates Yellow Alarm signals on the network and   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interfaces.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available for 1-port DSU/CSUs or if the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface is   
					disabled. If the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface is disabled, the DSU/CSU always generates the Yellow Alarm   
					signal on the network interface.   
					Enab – Generates the Yellow Alarm signal for both the network and DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interfaces.   
					Disab – Disables the Yellow Alarm signal. When this configuration option is disabled, Yellow Alarm conditions on the   
					network interface cause an AIS signal to be transmitted on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					NOTE: When this configuration option is disabled, the DTE equipment connected to the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface is responsible for generation of the Yellow Alarm signal on the network interface. In this case, the   
					interface port marked DTE must only be connected to an FCC Part 68 Registered (for USA) and Canadian DOC   
					Certified (for Canada) Digital Service Unit or System, such as PBX, with a DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Failure to do so is a violation of FCC Rules or DOC Regulations.   
					Clock Src: NET   
					Next NET DTE Prt1 Int Ext Prev   
					DSU/CSU Clock Source. Specifies the master clock source for the DSU/CSU. This selection synchronizes all internal   
					timing and external interface clocks. The clock rate(s) for the external timing interfaces are independent of the input rate   
					for the master clock. Failure of the clock specified by the Clock Source selection results in automatic fallback to internal   
					clock.   
					NET – Configures the network interface as the master clock source.   
					DTE – Configures the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface as the master clock source. This selection is not available for   
					1-port DSU/CSUs or if the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface is disabled. If the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface is   
					disabled after making this selection, the master clock source is changed to NET.   
					Prt1 – Configures data port 1 as the master clock source. This is the only synchronous data port you can use for the   
					master clock. If you enable EDL if for Port 1 and the DSU/CSU Clock Source is set to Prt1, the external device must   
					provide clocking of 8 kbps less than the expected data port rate. For example, if you select 64 kbps, the external clock   
					must supply a 56 kbps clock signal.   
					Int – Configures the internal clock as the master clock source.   
					Ext – Configures an external clock (provided through the Clock In connector) as the master clock source. This selection   
					is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					Clock Rate: 1544   
					Next 2048 1544   
					8 
					Prev   
					External Clock Rate. Specifies the clock rate when the master clock source is configured for external clock (Ext). This   
					configuration option does not appear when the clock source is not an external clock.   
					2048 – Sets the input rate of the external clock to 2,048 kHz.   
					1544 – Sets the input rate of the external clock to 1,544 kHz.   
					8 – Sets the input rate of the external clock to 8 kHz.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available on 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: External clock rate 2,048 kHz does not imply E1 compatibility.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-15   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-6   
					(2 of 2)   
					General Configuration Options   
					Tst Timeout: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Test Timeout. Specifies whether user-initiated loopback and pattern tests have durations that are specified by the   
					Tst Duration configuration option.   
					Enab – Loopback and pattern tests initiated on the DSU/CSU have specified durations.   
					Disab – Disables test timeout. The tests are terminated manually.   
					NOTE: For DSU/CSUs that are remotely managed through an inband data stream such as EDL or FDL, the   
					recommended setting is Enab. If tests are inadvertently left in the active state, the Enab setting will allow the test   
					to timeout (terminate) after a specified time.   
					Tst Duration: 10   
					Next Up Down Save Prev   
					Test Duration. Specifies the duration (1 to 120 minutes) of user-initiated loopback and pattern tests. (The Tst Timeout   
					configuration option must be set to Enab.) Use the left or right arrow key to position the cursor on the digit you want to   
					change. Use the Function keys (Up or Down) to increment or decrement the digit.   
					Up – Increments the test duration.   
					Down – Decrements the test duration.   
					Save – Stores the test duration.   
					C-16   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					User Interface   
					NOTE   
					Configuration Options   
					A circular symbol (F) identifies   
					configuration options that are   
					available on standalone   
					DSU/CSUs only. A triangular   
					symbol (Y) identifies   
					configuration options that are   
					available on carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs only.   
					Table C-7   
					(1 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					Self-Test: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Initial Self-Test. Specifies whether the DSU/CSU performs a device self-test at power-up and after a device reset.   
					Enab – Enables a self-test.   
					Disab – Disables the self-test.   
					FP Access: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Front Panel Access. Determines whether front panel access or display is allowed at the DSU/CSU.   
					Enab – Allows the front panel to access and display data.   
					Disab – Prevents the access and display of data.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					FP Pass: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Front Panel Pass-Through. Allows dial-out access to a remote DSU/CSU using the front panel pass-through operation.   
					Enab – Allows dial-out access to a remote DSU/CSU.   
					Disab – Prevents dial-out access to a remote DSU/CSU.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Dial-In: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Dial-in Access. Allows dial-in access to the DSU/CSU. For standalone DSU/CSUs, dial-in access is through the modem   
					port. For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, dial-in access is through an external device that is connected to the communication   
					port.   
					Enab – Allows dial-in access to the DSU/CSU.   
					Disab – Prevents dial-in access. Incoming calls to the DSU/CSU are not answered.   
					NOTE: To enable Dial-In for carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, the external device must be configured for automatic answer   
					and the ComExtDev configuration option must be enabled.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-17   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-7   
					(2 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					Password: None   
					Next None Com Modem Both Prev   
					Password Mode. Activates a password prompt that prevents access until a password is entered.   
					None – Does not require a password.   
					Com – Prompts the communications port user to enter a password.   
					Modem – Prompts the remote modem port user to enter a password.   
					Both – Prompts both the communications port user and the remote modem port user to enter a password.   
					Com Port: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Setting the Carrier Communication Port. Enables the use of the communication port in carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs.   
					Enab – This communication port is enabled.   
					Disab – The communication port is disabled.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					Com Use: ASCII   
					Next Mgmt ASCII Daisy Term Prev   
					Communication Port Use. Specifies how the communication port is used.   
					Mgmt – Configures the communication port as the link to an SNMP or Telnet system.   
					ASCII – Configures the communication port as a proprietary ASCII port supporting Front Panel Emulation software and   
					ASCII alarm messages. Only one ASCII communication port is allowed per 3000 Series carrier.   
					Daisy – Configures the communication port as an SNMP or Telnet port that is daisy chained to the auxiliary port of an   
					another 31xx Series device. This selection is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only.   
					Term – Configures the communication port as the interface to an async terminal.   
					ComExtDev: Disab   
					Next Disab AT Other Prev   
					Carrier Communication Port’s External Device Commands. Specifies the communication port’s external device   
					commands. When this configuration option is disabled, no commands are sent out the communication port. Select AT to   
					have standard attention (AT) commands sent out the communication port to control the external device. Select Other to   
					configure the connect prefix, the connect indication string, the escape sequence, the escape sequence delay, and the   
					disconnect string.   
					Disab – Allows no commands to be sent out the communication port.   
					AT – Allows standard AT commands to be sent out the communication port.   
					Other – Allows user configurable commands to be sent out the communication port.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the communications port is disabled.   
					NOTE: Carrier Detect (CD) is used to detect that the external device’s connection is lost. Therefore, do not allow the CD   
					lead to be forced on by the external device.   
					NOTE: The external device should be strapped to ignore Data Terminal Ready (DTR).   
					C-18   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-7   
					(3 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					ComConnPrefix:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Carrier Communication Port Connect Prefix. Specifies the connect prefix to the dial directory phone number. When you   
					make a connection or the DSU/CSU automatically makes a connection (dial-out alarms or traps) through the   
					communication port, the connect prefix and the dial directory phone number are used to establish the connection. The   
					connect prefix is an ASCII text string and may be up to 20 characters in length. If the connect prefix is NULL, then no   
					connect prefix is used.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the connect prefix using the generic text string entry screen.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the connect prefix. The connect prefix is set to a null string.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the ComExtDev configuration option is set to AT or the   
					communication port is disabled.   
					NOTE: If ComExtDev is configured for Other and the external device requires characters after the dial phone number,   
					you must append the characters to the phone number.   
					ComConnected:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Carrier Communication Port Connect Indication String. Specifies the communication port’s connect indication string.   
					When you make a connection or the DSU/CSU automatically makes a connection (dial-out alarms or traps) through the   
					communication port, this string determines that the connection has been established. The connect indication string is an   
					ASCII text string and may be up to 20 characters in length. If the connect indication string is not received within 1 minute,   
					it will time-out the connection. If the connect indication string is NULL, the communication port’s receive data stream is   
					not searched and a transition in the Carrier Detect (CD) lead is used to determine that a connection has been   
					established.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the case-sensitive connect indication string using the generic text string entry   
					screen.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the connect indication string. The connect indication string is set to a null string.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the ComExtDev configuration option is set to AT or the communication   
					port is disabled.   
					ComEscapeSeq:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Carrier Communication Port Escape Sequence. Specifies the communication port’s escape sequence. Once the external   
					device connection has been established, either you or the DSU/CSU can command the external device to disconnect.   
					Before doing so, you may need to send the escape sequence out to switch the external device into command mode. The   
					escape sequence is an ASCII text string and may be up to 20 characters in length. If the escape sequence is NULL, no   
					escape sequence is sent out.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the escape sequence using the generic text string entry screen.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the escape sequence. The escape sequence is set to a null string.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the ComExtDev configuration option is set to AT or the communication   
					port is disabled.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-19   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-7   
					(4 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					ComEscDel: None   
					Next None 0.2s 0.4s 0.6s 0.8s 1.0s Prev   
					Carrier Communication Port Escape Sequence Delay. Specifies the delay used while sending the communication port   
					escape sequence. Use the communication port escape delay to specify the delay before sending the first character of the   
					escape sequence and the delay after the last character of the escape sequence. During the delay, no data is sent out the   
					communication port.   
					None – No communication port escape sequence delay.   
					X.Xs – The delay used during the communication port escape sequence (where X.X is 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, or 1.0 seconds).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the ComExtDev configuration option is set to AT or the communication   
					port is disabled.   
					NOTE: ComEscDel must be configured for a delay greater than or equal to the escape guard time required by the   
					external device.   
					ComDisconnect:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Carrier Communication Port Disconnect String. Specifies the communication port’s disconnect string. The communication   
					port’s disconnect string is sent to the external device if either you or the DSU/CSU wants to command the external device   
					to disconnect. The external device must be in command mode before this command can be sent, so the escape   
					sequence will always be sent before the disconnect string. The disconnect string is an ASCII text string and may be up to   
					20 characters in length. If the disconnect string is NULL, then no disconnect string is sent out.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the disconnect string using the generic text string entry screen.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the disconnect string. The disconnect string is set to a null string.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the ComExtDev configuration option is set to AT or the   
					communication port is disabled.   
					Com Type: Async   
					Next Async Sync Prev   
					Communication Port Type. Specifies whether the communication port uses synchronous or asynchronous operation when   
					it is configured as the SNMP management link.   
					Async – Configures the communication port for asynchronous operation.   
					Sync – Configures the communication port for synchronous operation.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the Com Use configuration option is set to ASCII, Daisy, or Term. In   
					these cases, the communication port is always asynchronous.   
					Com Clk: Int   
					Next Int Ext Prev   
					Communication Port Synchronous Clock. Specifies whether the communication port uses internal or external clocking   
					when it is configured for synchronous operation.   
					Int – Configures the communication port for internal clocking.   
					Ext – Configures the communication port for external clocking.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the Com Type configuration option is set to Async.   
					C-20   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-7   
					(5 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					Com Rate: 9.6   
					Next 1.2 2.4 4.8 9.6 14.4 19.2 38.4 Prev   
					Communication Port Rate. Configures the bit rate for the communication port.   
					1.2 – Sets the bit rate to 1200 bps (for asynchronous operation only).   
					2.4 – Sets the bit rate to 2400 bps.   
					4.8 – Sets the bit rate to 4800 bps.   
					9.6 – Sets the bit rate to 9600 bps.   
					14.4 – Sets the bit rate to 14,400 bps.   
					19.2 – Sets the bit rate to 19,200 bps.   
					38.4 – Sets the bit rate to 38,400 bps. This rate is not supported for carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the communication port is configured for synchronous operation and   
					the clock source is external.   
					Char Length: 8   
					Next   
					7 
					8 
					Prev   
					Communication Port Character Length. Configures the character length (7 or 8 bits) for the communication port.   
					NOTE: This configuration option must be set to 8 if the communication port is used as the network communication link.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the communication port is configured for synchronous operation.   
					CParity: None   
					Next None Even Odd Prev   
					Communication Port Parity. Configures the parity (none, even, or odd) for the communication port.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the communication port is configured for synchronous operation.   
					CStop Bits: 1   
					Next   
					1 
					1.5   
					2 
					Prev   
					Communication Port Stop Bits. Configures the number of stop bits (1, 1.5, or 2) for the communication port.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the communication port is configured for synchronous operation.   
					Ignore DTR: No   
					Next Yes No Prev   
					Communication Port Ignore DTR State. Specifies whether the DSU/CSU ignores the state of the Data Terminal Ready   
					(DTR) input to the communication port.   
					Yes – DTR is ignored.   
					No – DTR is not ignored.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the communication port is configured for synchronous operation.   
					CmInActTm: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Communication Port Inactivity Timeout. Specifies whether the communication port disconnects after a period of inactivity   
					specified by the CmDiscTm configuration option.   
					Enab – The communication port disconnects after the period of inactivity specified by the CmDiscTm configuration option.   
					Disab – The communication port does not disconnect due to inactivity.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-21   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-7   
					(6 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					CmDiscTm: 5   
					Next Up Down Save Prev   
					Communication Port Disconnect Time. Specifies the period of time (1 to 60 minutes) before the communication port   
					disconnects due to inactivity. (The CmInActTm configuration option must be set to Enab.) Use the left or right arrow key to   
					position the cursor on the digit you want to change. Use the Function keys (Up or Down) to increment or decrement the   
					digit.   
					Up – Increments the time delay.   
					Down – Decrements the time delay.   
					Save – Stores the time delay for use with inactivity disconnects.   
					Modem Use: ASCII   
					Next Mgmt ASCII Term Prev   
					Modem Port Use. Specifies how the modem port is used.   
					Mgmt – Configures the modem port as the link to an SNMP or Telnet system.   
					ASCII – Configures the modem port as a proprietary ASCII port. This selection supports dial-out ASCII alarm messages   
					and dial-in/dial-out front panel access.   
					Term – Configures the modem port as the interface to an async terminal.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Modem Type: Async   
					Next Async Sync Prev   
					Modem Type. Specifies whether the port uses synchronous or asynchronous communication if the modem port is   
					configured as the SNMP management link.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the Modem Use configuration option is set to ASCII. In this case, the   
					modem port is always asynchronous.   
					Modem Rate: 2.4   
					Next 1.2 2.4 Prev   
					Modem Port Rate. Configures the bit rate for the modem port.   
					1.2 – Sets the bit rate at 1200 bps.   
					2.4 – Sets the bit rate at 2400 bps.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					MChar Len: 8   
					Next   
					7 
					8 
					Prev   
					Modem Character Length. Configures the character length (number of data bits) for the modem port. This does not   
					include the start bit (always 1) or the stop bits; 8 is the factory default.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					NOTE: This option must be set to 8 to perform PC emulation or pass-through operations, or SNMP management.   
					MParity: None   
					Next None Even Odd Prev   
					Modem Parity. Configures the parity for the modem port. None is the factory default.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					C-22   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-7   
					(7 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					MStop Bits: 1   
					Next   
					1 
					2 
					Prev   
					Modem Port Stop Bits. Configures the number of stop bits for the modem port; 1 is the factory default.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					LSpaceDsc: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Long Space Disconnect. Specifies how the modem disconnects a call. This makes call disconnecting more robust and   
					prevents invalid data at the remote modem if the call is disconnected. To be effective, the remote modem must be   
					configured to disconnect if it detects continuous space.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the modem port is configured as an SNMP management link and the   
					link is configured for synchronous operation.   
					MInActTm: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Modem Port Inactivity Timeout. Specifies whether the modem port disconnects after a period of inactivity specified by the   
					MDiscTm configuration option.   
					Enab – The modem port disconnects after the period of inactivity specified by the MDiscTm configuration option.   
					Disab – The modem port does not disconnect due to inactivity.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					MDiscTm: 5   
					Next Up Down Save Prev   
					Modem Port Disconnect Time. Specifies the period of time (1 to 60 minutes) before the modem port disconnects due to   
					inactivity. (The MInActTm configuration option must be set to Enab.) Use the left or right arrow key to position the cursor   
					on the digit you want to change. Use the Function keys (Up or Down) to increment or decrement the digit.   
					Up – Increments the time delay.   
					Down – Decrements the time delay.   
					Save – Stores the time delay for use with inactivity disconnects.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Aux Use: None   
					Next None Mgmt Daisy Prev   
					Auxiliary Port Use. Specifies how the auxiliary port is used. The auxiliary port only supports Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP)   
					with the following parameters: type is asynchronous, character length is 8, parity is none, and stop bit is 1.   
					None – Specifies that the auxiliary port is not to be used.   
					Mgmt – Configures the auxiliary port as the link to an SNMP manager or Telnet client via an external LAN Adapter.   
					Daisy – Configures the auxiliary port as an SNMP or Telnet port that is daisy chained to the communication port of an   
					another 31xx Series device.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-23   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-7   
					(8 of 8)   
					User Interface Configuration Options   
					Aux Rate: 19.2   
					Next 9.6 14.4 19.2 38.4 Prev   
					Auxiliary Port Rate. Configures the bit rate for the auxiliary port.   
					9.6 – Configures the auxiliary port rate as 9600 bps.   
					14.4 – Configures the auxiliary port rate as 14,400 bps.   
					19.2 – Configures the auxiliary port rate as 19,200 bps.   
					38.4 – Configures the auxiliary port rate as 38,400 bps.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					TnSession: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Telnet Session Enable. Specifies whether the DSU/CSU responds to Telnet session requests.   
					Enab – The DSU/CSU responds to Telnet session requests.   
					Disab – The DSU/CSU does not respond to Telnet session requests.   
					TnPaswd: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Telnet Password Mode. Specifies whether a password is required for Telnet access.   
					Enab – A password is required for Telnet access.   
					Disab – A password is not required for Telnet access.   
					TnInActTm: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Telnet Inactivity Timeout. Specifies whether the Telnet session disconnects after a period of inactivity specified by the   
					TnDiscTm configuration option.   
					Enab – The Telnet session disconnects after the period of inactivity specified by the TnDiscTm configuration option.   
					Disab – The Telnet session does not disconnect due to inactivity.   
					TnDiscTm: 5   
					Next Up Down Save Prev   
					Telnet Disconnect Time. Specifies the period of time (1 to 60 minutes) before the Telnet session disconnects due to   
					inactivity. (The TnInActTm configuration option must be set to Enab.) Use the left or right arrow key to position the cursor   
					on the digit you want to change. Use the Function keys (Up or Down) to increment or decrement the digit.   
					Up – Increments the time delay.   
					Down – Decrements the time delay.   
					Save – Stores the time delay for use with inactivity disconnects.   
					C-24   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Alarm Configuration Options   
					NOTE   
					A triangular symbol (Y) identifies   
					a configuration option that is   
					available on carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs only.   
					Table C-8   
					(1 of 3)   
					Alarm Configuration Options   
					Alrm Msg: Disab   
					Next Disab Modem Com Both Prev   
					Alarm Messages. Controls the generation of alarm messages, which are routed to an ASCII terminal or printer attached to   
					the communication port and/or the modem port.   
					Disab – Prevents an alarm message for any alarm conditions.   
					Modem – Enables alarm messages routed to the modem port. This selection does not appear on carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs.   
					Com – Enables alarm messages routed to the communication port.   
					Both – Enables alarm messages routed to both the modem and communication ports. This selection does not appear on   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs.   
					NOTE: Alarm messages are only sent to the communication port if the Com Use configuration option is set to ASCII,   
					otherwise the alarm messages are discarded.   
					SNMP Trap: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					SNMP Trap Enable. Specifies whether SNMP trap messages are sent over the SNMP management link.   
					Enab – Enables sending SNMP trap messages from this unit over any SNMP management link.   
					Disab – Disables sending SNMP trap messages from this unit over any SNMP management link.   
					NOTE: For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs that have the communication port enabled, the only traps that are disabled are   
					those that pertain to this particular unit. Traps from other units are passed through.   
					Trap Disc: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					SNMP Trap Disconnect. Specifies whether the modem connection or carrier external communication port device   
					connection is disconnected after sending a trap message. This configuration option applies only to modem connections or   
					carrier external communication port device connections initiated as a result of the trap message being sent.   
					Enab – Specifies that the modem call or carrier external communication port device call is disconnected after a trap   
					message is sent.   
					Disab – Specifies that the modem call or carrier external communication port device call is not disconnected after a trap   
					message is sent. The line is held until it is manually disconnected or disconnected by the remote modem.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is only available if SNMP traps are enabled and the integral modem or the carrier   
					external communication port device is enabled and configured as an SNMP management link.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-25   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-8   
					(2 of 3)   
					Alarm Configuration Options   
					DialOut: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Alarm and Trap Dial Out. Controls whether generated alarm or trap messages initiate a call if the integral modem   
					connection or carrier external communication port device connection has not already been established. When enabled, a   
					call is placed to the phone number contained in the alarm directory (directory A). If the call cannot be completed and the   
					retry option is enabled, the alarm or trap message is held until the call is completed or the maximum (five) retry count has   
					been exceeded. If more than one alarm message is received while waiting for a call retry, only the highest priority alarm   
					message received is held; all previous messages are discarded. When the modem port is configured as the SNMP   
					management link, up to 10 SNMP trap messages can be queued at the interface.   
					Enab – Enables automatic call initiation (dial out) if an alarm or trap message needs to be sent.   
					Disab – Disables automatic call initiation. Trap messages sent to the modem port or carrier external communication port   
					device are queued (held) if an integral modem connection or carrier external communication port device connection has   
					not been previously established. Alarm messages are not queued.   
					NOTE: For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, this configuration option is only available if the communication port is enabled   
					for an external device.   
					Call Retry: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Call Retry on Alarm or Trap. Determines whether a call that cannot complete (busy, no answer, etc.) is retried. This   
					affects calls that are initiated in attempting to send an alarm or trap message to the modem port or carrier external   
					communication port device. If call retry is specified, the DSU/CSU attempts to complete the call after a configurable delay.   
					Enab – Enables call retry. If enabled the call is retried up to a maximum of five times per alarm or trap message. A delay   
					as specified by the dial-out delay time is imposed between call attempts. If an alternate dial-out directory is specified, both   
					the alarm directory as well as the alternate directory are retried up to five times.   
					Disab – Disables call retry. If a call setup cannot be completed it is not retried.   
					NOTE: For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, this configuration option is only available if the communication port is enabled   
					for an external device.   
					Dial Delay: 5   
					Next   
					1 
					2 
					3 
					4 
					5 
					6 
					7 
					8 
					9 
					10 Prev   
					Dial Out Delay Time on Alarm or Trap. Specifies the number of minutes to wait between successive dial-out alarms or   
					traps and between retry attempts after failed alarm dial-outs. The factory default is 5 minutes.   
					NOTE: For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, this configuration option is only available if the communication port is enabled   
					for an external device.   
					AltDialDir: None   
					Next None   
					1 
					2 
					3 
					4 
					5 
					Prev   
					Alternate Dial-Out Directory for Alarm or Trap. Specifies whether a call that cannot be completed (busy, no answer, etc.)   
					is retried using an alternate phone number. This affects calls that are initiated in an attempt to send an alarm or trap   
					message to the modem port or carrier external communication port device. The alternate phone number to try is   
					contained in one of the five call directories. If call retry is enabled, the initial call is retried at the original number five times   
					before a call attempt to the alternate number is tried. If the call does not complete at the alternate number, it is also retried   
					up to the five-retry maximum. The alternate dial-out option applies to each alarm/trap event. Once a call for an alarm/trap   
					message either completes or fails all retry attempts, the next alarm/trap attempts to establish a call to the phone number   
					contained in the alarm directory.   
					None – Specifies that alternate alarm dial-out is not performed if a call cannot be completed to the telephone number   
					contained in the alarm directory.   
					1–5 – Specifies the call directory that contains the phone number to call if a call cannot be completed to the telephone   
					number contained in the alarm directory.   
					NOTE: For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, this configuration option is only available if the communication port is enabled   
					for an external device.   
					C-26   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-8   
					(3 of 3)   
					Alarm Configuration Options   
					Err Rate: 10E-4   
					Next 10E-4 10E-5 10E-6 10E-7 10E-8 10E-9 Prev   
					Excessive Error Rate Threshold. Sets the error rate threshold that determines if an Excessive Error Rate (EER) condition   
					is declared. This rate is determined by the ratio of the number of CRC6 errors to the total number of bits received over a   
					set period of time.   
					Select from the following:   
					10E-4 – EER is declared if more than 1,535 CRC6 errors are detected within 10 seconds (factory default).   
					10E-5 – EER is declared if more than 921 CRC6 errors are detected within 60 seconds.   
					10E-6 – EER is declared if more than 92 CRC6 errors are detected within 60 seconds.   
					10E-7 – EER is declared if more than 9 CRC6 errors are detected within 60 seconds.   
					10E-8 – EER is declared if more than 41 CRC6 errors are detected in three 15-minute intervals.   
					10E-9 – EER is declared if more than 4 CRC6 errors are detected in three 15-minute intervals.   
					AlrmRelay: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Alarm Relay. Specifies whether an alarm condition for this circuit card activates the shared alarm relay on the 3000 Series   
					Carrier. The alarm deactivates if the condition(s) causing it is corrected. An Alarm Cut-Off issued from the SDCP (or PC   
					Emulation program) for a particular carrier-mounted DSU/CSU also deactivates the alarm. The carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSU does not reactivate the alarm relay until all alarm conditions for the unit are cleared.   
					The following alarm conditions activate the alarm relay if this configuration option is enabled:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Continuous Loss of Signal (LOS) or Out of Frame (OOF) at the network or DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Continuous Out of Frame (OOF) at any synchronous data port that has the Embedded Data Link enabled.   
					Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) received at either the network or DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Yellow alarm signal received at either the network or DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Excessive Error Rate (EER) detected at the network interface.   
					An Excessive Error Rate (EER) detected at any synchronous data port that has the Embedded Data Link enabled.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-27   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Management Configuration   
					Options   
					The Management configuration options are divided   
					into two tables as follows:   
					NOTE   
					A circular symbol (F) identifies   
					configuration options that are   
					available on standalone   
					DSU/CSUs only. A triangular   
					symbol (Y) identifies   
					• 
					General Management Configuration Options   
					
					configuration options that are   
					available on carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs only.   
					• 
					Management Trap Configuration Options   
					
					Table C-9   
					(1 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					SNMP Mgt: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					SNMP Management Enable. Specifies whether the DSU/CSU responds to SNMP session requests.   
					Enab – The DSU/CSU responds to SNMP session requests.   
					Disab – The DSU/CSU does not respond to SNMP session requests.   
					NMS Valid: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					NMS IP Validation. Specifies whether the DSU/CSU validates (for security reasons) the IP address of an SNMP manager   
					attempting to access the DSU/CSU. Allowable addresses are specified using the NMS n IP Adr configuration option.   
					Enab – The DSU/CSU validates the IP address of SNMP management systems attempting to access the DSU/CSU.   
					Disab – The DSU/CSU does not validate the IP address of SNMP management systems.   
					Num Sec Mgrs: 1   
					Next   
					1 
					2 
					3 
					4 
					5 
					6 
					7 
					8 
					9 
					10 Prev   
					Number of Security Managers. Specifies the number of SNMP managers that are allowed to access the DSU/CSU.   
					NOTE: You must configure an IP address for each SNMP manager that is allowed access to the DSU/CSU. Allowable   
					addresses are specified using the NMS n IP Adr configuration option.   
					NMS n IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					NMS Manager n IP Address. Specifies the allowable IP address of an SNMP manager attempting to access the   
					DSU/CSU. The manager number (n) is specified by the Num Sec Mgrs configuration option.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the allowable IP address for the SNMP manager.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the allowable IP address for the SNMP manager. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					C-28   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-9   
					(2 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					NMS n Access: Read   
					Next Read R/W Prev   
					NMS Manager n Access Type. Specifies the allowable type of access for an SNMP manager attempting to access the   
					DSU/CSU’s MIB using community name 1.The manager number (n) is specified by the Num Sec Mgrs configuration   
					option.   
					Read – Allows read-only access (SNMP Get) to the accessible objects in the MIB for this device when community   
					name 1 is used. This includes all objects specified as either read-only or read/write in the MIB RFCs.   
					R/W – Allows read and write access (SNMP Get and Set) to the objects in the MIB for this device when community   
					name 1 is used. Write access is allowed for all objects specified as read/write in the MIB RFCs. Read access is allowed   
					for all objects specified as either read-only or read/write.   
					System Name:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					System Name. Specifies the system name for this unit. This is the name of this SNMP-managed node.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the system name.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the system name.   
					System Location:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					System Location. Specifies the system location for this unit. This is the physical location of this SNMP-managed node.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the system location.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the system location.   
					System Contact:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					System Contact. Specifies the system contact person for this unit, and how to contact this person.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the system contact.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the system contact.   
					CommunityName1:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Community Name 1. Specifies the first of two community names that are allowed to access this unit’s Management   
					Information Base (MIB). External SNMP managers must supply this name to access an object in the MIB.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the first community name.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the first community name.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-29   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-9   
					(3 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					Access 1: Read   
					Next Read R/W Prev   
					Access 1. Specifies the type of access allowed for Community Name 1. This is the type of access allowed for external   
					SNMP managers accessing objects in the MIB using Community Name 1.   
					Read – Allows read-only access (SNMP Get) to the accessible objects in the MIB for this device when community   
					name 1 is used. This includes all objects specified as either read-only or read/write in the MIB RFCs.   
					R/W – Allows read and write access (SNMP Get and Set) to the objects in the MIB for this device when community   
					name 1 is used. Write access is allowed for all objects specified as read/write in the MIB RFCs. Read access is allowed   
					for all objects specified as either read-only or read/write.   
					CommunityName2:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Community Name 2. Specifies the second of two community names that are allowed to access this unit’s Management   
					Information Base (MIB). External SNMP managers must supply this name to access an object in the MIB.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the second community name.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the second community name.   
					Access 2: Read   
					Next Read R/W Prev   
					Access 2. Specifies the type of access allowed for Community Name 2. This is the type of access allowed for external   
					SNMP managers accessing objects in the MIB using Community Name 2.   
					Read – Allows read-only access (SNMP Get) to the accessible objects in the MIB for this device when community   
					name 2 is used. This includes all objects specified as either read-only or read/write in the MIB RFCs.   
					R/W – Allows read and write access (SNMP Get and Set) to the objects in the MIB for this device when community   
					name 2 is used. Write access is allowed for all objects specified as read/write in the MIB RFCs. Read access is allowed   
					for all objects specified as either read-only or read/write.   
					IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					IP Address for the DSU/CSU. Specifies the IP address needed to access the DSU/CSU. Since this IP Address is not   
					bound to a particular port, it can be used for remote access via the FDL or EDL (for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs)   
					management link.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the IP address for the DSU/CSU.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the IP address for the DSU/CSU. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					NetMask:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Subnet Mask for the DSU/CSU. Specifies the subnet mask needed to access the DSU/CSU. Since this subnet mask is   
					not bound to a particular port, it can be used for remote access via the FDL or EDL (for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs)   
					management link.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the subnet mask for the DSU/CSU.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the subnet mask for the DSU/CSU. The subnet mask is set to 000.000.000.000. If the subnet   
					mask is 000.000.000.000, the IP protocol creates a default subnet mask based on the class of the IP address (Class A:   
					255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000).   
					C-30   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-9   
					(4 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					Com IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Com Port IP Address. Specifies the IP address for the communication port if the Com Use configuration option is set to   
					Mgmt or Daisy.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the IP address for the communication port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the IP address for the communication port. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs if the communication port is disabled.   
					Com NetMask:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Subnet Mask for the Communication Port. Specifies the subnet mask for the communication port if the Com Use   
					configuration option is set to Mgmt or Daisy.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the subnet mask for the communication port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the subnet mask for the communication port. The subnet mask is set to 000.000.000.000. If   
					the subnet mask is 000.000.000.000, the IP protocol creates a default subnet mask based on the class of the IP address   
					(Class A: 255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs if the communication port is disabled.   
					Com Link: PPP   
					Next PPP SLIP Prev   
					Com Port Link Layer Protocol. Specifies the link layer protocol for the communication port if the Com Use configuration   
					option is set to Mgmt or Daisy.   
					PPP – Specifies PPP as the link layer protocol for the IP management link on the communication port.   
					SLIP – Specifies SLIP as the link layer protocol for the IP management link on the communication port. The   
					communication port must be configured for asynchronous operation to support SLIP. This selection does not appear if the   
					Com Use configuration option is set to Daisy.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs if the communication port is disabled.   
					Modem IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Modem Port IP Address. Specifies the IP address for the modem port if the Modem Use configuration option is set to   
					Mgmt.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the IP address for the modem port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the IP address for the modem port. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-31   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-9   
					(5 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					Mdm NetMask:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Subnet Mask for the Modem Port. Specifies the Subnet Mask for the modem port if the Modem Use configuration option   
					is set to Mgmt.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the Subnet Mask for the modem port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the Subnet Mask for the modem port. The Subnet Mask is set to 000.000.000.000. If the   
					Subnet Mask is 000.000.000.000, the IP protocol creates a default Subnet Mask based on the class of the IP address   
					(Class A: 255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Alt Mdm IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Alternate Modem Port IP Address. Specifies the alternate IP address for the modem port if the Modem Use configuration   
					option is set to Mgmt. This IP address is needed if a call attempt does not complete on the primary alarm/trap phone   
					number (contained in the alarm directory) and the alternate dial out directory is used to try another phone number.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the alternate IP address for the modem port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the alternate IP address for the modem port. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Alt Mdm NetMask:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Alternate Subnet Mask for the Modem Port. Specifies the alternate Subnet Mask for the modem port if the Modem Use   
					configuration option is set to Mgmt. This Subnet Mask is needed if a call attempt does not complete on the primary   
					alarm/trap phone number (contained in the alarm directory) and the alternate dial-out directory is used to try another   
					phone number. If this configuration option contains a non-zero Subnet Mask, it is used as the Subnet Mask for the   
					modem port if a call is completed to the alternate phone number.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the alternate Subnet Mask for the modem port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the alternate Subnet Mask for the modem port. The Subnet Mask is set to 000.000.000.000. If   
					the Subnet Mask is 000.000.000.000, the IP protocol creates a default Subnet Mask based on the class of the IP address   
					(Class A: 255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Modem Link: PPP   
					Next PPP SLIP Prev   
					Modem Port Link Layer Protocol. Specifies the link layer protocol for the modem port if the Modem Use configuration   
					option is set to Mgmt.   
					PPP – Specifies PPP as the link layer protocol for the IP management link on the modem port.   
					SLIP – Specifies SLIP protocol as the link layer protocol for the IP management link on the modem port. The modem port   
					must be configured for asynchronous operation to support SLIP.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					C-32   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-9   
					(6 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					Aux IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					IP Address for the Auxiliary Port. Specifies the IP address for the auxiliary port if the Aux Use configuration option is set to   
					Mgmt or Daisy. The auxiliary port only supports the PPP link protocol.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the IP address for the auxiliary port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the IP address for the auxiliary port. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					Aux NetMask:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Subnet Mask for the Auxiliary Port. Specifies the subnet mask for the auxiliary port if the Aux Use configuration option is   
					set to Mgmt or Daisy.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit and/or display the subnet mask for the auxiliary port.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the subnet mask for the auxiliary port. The subnet mask is set to 000.000.000.000. If the   
					subnet mask is 000.000.000.000, the IP protocol creates a default subnet mask based on the class of the IP address   
					(Class A: 255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on standalone DSU/CSUs only. F   
					IPBusMast: Disab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Setting the IP Bus Master. Specifies whether or not a particular carrier-mounted unit is the IP Bus Master. There can only   
					be one IP Bus Master per 3000 Series Carrier. Typically, the carrier-mounted unit that has the SNMP/Telnet management   
					system connected to it is the IP Bus Master. This allows for faster access to the remaining carrier units. If an SNMP/Telnet   
					management system is connected to another carrier-mounted unit (i.e. not the IP Bus Master) and the SNMP/Telnet   
					management system tries to access another carrier-mounted unit, the data has to be routed to the IP Bus Master first.   
					Once the IP Bus Master receives the data, it is routed to the appropriate slot.   
					Enab – This unit is the IP Bus Master. Only one IP Bus Master is allowed per 3000 Series Carrier.   
					Disab – This unit is not the IP Bus Master.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is available on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs only. Y   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-33   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-9   
					(7 of 7)   
					General Management Configuration Options   
					Def Netwk: None   
					Next None IPBus Com Modem Aux FDL EDL1 EDL2 EDL3 EDL4 Prev   
					Default Network Destination. Specifies the default network destination. This configuration option specifies where the   
					default network is connected. For example, if the default network is connected to the communication port, you select   
					Com. If the default network is connected to the far-end 31xx Series device over the FDL, you select FDL. The routing   
					protocol uses the default network destination to route data that does not have a specific route.   
					None – No default network destination. Data that cannot be routed is discarded.   
					IPBus – The default network destination is the IP Bus on the carrier backplane. This selection only appears for   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs which are not configured as the IP Bus Master.   
					Com – The default network destination is the communication port. This selection only appears if the Com Use   
					configuration option is set to Mgmt.   
					Modem – The default network destination is the modem port. This selection only appears if the Modem Use configuration   
					option is set to Mgmt. This selection does not appear on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs.   
					Aux – The default network destination is the auxiliary port. This selection only appears if the Aux Use configuration option   
					is set to Mgmt.   
					FDL – The default network destination is FDL. This selection only appears if the FDL management link is enabled.   
					EDLn – For 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs, the default network destination is the EDLn port (where n is 1–4). This   
					selection only appears in 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs if the synchronous data port’s EDL management link is enabled.   
					NOTE: If the chosen default network link is disabled or down, data is discarded. Return to this menu and choose another   
					default network.   
					C-34   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Configuration Options   
					Table C-10   
					(1 of 2)   
					Management Trap Configuration Options   
					Num Trap Mgrs: 1   
					Next   
					1 
					2 
					3 
					4 
					5 
					6 
					Prev   
					Number of Trap Managers. Specifies the number of SNMP trap managers that are to receive traps for this unit.   
					NOTE: You must configure an IP address for each trap manager that is to receive trap messages.   
					Trapn IP Adr:   
					Next Edit Clear Prev   
					Trap n IP Address. Specifies the IP address for each trap manager. This configuration option is repeated for all trap   
					managers supported by the unit.   
					Edit – Allows you to edit or display the IP address for Trap Manager n.   
					Clear – Allows you to clear the IP address for Trap Manager n. The IP address is set to 000.000.000.000.   
					Trapn Dst: None   
					Next None IPBus Com Modem Aux FDL EDL1 EDL2 EDL3 EDL4 Prev   
					Trap Manager n Destination. Specifies the network destination for Trap Manager n. This configuration option is displayed   
					for the number of trap managers (n) specified by the Number of Trap Managers configuration option.   
					None – No Trap Manage n network destination. Traps are discarded.   
					IPBus – The Trap Manager n network destination is the IP Bus on the carrier backplane. This selection only appears for   
					carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs which are not configured as the IP Bus Master.   
					Com – The Trap Manager n network destination is the communication port. This selection only appears if the Com Use   
					configuration option is set to Mgmt or Daisy.   
					Modem – The Trap Manager n network destination is the modem port. This selection only appears if the Modem Use   
					configuration option is set to Mgmt. This selection does not appear on carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs.   
					Aux – The Trap Manager n network destination is the auxiliary port. This selection only appears if the Aux Use   
					configuration option is set to Mgmt or Daisy.   
					FDL – The Trap Manager n network destination is the FDL management link. This selection only appears if the FDL   
					management link is enabled.   
					EDLn – The Trap Manager n network destination is the EDLn port (where n is 1–4). This selection only appears if the   
					synchronous data port’s EDL management link is enabled.   
					NOTE: If the chosen destination link is disabled or down, the traps are discarded. Return to this menu and choose   
					another destination.   
					Gen Trap: Both   
					Next Disab Warm Auth Both Prev   
					General Trap Types. Specifies the general trap types to enable.   
					Disab – Disables the sending of trap messages for warmStart and authenticationFailure events.   
					Warm – Sends trap messages for warmStart events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					Auth – Sends trap messages for authenticationFailure events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					Both – Sends trap messages for warmStart and authenticationFailure events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the SNMP Trap configuration option (in the Alarm Configuration   
					Options section on page C-25) is disabled.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-35   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table C-10   
					(2 of 2)   
					Management Trap Configuration Options   
					Entp Trap: Enab   
					Next Enab Disab Prev   
					Enterprise Specific Traps. Specifies whether enterpriseSpecific traps are enabled.   
					Enab – Sends trap messages for enterpriseSpecific events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					Disab – Disables the sending of trap messages for enterpriseSpecific events.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the SNMP Trap configuration option (in the Alarm Configuration   
					
					Link Trap: Both   
					Next Disab Up Down Both Prev   
					Link Trap Type. Specifies the link trap type to enable. Interfaces monitored for linkUp and linkDown traps are specified   
					with the Trap I/F configuration option.   
					Disab – Disables the sending of trap messages for linkDown or linkUp events.   
					Up – Sends trap messages for linkUp events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					Down – Sends trap messages for linkDown events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					Both – Sends trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events to the currently configured trap manager(s).   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the SNMP Trap configuration option (in the Alarm Configuration   
					
					Trap I/F: All   
					Next NET DTE T1s Ports All Prev   
					Link Trap Interfaces. Specifies which interfaces generate linkUp and linkDown trap messages. These traps are supported   
					on the T1 interfaces (network and DTE Drop/Insert) and the synchronous data ports.   
					NET – Sends trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events occurring on the network interface.   
					DTE – Sends trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events occurring on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. This   
					selection does not appear if the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface is disabled.   
					T1s – Sends trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events occurring on the network or DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface.   
					Ports – Sends trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events occurring on the synchronous data ports.   
					All – Sends trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events occurring on the network interface, DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface, or the synchronous data ports.   
					NOTE: This configuration option is not available if the Link Trap configuration option is not configured to generate trap   
					messages for linkUp or linkDown events.   
					C-36   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Configuration Worksheets   
					This section contains one set of blank worksheets to be   
					used when configuring your DSU/CSU in the network. In   
					the tables, default settings for Factory 1 are indicated by   
					bold type. It is recommended that you copy these blank   
					worksheets before using them.   
					DTE Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					General   
					Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					DTE Port   
					Enab, Disab   
					Gen Yellow   
					Enab, Disab   
					DTE Framing   
					DTE Coding   
					Equal   
					D4, ESF   
					Clock Src   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Int, Ext   
					2048, 1544, 8   
					AMI, B8ZS   
					Clock Rate   
					Tst Timeout   
					Tst Duration   
					0–133, 133–266, 266–399,   
					399–533, 533–655   
					Enab, Disab   
					Extrn DLB   
					Send Ones   
					Enab, Disab   
					1–120 (Default = 10)   
					Enab, Disab   
					Net Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					D4, ESF   
					NET Framing   
					NET Coding   
					LBO   
					AMI, B8ZS   
					0.0, –7.5, –15, –22.5   
					Enab, Disab   
					ANSI PRM   
					Mgmt Link   
					NET LLB   
					NET PLB   
					BitStuff   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					62411, Part68, Disab   
					Edit, Clear   
					Circuit Ident   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					C-37   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					User Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					User Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Self-Test   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					MInActTm   
					F 
					F 
					F 
					F 
					Enab, Disab   
					FP Access   
					FP Pass   
					F 
					F 
					1–60 (Default = 5)   
					None, Mgmt, Daisy   
					9.6, 14.4, 19.2, 38.4   
					Enab, Disab   
					MDiscTm   
					Aux Use   
					Enab, Disab   
					Dial-In   
					Enab, Disab   
					Aux Rate   
					TnSession   
					TnPaswd   
					TnInActTm   
					TnDiscTm   
					Password   
					None, Com, Modem, Both   
					Enab, Disab   
					Com Port   
					Y 
					Enab, Disab   
					Com Use   
					Mgmt, ASCII, Daisy, Term   
					Disab, AT, Other   
					Edit, Clear   
					Enab, Disab   
					ComExtDev   
					ComConnPrefix   
					ComConnected   
					Y 
					Y 
					Y 
					1–60 (Default = 5)   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					ComEscapeSeq Y   
					ComEscDel   
					Alarm   
					Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					None, 0.2s, 0.4s, 0.6s, 0.8s,   
					1.0s   
					Y 
					Alrm Msg   
					Disab, Modem, Com, Both   
					Enab, Disab   
					Edit, Clear   
					Async, Sync   
					Int, Ext   
					ComDisconnect   
					Com Type   
					Com Clk   
					Y 
					F 
					F 
					SNMP Trap   
					Trap Disc   
					DialOut   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Com Rate   
					1.2, 2.4, 4.8, 9.6, 14.4, 19.2,   
					38.4   
					Call Retry   
					Dial Delay   
					AltDialDir   
					Err Rate   
					Enab, Disab   
					1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10   
					None, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5   
					Char Length   
					CParity   
					7, 8   
					None, Even, Odd   
					1, 1.5, 2   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7,   
					10E–8, 10E–9   
					CStop Bits   
					Ignore DTR   
					CmInActTm   
					CmDiscTm   
					Modem Use   
					Modem Type   
					Modem Rate   
					MChar Len   
					MParity   
					Yes, No   
					Enab, Disab   
					Alrm Relay   
					Y 
					Enab, Disab   
					1–60 (Default = 5)   
					Mgmt, ASCII, Term   
					Async, Sync   
					1.2, 2.4   
					F 
					F 
					F 
					F 
					F 
					F 
					F 
					NOTE   
					A circular symbol (F) identifies   
					configuration options that are   
					available on standalone   
					DSU/CSUs only. A triangular   
					symbol (Y) identifies   
					7, 8   
					None, Even, Odd   
					1, 2   
					configuration options that are   
					available on carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs only.   
					MStop Bits   
					LSpaceDisc   
					Enab, Disab   
					C-38   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Prt1 Options   
					Port Type   
					Base Rate   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Prt3 Options   
					Port Type   
					Base Rate   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Disab, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disab, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Disab, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					Disab, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disab, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Disab, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					All Ones   
					All Ones   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					EDL   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					EDL   
					Int, Ext   
					Int, Ext   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Err Rate   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7,   
					10E–8, 10E–9   
					Err Rate   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7,   
					10E–8, 10E–9   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Disab, Maint, Send, Both   
					Disab, Maint   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Disab, Maint, Send, Both   
					Disab, Maint   
					Mgmt Link   
					Enab, Disab   
					Mgmt Link   
					Enab, Disab   
					Prt2 Options   
					Port Type   
					Base Rate   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Prt4 Options   
					Port Type   
					Base Rate   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Disab, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disab, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Disab, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					Disab, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disab, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Disab, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					All Ones   
					All Ones   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					EDL   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					EDL   
					Int, Ext   
					Int, Ext   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Enab, Disab   
					Err Rate   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7,   
					10E–8, 10E–9   
					Err Rate   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7,   
					10E–8, 10E–9   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Disab, Maint, Send, Both   
					Disab, Maint   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Disab, Maint, Send, Both   
					Disab, Maint   
					Mgmt Link   
					Enab, Disab   
					Mgmt Link   
					Enab, Disab   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					C-39   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Network Interface   
					Network Channel Allocation   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Interface   
					DTE (DSX-1) Channel Allocation   
					N1   
					N2   
					N3   
					N4   
					N5   
					N6   
					N7   
					N8   
					N9   
					D1   
					D2   
					D3   
					D4   
					D5   
					D6   
					D7   
					D8   
					D9   
					N10   
					N11   
					D10   
					D11   
					D12   
					D13   
					D14   
					D15   
					D16   
					D17   
					D18   
					D19   
					D20   
					D21   
					D22   
					D23   
					D24   
					Allocations   
					N12   
					N13   
					N14   
					N15   
					N16   
					N17   
					N18   
					N19   
					N20   
					N21   
					N22   
					N23   
					N24   
					Allocations   
					N1 – N24 indicates allocation to DTE   
					(Drop/Insert) channels.   
					D1 – D24 indicates allocation to network   
					channels.   
					C-40   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					DTE Chan   
					Config   
					Assign:   
					(N1 – 24)   
					Voice   
					(RBS or Data)   
					D1   
					D2   
					D3   
					D4   
					D5   
					D6   
					D7   
					D8   
					D9   
					D10   
					D11   
					D12   
					D13   
					D14   
					D15   
					D16   
					D17   
					D18   
					D19   
					D20   
					D21   
					D22   
					D23   
					D24   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					C-41   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Port Chan   
					Conf   
					Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt2, Prt3, Prt4   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 1   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Prt3, Prt4   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 2   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					C-42   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Configuration Options   
					Port Chan   
					Conf   
					Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Prt2, Prt4   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 3   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					Assign To   
					Assign By   
					NET, DTE, Prt1, Prt2, Prt3   
					Block, ACAMI, Chan   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768, 832, 896, 960, 1024, 1088, 1152,   
					1216, 1280, 1344, 1408, 1472, 1536   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672, 728, 784, 840, 896, 952, 1008, 1064,   
					1120, 1176, 1232, 1288, 1344   
					If Assign By Block   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select One)   
					Port 4   
					Port Rate   
					Nx64: 64, 128, 192, 256, 320, 384, 448, 512, 576,   
					640, 704, 768   
					Nx56: 56, 112, 168, 224, 280, 336, 392, 448, 504,   
					560, 616, 672   
					If Assign By   
					ACAMI   
					Start At   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23   
					(Select One)   
					If Assign By Chan   
					Time Slot (Nx or Dx): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,   
					12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24   
					(Select Multiple)   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					C-43   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					General Mgmt   
					Options   
					Mgmt Trap   
					Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					SNMP Mgt   
					Enab, Disab   
					Num Trap Mgrs   
					Trapn IP Adr   
					1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6   
					NMS Valid   
					Enab, Disab   
					1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10   
					Edit, Clear   
					Read, R/w   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Read, R/W   
					Edit, Clear   
					Read, R/W   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					PPP, SLIP   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					PPP, SLIP   
					Edit, Clear   
					Edit, Clear   
					Enab, Disab   
					Edit, Clear   
					Num Sec Mgrs   
					NMS n IP Adr   
					NMS n Access   
					System Name   
					System Location   
					System Contact   
					CommunityName1   
					Access 1   
					None, IPBus, Com, Modem,   
					Aux, FDL, EDLn   
					Trapn Dst   
					Gen Trap   
					Entp Trap   
					Link Trap   
					Trap I/F   
					Disab, Warm, Auth, Both   
					Enab, Disab   
					Disab, Up, Down, Both   
					NET, DTE, T1s, Ports, All   
					CommunityName2   
					Access 2   
					NOTE   
					A circular symbol (F) identifies   
					configuration options that are   
					available on standalone   
					DSU/CSUs only. A triangular   
					symbol (Y) identifies   
					IP Adr   
					NetMask   
					configuration options that are   
					available on carrier-mounted   
					DSU/CSUs only.   
					Com IP Adr   
					Com NetMask   
					Com Link   
					Modem IP Adr   
					Mdm NetMask   
					Alt Mdm IP Adr   
					F 
					F 
					F 
					Alt Mdm NetMask F   
					Modem Link   
					Aux IP Adr   
					Aux NetMask   
					IPBusMast   
					F 
					F 
					F 
					Y 
					None, IPBus, Com, Modem,   
					Aux, FDL, EDLn   
					Def Netwk   
					C-44   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					D 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-1   
					T1 Network Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-1   
					DTE Drop/Insert Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-3   
					MODEM Port Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-4   
					AUX Port Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-5   
					COM Port Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-6   
					EIA 530A Port Interface Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-8   
					EIA 530A-to-RS449 Cable Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-9   
					EIA 530A-to-V.35 Cable Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-11   
					EIA 530A-to-X.21 Cable Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-13   
					Serial Crossover Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-15   
					Power Input Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-16   
					Optional DC Power Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-16   
					External Clock Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-16   
					Overview   
					T1 Network Interface   
					The DSU/CSU is shipped with a power module and a   
					VF cable. Various other interconnecting cables are   
					available. For cable feature numbers, refer to Appendix I,   
					
					assignments and cables.   
					The T1 network interface connector is an RJ48C,   
					
					The T1 line interface cable is a 20-foot, 24 AWG solid,   
					2-twisted pair cable that is either RJ48C-to-RJ48C   
					
					Table D-1   
					T1 Network Interface Connector   
					Signal   
					Pin Number   
					Receive Ring   
					1 
					2 
					4 
					5 
					Receive Tip   
					Transmit Ring   
					Transmit Tip   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					D-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					DTE Drop/Insert Interface   
					Table D-2   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Connector   
					The DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface connector is a   
					
					about using Relay Contact Sense for external DTE   
					loopback, refer to the Extrn DLB configuration option in   
					
					Appendix C.   
					Signal   
					Pin Number   
					Receiver Tip from DTE   
					Receiver Ring from DTE   
					Transmitter Tip to DTE   
					Transmitter Ring to DTE   
					Relay Contact Sense Return   
					Relay Contact Sense   
					Shield Ground   
					1 
					9 
					3 
					
					typically supplied by a DTE vendor. It is made of shielded   
					twisted-pair wires (22 AWG). The cable connector is a   
					DB15-type plug connector. Be sure to connect the shield   
					ground only at the DSU/CSU end to prevent ground   
					loops.   
					11   
					12   
					14   
					2,4   
					Figure D-3. DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) Cable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					D-3   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					MODEM Port Interface   
					The integral modem port connector is a 4-position,   
					
					Table D-3   
					Integral Modem Port Connector   
					Signal   
					Pin Number   
					The integral modem VF cable is a 14.5-foot, 26 AWG,   
					4-conductor keyed cable with an RJ11C-like plug   
					
					standalone DSU/CSU.   
					VF Ring   
					VF Tip   
					2 
					3 
					Figure D-4. Integral Modem Cable   
					D-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					AUX Port Interface   
					NOTE   
					The Auxiliary (AUX) port connects to the LAN   
					Adapter for SNMP or Telnet applications, or to another   
					DSU/CSU’s COM port for daisy chain connectivity. (The   
					SNMP LAN Adapter includes the cable that is needed   
					to attach it to the DSU/CSU.) The AUX port connector   
					
					For daisy-chaining an AUX port   
					to a COM port, a 25-pin-to-8-pin,   
					cable is required and the   
					appropriate configuration   
					options (Com Use and Aux Use)   
					must be set to Daisy. Whenever   
					the cable is connected or   
					disconnected, you should   
					change the Daisy selection to   
					ensure that the correct   
					parameters have been   
					negotiated for the link layer.   
					Table D-4   
					AUX Port Connector   
					Signal   
					DTE Transmit Clock   
					DTE Receive Data   
					Signal Ground   
					Direction   
					Pin Number   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					— 
					15   
					3 
					7 
					DTE Transmit Data   
					DTE Receive Clock   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					2 
					17   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					D-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					COM Port Interface   
					NOTE   
					The COM port connects to a PC for front panel   
					emulation, to an ASCII terminal or printer for alarms, to   
					an async terminal, to a network device (e.g., a router) for   
					SNMP or Telnet applications, to the LAN Adapter for   
					SNMP or Telnet applications, or to another DSU/CSU’s   
					AUX port for daisy chain connectivity. (The SNMP LAN   
					Adapter includes the cable that is needed to attach it to   
					the DSU/CSU.) The COM port connector is an 8-position   
					
					this port are referenced to a DTE interface.   
					For daisy-chaining an AUX port   
					to a COM port, a 25-pin-to-8-pin,   
					cable is required and the   
					appropriate configuration   
					options (Com Use and Aux Use)   
					must be set to Daisy. Whenever   
					the cable is connected or   
					disconnected, you should   
					change the Daisy selection to   
					ensure that the correct   
					parameters have been   
					
					the COM port-to-terminal/printer cable is shown in   
					
					negotiated for the link layer.   
					Table D-5   
					COM Port Connector   
					Signal   
					DCE Transmit Clock   
					DCE Receive Data   
					Signal Ground   
					Direction   
					Pin Number   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					— 
					1 
					2 
					3 
					4 
					5 
					6 
					7 
					8 
					DCE Transmit Data   
					DCE Data Terminal Ready   
					DCE Carrier Detect   
					DCE Request-to-Send   
					DCE Receive Clock   
					To DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					D-6   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					EIA 530A Port Interface   
					Connector   
					The EIA 530A Port interface connector information is   
					
					Table D-6   
					EIA 530A Port Interface Connector   
					Circuit   
					Mnemonic   
					CCITT   
					Number   
					Signal   
					Direction   
					Pin   
					Shield   
					— 
					AB   
					AC   
					BA   
					— 
					— 
					1 
					7 
					Signal Common   
					Signal Common   
					Transmitted Data   
					102A   
					102B   
					103   
					— 
					— 
					23   
					To DSU/CSU   
					2 (A)   
					14 (B)   
					Received Data   
					Request-to-Send   
					Clear-to-Send   
					BB   
					CA   
					CB   
					CF   
					104   
					105   
					106   
					109   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					3 (A)   
					16 (B)   
					4 (A)   
					19 (B)   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					5 (A)   
					13 (B)   
					Received Line Signal Detector   
					8 (A)   
					10 (B)   
					DCE Ready   
					CC   
					CD   
					DA   
					107   
					108/1, /2   
					113   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					6 
					DTE Ready   
					20   
					Transmit Signal Element Timing (DTE Source)   
					11 (B)   
					24 (A)   
					Transmit Signal Element Timing (DCE Source)   
					Receiver Signal Element Timing (DCE Source)   
					DB   
					DD   
					114   
					115   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					12 (B)   
					15 (A)   
					17 (A)   
					9 (B)   
					Local Loopback   
					Remote Loopback   
					Test Mode   
					LL   
					RL   
					TM   
					141   
					140   
					142   
					To DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					18   
					21   
					25   
					D-8   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					EIA 530A-to-RS449 Cable   
					Interface   
					
					
					530   
					SIGNAL   
					DB37 449   
					SOCKET SIGNAL   
					DB25   
					PLUG   
					SHIELD   
					TD-A   
					1 
					1 
					SHIELD   
					TD-A   
					2 
					4 
					TD-B   
					14   
					3 
					22   
					6 
					TD-B   
					RD-A   
					RD-A   
					RD-B   
					16   
					15   
					12   
					17   
					9 
					24   
					5 
					RD-B   
					TXC-A   
					TXC-B   
					RXC-A   
					RXC-B   
					RTS-A   
					RTS-B   
					CTS-A   
					CTS-B   
					DTR   
					TXC-A   
					TXC-B   
					RXC-A   
					RXC-B   
					RTS-A   
					RTS-B   
					CTS-A   
					CTS-B   
					DTR-A   
					RR-A   
					23   
					8 
					26   
					7 
					4 
					19   
					5 
					25   
					9 
					13   
					20   
					8 
					27   
					12   
					13   
					31   
					11   
					19   
					14   
					10   
					20   
					17   
					35   
					18   
					RLSD-A   
					RLSD-B   
					DSR   
					10   
					6 
					RR-B   
					DM-A   
					SIG. COMMON   
					RL   
					7 
					SIG. COMMON   
					RL   
					21   
					18   
					23   
					24   
					11   
					25   
					22   
					LL   
					LL   
					RCV. COMMON   
					TT-A   
					RCV. COMMON   
					TT-A   
					TT-B   
					TT-B   
					TM   
					TM   
					SIG. COMMON   
					29   
					30   
					DM-B   
					DTR-B   
					495-14323-01   
					Figure D-7. EIA 530A-to-RS449 Cable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					D-9   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table D-7   
					RS449 Cable Interface   
					Circuit   
					Mnemonic   
					CCITT   
					Number   
					Signal   
					Direction   
					Pin   
					Shield   
					— 
					— 
					102A   
					102B   
					— 
					— 
					1 
					Signal Ground   
					Receive Ground   
					Send Common   
					Send Data   
					SG   
					RC   
					SC   
					SD   
					— 
					19   
					20   
					37   
					— 
					— 
					103   
					To DSU/CSU   
					4 (A)   
					22 (B)   
					Receive Data   
					Request-to-Send   
					Clear-to-Send   
					Receiver Ready   
					Data Mode   
					RD   
					RS   
					CS   
					RR   
					DM   
					TR   
					TT   
					104   
					105   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					6 (A)   
					24 (B)   
					7 (A)   
					25 (B)   
					106   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					9 (A)   
					27 (B)   
					109   
					13 (A)   
					31 (B)   
					107   
					11 (A)   
					29 (B)   
					Terminal Ready   
					Terminal Timing   
					Send Timing   
					108/1, /2   
					113   
					12 (A)   
					30 (B)   
					To DSU/CSU   
					17 (A)   
					35 (B)   
					ST   
					RT   
					114   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					5 (A)   
					23 (B)   
					Receive Timing   
					115   
					8 (A)   
					26 (B)   
					Local Loopback   
					Remote Loopback   
					Test Mode   
					LL   
					RL   
					TM   
					141   
					140   
					142   
					To DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					10   
					14   
					18   
					D-10   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					EIA 530A-to-V.35 Cable   
					Interface   
					
					
					530 DB25   
					SIGNAL PLUG   
					V.35   
					SIGNAL   
					MS34   
					SOCKET   
					SHIELD   
					TD-A   
					1 
					2 
					A 
					P 
					S 
					R 
					T 
					Y 
					SHIELD   
					TD-A   
					TD-B 14   
					RD-A   
					TD-B   
					3 
					RD-A   
					RD-B 16   
					TXC-A 15   
					TXC-B 12   
					RXC-A 17   
					RD-B   
					TXC-A   
					AA TXC-B   
					V 
					X 
					C 
					D 
					F 
					RXC-A   
					RXC-B   
					RTS   
					RXC-B   
					RTS   
					9 
					4 
					5 
					8 
					6 
					7 
					CTS   
					CTS   
					RLSD   
					RLSD   
					DSR   
					DSR   
					E 
					B 
					U 
					W 
					H 
					N 
					L 
					SIG. COMMON   
					SIG. COMMON   
					TT-A   
					TT-A 24   
					TT-B 11   
					TT-B   
					DTR 20   
					DTR   
					RL 21   
					RL   
					LL 18   
					LL   
					TM 25   
					NN TM   
					SIG. COMMON 23   
					497-15233   
					Figure D-8. EIA 530A-to-V.35 Cable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					D-11   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table D-8   
					V.35 Cable Interface   
					CCITT   
					Number   
					Signal   
					Direction   
					Pin   
					Shield   
					— 
					— 
					— 
					A 
					B 
					Signal Common   
					Transmitted Data   
					102   
					103   
					To DSU/CSU   
					P (A)   
					S (B)   
					Received Data   
					104   
					From DSU/CSU   
					R (A)   
					T (B)   
					Request to Send   
					Clear to Send   
					105   
					106   
					To DSU/CSU   
					C 
					D 
					F 
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					Data Channel Received Line Signal Detector   
					Data Set Ready   
					109   
					107   
					E 
					H 
					Data Terminal Ready   
					108/1, /2   
					113   
					Transmit Signal Element Timing (DTE Source)   
					To DSU/CSU   
					U (A)   
					W (B)   
					Transmit Signal Element Timing (DCE Source)   
					Receiver Signal Element Timing (DCE Source)   
					114   
					115   
					From DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					Y (A)   
					AA (B)   
					V (A)   
					X (B)   
					Local Loopback   
					141   
					140   
					142   
					To DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					From DSU/CSU   
					L 
					N 
					Loopback/Maintenance   
					Test Indicator   
					NN   
					D-12   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					EIA 530A-to-X.21   
					Cable Interface   
					
					
					530 DB25   
					SIGNAL PLUG   
					X.21   
					SIGNAL   
					DB15   
					SOCKET   
					TD-A   
					TD-B   
					2 
					14   
					3 
					2 
					9 
					TD-A   
					TD-B   
					RD-A   
					4 
					RD-A   
					RD-B   
					16   
					17   
					9 
					11   
					6 
					RD-B   
					RXC-A   
					RXC-A   
					RXC-B   
					RTS-A   
					RTS-B   
					RLSD-A   
					RLSD-B   
					SIG. COMMON   
					TT-A   
					RXC-B   
					13   
					3 
					RTS-A   
					4 
					RTS-B   
					19   
					8 
					10   
					5 
					RLSD-A   
					RLSD-B   
					SIG. COMMON   
					TT-A   
					10   
					7 
					12   
					8 
					24   
					11   
					7 
					TT-B   
					14   
					TT-B   
					495-14787   
					Figure D-9. EIA 530A-to-X.21 Cable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					D-13   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table D-9   
					X.21 Cable Interface   
					CCITT   
					Number   
					Signal   
					Direction   
					Pin   
					Signal Common   
					Transmitted Data   
					102   
					103   
					— 
					8 
					To DSU/CSU   
					2 (A)   
					9 (B)   
					Received Data   
					104   
					105   
					109   
					113   
					115   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					4 (A)   
					11 (B)   
					Request-to-Send   
					3 (A)   
					10 (B)   
					Data Channel Received Line Signal Detector   
					Transmit Signal Element Timing (DTE Source)   
					Receiver Signal Element Timing (DCE Source)   
					From DSU/CSU   
					To DSU/CSU   
					5 (A)   
					12 (B)   
					7 (A)   
					14 (B)   
					From DSU/CSU   
					6 (A)   
					13 (B)   
					D-14   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Pin Assignments   
					Serial Crossover Cable   
					Use a serial crossover cable like the one shown in   
					
					
					DSU/CSU’s COM port.   
					Pin 14   
					Pin 1   
					P1   
					Plug   
					P2   
					Plug   
					Pin 14   
					Pin 1   
					Pin 25   
					Pin 13   
					Pin 25   
					Pin 13   
					P1   
					Pin   
					Pin   
					P2   
					Chassis Ground   
					TXD   
					Chassis Ground   
					TXD   
					1 
					2 
					1 
					2 
					RXD   
					RXD   
					3 
					3 
					RTS   
					RTS   
					4 
					4 
					CTS   
					CTS   
					5 
					5 
					DSR   
					DSR   
					6 
					6 
					Signal Ground   
					CD (RLSD)   
					Signal Ground   
					CD (RLSD)   
					7 
					7 
					8 
					8 
					9 
					9 
					10   
					11   
					12   
					13   
					14   
					15   
					16   
					17   
					18   
					19   
					10   
					11   
					12   
					13   
					14   
					15   
					16   
					17   
					18   
					19   
					20   
					21   
					22   
					23   
					24   
					25   
					DTR   
					DTR 20   
					21   
					22   
					23   
					24   
					25   
					497-15180a   
					Figure D-10. Serial Crossover Cable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					D-15   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Power Input Connector   
					External Clock Interface   
					The input power connector leads are shown in   
					
					The External Clock connector pinouts are in   
					
					Table D-10   
					DC Power Connector   
					Table D-11   
					External Clock Connector   
					Signal   
					Pin Number   
					Signal   
					–48 Vdc Return   
					–48 Vdc A   
					Pin Number   
					Shield   
					1 
					2 
					1, 2   
					6 
					Clock (+) (RS422 only)   
					Clock (–) (RS422 only)   
					Clock In (RS423 only)   
					Signal Common   
					3 
					–48 Vdc B   
					5 
					9 
					+24 Vdc   
					5 
					11   
					+24 Vdc Return   
					Chassis Ground   
					4 
					3 
					Optional DC Power Cable   
					The power cable is a 14.5-foot, 18 AWG stranded   
					cable. The connector is terminated at one end with a   
					6-position connector. The other end of the cable is   
					terminated with a bare wire that should be connected to a   
					
					power source can be either a single source of +24 Vdc or   
					up to two sources of –48 Vdc (A and B). You cannot   
					connect +24 Vdc and –48 Vdc to the same unit. See the   
					
					Figure D-11. DC Power Cable   
					D-16   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					E 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-1   
					MIB II (RFC 1213) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-2   
					System Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-2   
					Interface Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-3   
					IP Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-6   
					ICMP Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					TCP Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					UDP Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					Transmission Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					SNMP Group, MIB II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					DS1/E1 MIB (RFC 1406) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					Near End Group, DS1/E1 MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-8   
					Far End Group, DS1/E1 MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-11   
					DS1 Fractional Group, DS1/E1 MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-11   
					RS-232-like MIB (RFC 1317) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-12   
					General Port Table, RS-232-like MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-12   
					Asynchronous Port Table, RS-232-like MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-13   
					Synchronous Port Table, RS-232-like MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-14   
					Input Signal Table, RS-232-like MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-14   
					Output Signal Table, RS-232-like MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-14   
					Generic-Interface MIB Extensions (RFC 1229) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-15   
					Generic Interface Test Table, Generic Interface MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-15   
					Enterprise MIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-16   
					Correlation between Menu Commands and SNMP Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-16   
					• 
					
					
					Overview   
					RS-232-type interfaces and supports synchronous   
					data ports (PORTs 1– 4) and management   
					communication ports (AUX, MODEM, and COM   
					ports) on the DSU/CSU.   
					This appendix describes the Management Information   
					Base (MIB) objects that are supported by the DSU/CSU   
					and provides a correlation between front panel commands   
					and MIB objects (Table E-1).   
					
					MIB II that defines additional objects for control of   
					generic interfaces in MIB II. It supports control of   
					tests on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) and   
					synchronous data interfaces that are not supported   
					by other MIBs.   
					The DSU/CSU supports the following MIBs:   
					
					
					Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol   
					(TCP/IP) internets and provides general   
					information about the DSU/CSU.   
					
					
					devices such as Model 316x DSU/CSUs.   
					
					
					interfaces and supports the network and DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interfaces on the DSU/CSU.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-1   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					System Group – “sysDescr” Object (system 1)   
					MIB II (RFC 1213)   
					This object provides the full name and version   
					identification for the system hardware and software. This   
					object displays the following string:   
					The objects defined by MIB II are organized into 10   
					different groups. The DSU/CSU implements only those   
					groups where the semantics of the group are applicable to   
					the implementation of a DSU/CSU. The MIB II object   
					groups supported or not supported by the 3100 Series   
					devices are as follows:   
					[Company Name] T1 DSU/CSU; model xxxx-xx-xxx;   
					S/W Release: yy.yy.yy; H/W CCA1: zzzz-zzz;   
					H/W CCA2: zzzz-zzz; Serial number: ssssssss.   
					Where:   
					xxxx-xx-xxx represents the full model   
					number of the unit.   
					System Group Supported.   
					Interface   
					Group   
					Supported for the network   
					interface, the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface, the   
					yy.yy.yy represents the software revision   
					number of the unit.   
					synchronous data ports, the COM   
					port, the AUX port, and the   
					MODEM port. Interface statistics   
					(counters) apply to any port (COM,   
					AUX, or MODEM), whichever is   
					defined as the SNMP management   
					link.   
					zzzz-zzz represents the hardware revision   
					number of the unit.   
					ssssssss represents the serial number of   
					the unit.   
					System Group – “sysObjectID” Object   
					(system 2)   
					Address   
					Translation   
					Group   
					Not supported since this group is   
					not supported in MIB II.   
					This object provides the authoritative identification of   
					the network management subsystem contained in the unit.   
					IP Group   
					Supported.   
					ICMP Group Supported.   
					This object displays the following object identifier:   
					TCP Group   
					UDP Group   
					EGP Group   
					Supported.   
					Supported.   
					3160   
					3164   
					3165   
					3161   
					[Company OID].1.14.2.2.1   
					[Company OID].1.14.2.2.2   
					[Company OID].1.14.2.2.3   
					[Company OID].1.14.2.2.4   
					Not supported since the EGP   
					protocol is not supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					Transmission Supported on the T1 interfaces   
					System group –”sysContact” Object (system 4)   
					Group   
					using the DS1/E1 MIB. Supported   
					on the synchronous data ports   
					using the RS-232-like MIB.   
					Supported on the COM, AUX, and   
					MODEM ports using the   
					This object provides a textual identification of the   
					contact person for this managed node.   
					RS-232-like MIB.   
					System Group – “sysName” Object (system 5)   
					SNMP Group Supported.   
					This object provides an administratively-assigned   
					name for this managed node.   
					System Group, MIB II   
					The System Group objects are fully supported by the   
					DSU/CSU. The following sections provide clarification   
					for objects contained in the System Group where it is not   
					otherwise clear how the object definition in MIB II is   
					related to the DSU/CSU. Objects not mentioned are   
					supported as stated in the MIB.   
					System Group – “sysLocation” Object   
					(system 6)   
					This object provides the physical location of this node.   
					E-2   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					The following are the values of the ifIndexes for all   
					DSU/CSU models:   
					System Group – “sysServices” Object   
					(system 7)   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					1–Net T1   
					This object provides a value which indicates the set of   
					services that are potentially offered by the DSU/CSU.   
					Only the following values are supported.   
					2–DTE T1   
					3–COM port   
					• 
					physical(1) – Layer 1 functionality for all   
					interfaces.   
					4–Modem port   
					5–Auxiliary RS-232 port   
					6–DCE port 1   
					7–DCE port 2   
					8–DCE port 3   
					9–DCE port 4   
					• 
					datalink/subnetwork(2) – Layer 2 functionality   
					(SLIP, PPP) for the COM, AUX, and MODEM   
					ports.   
					• 
					• 
					internet(4) – Layer 3 functionality (IP) for all   
					management links.   
					end-to-end(8) – Layer 4 functionality (UDP) for all   
					management links.   
					The supported ifIndexes for the 3160 DSU/CSU are:   
					Therefore, set this object to 15 (the sum   
					of 1 + 2 + 4 + 8).   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Net T1   
					DTE T1   
					Interface Group, MIB II   
					COM port   
					The Interfaces Group consists of an object indicating   
					the number of interfaces supported by the unit and an   
					interface table containing an entry for each interface. The   
					DSU/CSU provides an entry in the interface table for the   
					network interface, the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface, each of the synchronous data ports (1, 2, or 4   
					depending on the model), the COM port, the AUX port,   
					and the MODEM port, if they apply. The following   
					sections provide clarification for objects contained in the   
					Interface Group where it is not clear how the object   
					definition in MIB II is related to the DSU/CSU.   
					Modem port   
					Auxiliary RS-232 port   
					DCE port 1   
					DCE port 2   
					The supported ifIndexes for the 3164 DSU/CSU are:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Net T1   
					DTE T1   
					COM port   
					Interface Group – “ifNumber” Object   
					(interfaces 1)   
					Modem port   
					Auxiliary RS-232 port   
					DCE port 1   
					DCE port 2   
					DCE port 3   
					DCE port 4   
					This variable contains the maximum number of MIB II   
					supported interfaces possible across the 31xx Series   
					product line (9). This is different from the MIB   
					description, which is defined as the number of interfaces   
					on the particular device. This change allows the use of the   
					same ifIndexes across all 31xx Series models.   
					The supported ifIndexes for the 3165 DSU/CSU are:   
					Interface Group – “ifIndex” Object (ifEntry 1)   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Net T1   
					This object provides the index into the ifTable and   
					typically into tables in other MIBs also. The values of the   
					ifIndex object do not vary between models even though   
					not all indexes are supported for a particular model. When   
					an unsupported index is accessed, “noSuchName” is   
					returned.   
					COM port   
					Modem port   
					DCE port 1   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-3   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					The supported ifIndexes for the 3161 DSU/CSU are:   
					• 
					propPointToPointSerial(22) – Used for the   
					synchronous data ports. Used for the MODEM or   
					COM port when the port is not configured as the   
					SNMP management interface.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Net T1   
					DTE T1   
					• 
					• 
					ppp(23) – Used for the MODEM, AUX, or COM   
					port when the port is configured for PPP.   
					COM port (if configured)   
					DCE port 1   
					slip(28) – Used for the MODEM or COM port   
					when the port is configured for SLIP.   
					DCE port 2 (if configured)   
					Interface Group – “ifDescr” Object (ifEntry 2)   
					Interface Group – “ifMtu” Object (ifEntry 4)   
					This object provides information about the interface.   
					Each interface displays a text string as shown below:   
					This object identifies the largest datagram that can be   
					sent or received on the interface. It is applicable only to   
					the interface configured as the SNMP management link.   
					This object is zero for all other interfaces.   
					Network T1:   
					DTE T1:   
					COM:   
					“Network T1. [Company Name]   
					T1 DSU/CSU, Hardware Version:   
					[CCA number for the CSU   
					board]”.   
					Interface Group – “ifSpeed” Object (ifEntry 5)   
					“DTE T1. [Company Name] T1   
					DSU/CSU, Hardware Version:   
					[CCA number for the CSU   
					board]”.   
					This object provides the interface’s current bandwidth   
					in bits per second. The value of this object for each   
					interface is specified as follows:   
					“COM port. [Company Name] T1   
					DSU/CSU, Hardware Version:   
					[CCA number for the CSU board   
					for the standalone, or the CCA   
					number for the DSU board for the   
					carrier]”.   
					T1 Interfaces:   
					COM, AUX,   
					1,544,000 bps.   
					The currently configured data rate   
					and MODEM: for the port.   
					Data Ports: The currently configured data rate   
					for the port when the port is   
					allocated to one of the T1   
					interfaces. If the port is not   
					allocated the data rate is defined as   
					zero.   
					Modem:   
					AUX:   
					“MODEM port. [Company Name]   
					T1 DSU/CSU, Hardware Version:   
					[CCA number for the CSU   
					board]”.   
					“AUX port. [Company Name] T1   
					DSU/CSU, Hardware Version:   
					[CCA number for the CSU   
					board]”.   
					Interface Group – “ifAdminStatus” Object   
					(ifEntry 7)   
					Data Ports:   
					“Data Port n. [Company Name] T1   
					DSU/CSU, Hardware Version:   
					[CCA number for the DSU board]”   
					(where n is 1 to 4).   
					This object specifies the desired state (configuration)   
					of the interface. This object is supported only for the   
					COM and MODEM ports. It provides the ability to switch   
					between using the port for SNMP or ASCII operations   
					(dial-out, front panel emulation). The value of this object   
					will not affect the state of any of the interfaces on the   
					DSU/CSU other than the COM or MODEM port. Only   
					the following values are supported by the DSU/CSU:   
					Interface Group – “ifType” Object (ifEntry 3)   
					This object identifies the type of the interface based on   
					the physical/link protocol(s) immediately below the   
					network layer. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU:   
					• 
					up(1) – The SNMP management link is active on   
					the COM or MODEM port.   
					• 
					testing(3) – The SNMP management link is inactive   
					on the COM or MODEM port. These ports can be   
					used for proprietary ASCII functions.   
					• 
					ds1 – Used for the network and DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interfaces.   
					E-4   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					Interface Group – “ifOperStatus” Object   
					(ifEntry 8)   
					Data Ports:   
					The interface is up(1) when the   
					port is assigned to a T1 interface or   
					another data port as a backup, and   
					both CTS and DSR are ON.   
					This object specifies the current operational state of the   
					interface. The value of this object for each interface is   
					defined as follows:   
					The interface is down(2) when the   
					port is unassigned, or either CTS   
					or DSR is OFF.   
					Network T1:   
					The interface is up(1) when no   
					alarm conditions exist.   
					The interface is testing(3) when a   
					test is active on the interface.   
					The interface is down(2) when an   
					alarm condition is active.   
					The interface is testing(3) when a   
					test is active on the interface.   
					Interface Group – “ifLastChange” Object   
					(ifEntry 9)   
					DTE T1:   
					The interface is up(1) when no   
					alarm conditions exist and the   
					interface is enabled.   
					This object contains the value of “sysUpTime” at the   
					time the interface entered its current operational state.   
					The interface is down(2) when an   
					alarm condition is active and the   
					interface is disabled.   
					Interface Group – Input Counters   
					(objects ifEntry 10 to ifEntry 15)   
					The interface is testing(3) when a   
					test is active on the interface.   
					These objects collect statistics on the data received by   
					the COM port, the AUX port, and the MODEM port when   
					these ports are configured as SNMP management links.   
					For interfaces that are not configured as an SNMP   
					management link, these statistics are not provided and an   
					error status is returned if access is attempted. The objects   
					used to collect input statistics are listed below:   
					COM Port:   
					AUX Port:   
					When configured as an SNMP   
					management link, up and down are   
					based on the current state of the   
					link layer protocol. Otherwise, the   
					interface is always up(1).   
					The interface is never in the   
					testing(3) state.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					ifInOctets (ifEntry 10)   
					When configured as an SNMP   
					management link, up and down are   
					based on the current state of the   
					link layer protocol. Otherwise, the   
					interface is always down(2).   
					ifInUcastPkts (ifEntry 11)   
					ifInNUcastPkts (ifEntry 12)   
					ifInDiscards (ifEntry 13)   
					ifInErrors (ifEntry 14)   
					The interface is never in the   
					testing(3) state.   
					MODEM Port: When configured as an SNMP   
					management link, up and down are   
					based on the current state of the   
					ifInUnknownProtos (ifEntry 15)   
					link layer protocol. Otherwise, the   
					interface is always up(1) when the   
					modem is connected and down(2)   
					when the modem is not connected.   
					The interface is never in the   
					testing(3) state.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-5   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Interface Group – Output Counters   
					(objects ifEntry 16 to ifEntry 21)   
					IP Group – “ipAdEntAddr” Object   
					(ipAddrEntry 1)   
					These objects collect statistics on the data received by   
					the COM port, the AUX port, and the MODEM port when   
					these ports are configured as SNMP management links.   
					For interfaces that are not configured as an SNMP   
					management link, these statistics are not provided and an   
					error status is returned if access is attempted. The objects   
					used to collect output statistics are listed below:   
					The ipAdEntAddr object is an IP address supported by   
					the device and serves as the index to the address table.   
					Since indexes for tables must be unique, only one ifIndex   
					may be displayed for each IP address supported by the   
					device. If you have configured the same IP address for   
					multiple interfaces or for default IP addresses, you will   
					not see all interfaces that support a particular IP address   
					upon display of the ipAddrTable.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					ifOutOctets (ifEntry 16)   
					ifOutUcastPkts (ifEntry 17)   
					ifOutNUcastPkts (ifEntry 18)   
					ifOutDiscards (ifEntry 19)   
					ifOutErrors (ifEntry 20)   
					ifOutQLen (ifEntry 21)   
					IP Group – “ipAdEntIfIndex” Object   
					(ipAddrEntry 2)   
					For some address table entries, the ipAdEntIfIndex   
					object may have a value greater than ifNumber. In these   
					cases, the ipAdEntIfIndex refers to a proprietary interface   
					which is not currently implemented by the interface group   
					of MIB II.   
					IP Group, MIB II   
					IP Group – “ipRouteTable” Object (ip 21)   
					The IP Group objects are supported by the DSU/CSU   
					for all data paths which currently are configured to carry   
					IP data to or from the DSU/CSU, including the MODEM,   
					COM, AUX, carrier SNMP bus, EDL, and FDL. All of   
					the objects in the IP Group other than the IP Address   
					Translation table are fully supported. The IP Address   
					Translation table (ipNetToMediaTable) does not apply to   
					the DSU/CSU and will be empty (i.e., have zero entries).   
					The following sections provide clarification for objects   
					contained in the IP Group when it is not clear how the   
					object definition in MIB II is related to the DSU/CSU.   
					The routing table used by the DSU/CSU is supported   
					as a read/write table. Entries in this table may be added,   
					deleted, or changed. You should exercise great caution   
					when adding or modifying routes in the ipRoutingTable.   
					In general, it should not be necessary to add or modify   
					routes in the DSU/CSU. In those cases where it is deemed   
					necessary, the routes should only be added to the   
					connected device (i.e., the device closest to the   
					destination). Internal routing mechanisms will propagate   
					the route to the other devices.   
					An existing route may be effectively deleted by setting   
					the ipRouteType object to “invalid” for the entry to be   
					deleted. An existing route may be modified by changing   
					fields in the desired entry (indexed by ipRouteDest) of the   
					routing table. A new route may be added by specifying   
					values for a table entry for which the index   
					IP Group – “ipForwarding” Object (ip 1)   
					This object specifies whether the unit is acting as an IP   
					gateway in respect to the forwarding of a datagram   
					received by, but not addressed to, this unit. Only the   
					following value is supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					(“ipRouteDest”) does not already exist.   
					To add a route using an SNMP set, you must specify a   
					group of minimal objects. These variable bindings must   
					be contained in a single Protocol Data Unit (PDU). The   
					objects are described in more detail in the following   
					sections. The minimal set consists of:   
					• 
					forwarding(1) – The unit is acting as a gateway.   
					IP Group – “ipAddrTable” Object (ip 20)   
					The address table is supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					ipRouteDest   
					ipRouteIfIndex   
					E-6   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					The following objects are defaulted if not specified in   
					the set PDU used to add a route.   
					IP Group – “ipRouteIfIndex” Object   
					(ipRouteEntry 1)   
					• 
					• 
					ipRouteMetric1 – Defaulted to 1 hop.   
					When the routing table is displayed, the ipRouteIfIndex   
					object for some entries may have a value greater than   
					ifNumber. In these cases, the ipRouteIfIndex refers to a   
					proprietary interface which is not currently implemented   
					by the interface group of MIB II. Route entries with an   
					unrecognized ipRouteIfIndex value should not be deleted.   
					ipRouteMetric2 – Defaulted to current slot for   
					carrier devices and –1 for standalone devices.   
					• 
					• 
					ipRouteType – Defaulted to indirect.   
					ipRouteMask – Defaulted as specified in the MIB   
					description.   
					When setting this object via SNMP, the ipRouteIfIndex   
					value can only assume an appropriate value of ifIndex   
					defined for the particular device type.   
					The following objects are unused in the DSU/CSU and   
					setting them will have no effect on the operation of the IP   
					implementation.   
					IP Group – “ipRouteMetric2” Object   
					(ipRouteEntry 4)   
					• 
					ipRouteMetric3, ipRouteMetric4, ipRouteMetric5 –   
					Defaulted to –1 as specified in the MIB.   
					The following values are displayed for the   
					• 
					ipRouteNextHop – Defaulted to 0.0.0.0.   
					ipRouteMetric2 object. For a carrier device designated as   
					the IP Bus Master, ipRouteMetric2 is used to designate   
					the slot number of the next hop associated with this route   
					if the destination is not connected to the device. For   
					carrier devices not designated as the IP Bus Master or IP   
					Bus Master devices in which the destination is connected   
					to the device, ipRouteMetric2 contains the slot number   
					(0–15) of the carrier device. For standalone devices,   
					ipRouteMetric2 is not used and contains –1.   
					The following read-only objects must not be specified   
					in the set PDU used to add a route.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					ipRouteProto – Set to netmgmt(3) by software.   
					ipRouteAge – Defaulted to 999.   
					ipRouteInfo – Set to OBJECT IDENTIFIER {0, 0}   
					since it is unused.   
					When adding a route to the routing table using SNMP,   
					do not specify a value for ipRouteMetric2.   
					IP Group – “ipRouteDest” Object   
					(ipRouteEntry 1)   
					IP Group – “ipRouteProto” Object   
					(ipRouteEntry 9)   
					The ipRouteDest object serves as the index to the   
					routing table. Since indexes for tables must be unique,   
					only one route per destination may appear in the table. To   
					ensure that no duplicate destinations appear in the routing   
					table, the ipRouteDest object of the ipRouteTable will be   
					treated as described in RFC 1354 (IP Forwarding Table   
					MIB):   
					This object is a read-only object and may have the   
					following values in the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					other(1) – Temporary route added by IP.   
					local(2) – Route added or modified as a result of   
					user configuration via the front panel.   
					“The destination IP address of this route. An entry with   
					a value of 0.0.0.0 is considered a default route. This object   
					may not take a Multicast (Class D) address value. Any   
					assignment (implicit or otherwise) of an instance of this   
					object to a value x must be rejected if the bitwise   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					netmgmt(3) – Route added or modified by means of   
					an SNMP set.   
					icmp(4) – Route added or modified by Internet   
					Control Management Protocol (ICMP).   
					logical–AND of x with the value of the corresponding   
					instance of the ipForwardMask object is not equal to x.”   
					rip(8) – Route added or modified by Routing   
					Information Protocol (RIP) (or similar proprietary   
					protocol).   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-7   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					IP Group – “ipRouteAge” Object   
					(ipRouteEntry 10)   
					SNMP Group, MIB II   
					The SNMP Group objects that apply to a management   
					agent are fully supported by the DSU/CSU. The following   
					objects apply only to an NMS and return a zero value if   
					accessed.   
					This object is implemented as a read-only object in the   
					DSU/CSU. In the DSU/CSU, it reflects the value of the   
					route’s time-to-live (in seconds). When displays, a value   
					of 999 represents a route that is retained permanently. For   
					temporary routes, the ipRouteAge object decrements over   
					time. All routes added via an SNMP set of the   
					ipRouteTable are considered permanent routes. These   
					routes do not age, but will remain unless deleted via   
					SNMP.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					snmpInTooBigs (snmp 8)   
					snmpInNoSuchNames (snmp 9)   
					snmpInBadValues (snmp 10)   
					snmpInReadOnlys (snmp 11)   
					snmpInGenErrs (snmp 12)   
					snmpInGetResponses (snmp 18)   
					snmpInTraps (snmp19)   
					ICMP Group, MIB II   
					The ICMP Group objects are fully supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					snmpOutGetRequests (snmp 25)   
					snmpOutGetNexts (snmp 26)   
					snmpOutSetRequests (snmp 27)   
					TCP Group, MIB II   
					The TCP Group objects are fully supported by the   
					DSU/CSU, with the exception of the tcpConnState object,   
					which will be read-only.   
					DS1/E1 MIB (RFC 1406)   
					UDP Group, MIB II   
					The “ds1” object defined by RFC 1406 is supported for   
					both the network and DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interfaces. The DS1 Near End Group and DS1 Fractional   
					Group are supported for both interfaces. The DS1 Far End   
					Group is not supported.   
					The User Datagram Protocol (UDP) Group objects are   
					fully supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					Transmission Group, MIB II   
					Objects in the transmission group are supported on the   
					network and DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interfaces, the   
					COM port, the MODEM port, the AUX port, and the   
					synchronous data ports. The objects in the transmission   
					group are not defined within MIB II, but rather through   
					other Internet standard MIB definitions. The following   
					two transmission group objects are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					Near End Group, DS1/E1 MIB   
					The DS1 Near End Group consists of the following   
					four tables:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					DS1 Configuration   
					DS1 Current   
					DS1 Interval   
					DS1 Total   
					• 
					ds1 (transmission 18) – The transmission object   
					supported on the T1 interfaces.   
					• 
					rs232 (transmission 33) – The transmission object   
					supported on the synchronous data ports, COM   
					port, AUX port, and MODEM port.   
					The “ds1” transmission object is defined by the   
					DS1/E1 MIB. The rs232 transmission object is defined by   
					the RS-232-like MIB.   
					E-8   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					All four tables are fully supported for the network   
					interface. Since statistics are not kept for the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface, only the DS1   
					Configuration table is fully supported. The “statistic”   
					objects for the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface entry   
					in the DS1 Current, DS1 Interval, and DS1 Total tables   
					are always zero (null). The following sections provide   
					clarification for objects contained in the Near End Group   
					when it is not clear how the object definition in the   
					DS1/E1 MIB is related to the DSU/CSU.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1SendCode” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 7)   
					This object specifies the test patterns/codes being sent   
					over the network interface. These tests are not supported   
					on the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface. Only the   
					following values are supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					dsx1SendNoCode(1) – Specifies that the interface   
					is sending normal or looped data. Setting the   
					interface to this value stops an active “send pattern”   
					test on the interface. This is the only value   
					supported by the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1)   
					interface.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1TimeElapsed” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 3)   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					dsx1SendLineCode(2) – Specifies that the network   
					interface is sending a Remote Loopback (Rlpbk)   
					LLBUP code. The code is sent for 10 seconds.   
					Applies to the network interface only. An error status is   
					returned if access is attempted for the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface.   
					dsx1SendResetCode(4) – Specifies that the network   
					interface is sending Remote Loopback (Rlpbk)   
					LLBDN code. The code is sent for 10 seconds.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1ValidIntervals” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 4)   
					dsx1SendQRS(5) – Specifies that the network   
					interface is sending a QRSS test pattern. The   
					pattern is sent until the test is halted (i.e., setting to   
					dsx1SendNoCode).   
					Applies to the network interface only. An error status is   
					returned if access is attempted for the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface.   
					• 
					dsx1SendOtherTestPattern(8) – Specifies that the   
					network interface is sending a 1-in-8 test pattern.   
					The pattern is sent until the test is halted (i.e.,   
					setting to dsx1SendNoCode).   
					Near End Group – “dsx1LineType” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 5)   
					This object corresponds to the NET Framing/DTE   
					Framing configuration options for the T1 interfaces on the   
					DSU/CSU. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1CircuitIdentifier” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 8)   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1ESF(2) – Indicates ESF framing.   
					dsx1D4(2) – Indicates D4 framing.   
					This object is only supported on the Net T1 Interface.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1LoopbackConfig”   
					Object (dsx1ConfigEntry 9)   
					Near End Group – “dsx1LineCoding” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 6)   
					This object specifies the loopback state of the T1   
					interfaces. Only the following values are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					This object corresponds to the NET Coding/DTE   
					Coding configuration options for the T1 interfaces on the   
					DSU/CSU. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					dsx1NoLoop(1) – The T1 interface is not in a   
					loopback state.   
					• 
					dsx1PayloadLoop(2) – Specifies that a Payload   
					Loopback (PLB) is active for the network interface   
					or a Repeater Loopback (RLB) is active for the   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1B8ZS(2) – Indicates B8ZS line coding.   
					dsx1AMI(5) – Indicates AMI line coding.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-9   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					• 
					dsx1LineLoop(3) – Specifies that a Line Loopback   
					Near End Group – “dsx1TransmitClockSource”   
					Object (dsx1ConfigEntry 12)   
					(LLB) is active for the network interface or a DTE   
					Loopback (DLB) is active for the DTE Drop/Insert   
					(DSX-1) interface.   
					This object specifies the timing source for the transmit   
					clock for this T1 interface. This object differs from the   
					MIB definition in that it is “read-only” (not read/write) for   
					DSU/CSUs. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1LineStatus” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 10)   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					loopTiming(1) – The recovered receive clock is   
					being used as the transmit clock.   
					This object specifies the line (alarm) status of the T1   
					interfaces. Only the following values are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU. More than one value may be active at a time.   
					localTiming(2) – The DSU/CSU’s internal clock is   
					used being as the transmit clock.   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1NoAlarm(1) – No alarm present.   
					ThroughTiming(3) – The recovered receive clock   
					from another interface (e.g., T1, Port, or External)   
					is being used as the transmit clock.   
					dsx1RcvFarEndLOF(2) – A yellow alarm signal is   
					being received.   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1RcvAIS(8) – An Alarm Indication Signal   
					(AIS) is being received.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1Fdl” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 13)   
					dsx1LossOfFrame(32) – An Out Of Frame   
					condition has persisted for more that 2.5 seconds   
					(i.e., Red Alarm).   
					This object specifies how Facility Data Link is being   
					used. Only the following values are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU. More than one value may be active at a time.   
					• 
					dsx1LossOfSignal(64) – A Loss of Signal condition   
					has persisted for more that 2.5 seconds (i.e., Red   
					Alarm).   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1other(1) – SNMP data is being sent over FDL.   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1LoopbackState(128) – The near end of the T1   
					interface is in a loopback state.   
					dsx1Ansi-T1-403(2) – ANSI PRMs are supported   
					on the network interface as specified by   
					ANSI T1.403.   
					dsx1Other Failure(4096) – An Excessive Error Rate   
					(EER) has been detected on the network interface.   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1Att-54016(4) – FDL supports the requirements   
					specified by AT&T publication TR54016.   
					dsx1Fdl-none(8) – Indicates that the device does   
					not use FDL. This is the only value that applies to   
					the DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					Near End Group – “dsx1SignalMode” Object   
					(dsx1ConfigEntry 11)   
					This object specifies whether Robbed Bit Signaling   
					(RBS) is being used. This object differs from the MIB   
					definition in that it is “read-only” (not read/write) for   
					DSU/CSUs. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					none(1) – No signaling is being used on this   
					interface.   
					• 
					robbedBit(2) – Robbed Bit Signaling is being used   
					on at least one DS0 on this T1 interface.   
					E-10   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					Near End Group – The DS1 Current Table   
					Objects (dsx1CurrentEntry)   
					Near End Group – The DS1 Total Table Objects   
					(dsx1TotalEntry)   
					The following DS1 current table objects are provided   
					for the network interface only. Objects in the table that are   
					not listed are not supported and will return an error status   
					if access is attempted.   
					The following DS1 total table objects are provided for   
					the network interface only. Objects in the table that are not   
					listed are not supported and will return an error status if   
					access is attempted.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					dsx1CurrentIndex – The index that identifies the T1   
					interface.   
					• 
					dsx1TotalIndex – The index that identifies the T1   
					interface.   
					dsx1CurrentESs – Errored Seconds for the current   
					interval.   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1TotalESs – The 24-hour total Errored Seconds.   
					dsx1Total SESs – The 24-hour total Severely   
					Errored Seconds.   
					dsx1Current SESs – Severely Errored Seconds for   
					the current interval.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					dsx1TotalUASs – The 24-hour total Unavailable   
					Seconds.   
					dsx1CurrentUASs – Unavailable Seconds for the   
					current interval.   
					dsx1TotalCSSs – The 24-hour total Controlled Slip   
					Seconds.   
					dsx1CurrentCSSs – Controlled Slip Seconds for the   
					current interval.   
					dsx1TotalBESs – The 24-hour total Bursty Errored   
					Seconds.   
					dsx1CurrentBESs – Bursty Errored Seconds for the   
					current interval.   
					Far End Group, DS1/E1 MIB   
					Near End Group – The DS1 Interval Table   
					Objects (dsx1IntervalEntry)   
					The DS1 Far End Group consists of the following three   
					tables:   
					The following DS1 interval table objects are provided   
					for the network interface only. Objects in the table that are   
					not listed are not supported and will return an error status   
					if access is attempted.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					DS1 Far End Current   
					DS1 Far End Interval   
					DS1 Far End Total   
					• 
					dsx1IntervalIndex – The index that identifies the T1   
					interface.   
					These tables are not supported for either the network or   
					DTE Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface.   
					• 
					dsx1IntervalNumber – The interval number   
					(1 to 96).   
					DS1 Fractional Group, DS1/E1 MIB   
					• 
					• 
					dsx1IntervalESs – Errored Seconds for the interval.   
					The DS1 Fractional Group consists of the DS1   
					fractional table. This table (dsx1FracTable) is fully   
					supported by the DSU/CSU and allows channel (time   
					slots) to be mapped between the T1 interfaces and data   
					ports. If an invalid channel map (e.g., two interfaces   
					mapped to a single time slot, one interface mapped to two   
					T1s, etc.) is received, an error will be returned to the   
					SNMP manager. The DSU/CSU will validate all channel   
					configurations before applying them.   
					dsx1Interval SESs – Severely Errored Seconds for   
					the interval.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					dsx1IntervalUASs – Unavailable Seconds for the   
					interval.   
					dsx1IntervalCSSs – Controlled Slip Seconds for the   
					interval.   
					dsx1Interval BESs – Bursty Errored Seconds for   
					the interval.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-11   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Operational Note: The fractional T1 group only allows   
					specification of an entire interface to a particular time slot   
					on another interface (i.e., a time slot on one interface   
					cannot be mapped to a time slot on another interface).   
					This prevents complete mapping of time slots on the DTE   
					Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface to time slots on the   
					network interface. For mapping time slots between the   
					network and DTE T1 interfaces, the following convention   
					is used: Time slots on the T1 interface that are mapped to   
					another T1 interface (i.e., not a data port) are connected in   
					ascending order. For example, if the fractional table for   
					the network interface maps time slots 1, 3 and 5 to the   
					DTE T1 interface and the DTE T1 interface maps time   
					slots 10, 11 and 15 to the network the following time slots   
					will be connected: N1 to D10, N3 to D11 and N5 to D15.   
					General Port Table, RS-232-like MIB   
					The general port table contains general configuration   
					objects for the RS-232-like interfaces.   
					General Port Table – “rs232PortIndex” Object   
					(rs232PortEntry 1)   
					This object contains a unique value for each port and is   
					used as an index into the general port table   
					(rs232PortTable). The values of the rs232PortIndex object   
					vary between models and are listed below.   
					The values of rs232PortIndex for the 3160 DSU/CSU   
					are:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					1 – COM port   
					2 – Modem port   
					3 – Auxiliary RS-232 port   
					4 – DCE port 1   
					RS-232-like MIB (RFC 1317)   
					The “rs232” object defined by RFC 1317 is supported   
					for all of the synchronous data ports, the MODEM port,   
					the COM port, and the AUX port. The RS-232-like MIB   
					consists of one object and five tables, as follows:   
					5 – DCE port 2   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Number of RS-232-like ports   
					The General Port Table   
					The values of rs232PortIndex for the 3164 DSU/CSU   
					are:   
					• 
					1 – COM port   
					The Asynchronous Port Table   
					The Synchronous Port Table   
					The Input Signal Table   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					2 – Modem port   
					3 – Auxiliary RS-232 port   
					4 – DCE port 1   
					5 – DCE port 2   
					6 – DCE port 3   
					7 – DCE port 4   
					The Output Signal Table   
					The Asynchronous Port table is not supported by the   
					DSU/CSU for the synchronous data ports. The Input   
					Signal and Output Signal tables are not supported for the   
					MODEM, AUX, and COM ports. The following sections   
					provide clarification for objects contained in the   
					RS-232-like MIB when it is not clear how the object   
					definition in MIB is related to the DSU/CSU.   
					The values of rs232PortIndex for the 3165 DSU/CSU   
					are:   
					• 
					1 – COM port   
					2 – Modem port   
					3 – DCE port 1   
					• 
					• 
					Number of Ports – “rs232Number” Object   
					(rs232 1)   
					This object contains the number of ports in the   
					RS-232-like general port table. This number is 5 for the   
					3160, 7 for the 3164, 3 for the 3165 and 2 for the 3161.   
					The values of rs232PortIndex for the carrier 3161   
					DSU/CSU are:   
					• 
					• 
					1 – DCE port 1   
					2 – DCE port 2 or COM port (depending upon   
					configuration)   
					E-12   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					General Port Table – “rs232PortType” Object   
					(rs232PortEntry 2)   
					General Port Table – “rs232PortOutSpeed”   
					Object (rs232PortEntry 6)   
					This object is used to identify the port’s hardware type.   
					Only the following values are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					This object contains the port’s output speed in bits per   
					second. For the DSU/CSU, the rs232PortInSpeed object   
					has the same value as the rs232PortOutSpeed object. The   
					input speed of a synchronous data port is determined by   
					the channel configuration and cannot be changed through   
					this object. Thus, for the synchronous data ports, this   
					object is read-only. The input speed of the MODEM,   
					AUX, or COM port is the currently configured speed.   
					Setting of this value for the MODEM, AUX, or COM port   
					causes the configured port speed to be changed.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					rs232(2) – Used to identify the MODEM, AUX,   
					and COM ports.   
					rs422(3) – Used to identify synchronous data ports   
					that are configured as EIA-530A or RS-449.   
					V35(5) – Used to identify synchronous data ports   
					that are configured as V.35.   
					Asynchronous Port Table, RS-232-like MIB   
					General Port Table – “rs232PortInSigNumber”   
					Object (rs232PortEntry 3)   
					The asynchronous port table contains an entry for the   
					MODEM, AUX, or COM port when the port is configured   
					for asynchronous operation. For the DSU/CSU, the entries   
					in the table that are counters (rs232AsyncPortEntry 6–8)   
					are used to collect statistics and are not supported.   
					This object contains the number of input signals   
					contained in the input signal table. This is the number of   
					signals that can be detected. This number is 2 for the   
					synchronous data ports and 0 for the MODEM, AUX, and   
					COM ports.   
					Asynchronous Port Table, “rs232AsyncPortBits”   
					(rs232AsyncPortEntry 2)   
					General Port Table – “rs232PortOutSigNumber”   
					Object (rs232PortEntry 4)   
					This object specifies the number of bits in a character.   
					Only the following values are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					This object contains the number of output signals   
					contained in the output signal table. This is the number of   
					signals that can be asserted. This number is 2 for the   
					synchronous data ports and 0 for the MODEM, AUX,   
					and COM ports.   
					• 
					7 – 7-bit characters. Supported on the COM and   
					MODEM ports only.   
					• 
					8 – 8-bit characters.   
					General Port Table – “rs232PortInSpeed”   
					Object (rs232PortEntry 5)   
					Asynchronous Port Table,   
					“rs232AsyncPortStopBits”   
					(rs232AsyncPortEntry 3)   
					This object contains the port’s input speed in bits per   
					second. For the DSU/CSU, the rs232PortInSpeed object   
					has the same value as the rs232PortOutSpeed object. The   
					input speed of a synchronous data port is determined by   
					the channel configuration and cannot be changed through   
					this object. Thus, for the synchronous data ports, this   
					object is read-only. The input speed of the MODEM,   
					AUX, or COM port is the currently configured speed.   
					Setting of this value for the MODEM, AUX, or COM port   
					causes the configured port speed to be changed.   
					This object specifies the number of stop bits supported.   
					Only the following values are supported by the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					one(1) – One stop bit.   
					two(2) – Two stop bits. Supported on the COM and   
					MODEM ports only.   
					• 
					one-and-half(3) – One and a half stop bits.   
					Supported on the COM port only.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-13   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Asynchronous Port Table,   
					“rs232AsyncPortParity”   
					(rs232AsyncPortEntry 4)   
					Input Signal Table – “rs232InSigName”   
					(rs232InSigEntry 2)   
					This object contains the identification of a hardware   
					input signal. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					This object specifies the parity used by the port. Only   
					the following values are supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					rts(1) – Request-To-Send.   
					• 
					• 
					none(1) – No parity bit.   
					dtr(4) – Data Terminal Ready.   
					odd(2) – Odd parity. Supported on the COM and   
					MODEM ports only.   
					• 
					even(3) – Even parity. Supported on the COM and   
					MODEM ports only.   
					Input Signal Table – “rs232InSigState”   
					(rs232InSigEntry 3)   
					This object contains the current signal state. Only the   
					following values are supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					Asynchronous Port Table,   
					“rs232AsyncPortAutoBaud”   
					(rs232AsyncPortEntry 5)   
					• 
					• 
					on(2) – The signal is asserted.   
					off(3) – The signal is not asserted.   
					This object specifies the ability to automatically sense   
					the input speed of the port. Only the following value is   
					supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					Input Signal Table – “rs232InSigChanges”   
					(rs232InSigEntry 4)   
					• 
					disabled(2) – Autobaud is not supported.   
					This object is not supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					Synchronous Port Table, RS-232-like MIB   
					The synchronous port table contains an entry for each   
					of the synchronous data ports and the MODEM or COM   
					port when the port is configured for synchronous   
					operation. For the DSU/CSU, the entries in the table that   
					are counters (rs232SyncPortEntry 3–7) are used to collect   
					statistics and are not supported.   
					Output Signal Table, RS-232-like MIB   
					This object contains entries for the output signals that   
					can be asserted by the unit for each of the synchronous   
					data ports.   
					Output Signal Table – “rs232OutSigName”   
					(rs232OutSigEntry 2)   
					Synchronous Port Table –   
					“rs232SyncPortClockSource”   
					(rs232SyncPortEntry 2)   
					This object contains the identification of a hardware   
					output signal. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					This object specifies the clock source for the port. Only   
					the following values are supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					cts(1) – Clear-To-Send.   
					dsr(4) – Data Set Ready.   
					• 
					• 
					internal(1) – The port uses an internal clock.   
					external(2) – The port uses an external clock.   
					Output Signal Table – “rs232OutSigState”   
					(rs232OutSigEntry 3)   
					Input Signal Table, RS-232-like MIB   
					This table contains entries for the input signals that can   
					be detected by the unit for each of the synchronous data   
					ports.   
					This object contains the current signal state. Only the   
					following values are supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					on(2) – The signal is asserted.   
					off(3) – The signal is not asserted.   
					E-14   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					• 
					• 
					noTest – Stops the test in progress on the interface.   
					Output Signal Table – “rs232OutSigChanges”   
					(rs232OutSigEntry 4)   
					testFullDuplexLoopBack – Initiates a DCLB on the   
					interface. Only supported for the data ports.   
					This object is not supported by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					• 
					testLoopDTLB – Initiates a DTLB on the interface.   
					Only supported for the data ports.   
					Generic-Interface MIB   
					Extensions (RFC 1229)   
					testMonQRSS – Initiates a Monitor QRSS test on   
					the interface. Supported for the data ports and the   
					network interface.   
					This generic-interface MIB is an experimental MIB   
					that provides extensions to the generic interface group   
					defined in MIB II. This MIB describes three tables:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					testMon511 – Initiates a Monitor 511 test on the   
					interface. Only supported for the data ports.   
					testSendQRSS – Initiates a Send QRSS test on the   
					interface. Only supported for the data ports.   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Generic Interface Extension Table   
					Generic Interface Test Table   
					testSend511 – Initiates a send 511 test on the   
					interface. Only supported for the data ports.   
					Generic Receive Address Table   
					testSendV54Up – Sends a V54 up code to the   
					remote unit. Only supported for the data ports.   
					Only the generic interface test table is supported by the   
					DSU/CSU. This table is supported for the network   
					interface only.   
					testSendV54Down – Sends a V54 down code to the   
					remote unit. Only supported for the data ports.   
					testSendFT1Up – ends a FT1 up code to the remote   
					unit. Only supported for the data ports.   
					Generic Interface Test Table, Generic   
					Interface MIB   
					testSendFT1Down – Sends a FT1 down code to the   
					remote unit. Only supported for the data ports.   
					The test table provides access to additional tests   
					(loopbacks and pattern tests) that are not in the interface   
					group of MIB II.   
					Where these object identifiers are defined as follows:   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					testLoopDTLB – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 2]   
					Generic Interface Test Table – “ifExtnsTestType”   
					Object (ifExtnsTestEntry 4)   
					testMonQRSS – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 3]   
					This object is a control variable used to start and stop   
					operator-initiated tests on the interface. It provides the   
					capability to:   
					testMon511 – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 4]   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Start/stop the Monitor QRSS test pattern on the   
					network interface.   
					testSendQRSS – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 5]   
					Start/stop the Send QRSS/511 test pattern on a   
					synchronous data port.   
					testSend511 – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 6]   
					Start sending a V.54/FT1 UP/DOWN code to the   
					remote unit for a synchronous data port.   
					testSendV54Up – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 7]   
					Start/stop the Monitor QRSS/511 test pattern on a   
					synchronous data port.   
					testSendV54Down – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 8]   
					Start/stop the DCLB/DTLB loopback test on a   
					synchronous data port.   
					testSendFT1Up – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 9]   
					The following object identifiers are used to control the   
					tests on the interface.   
					testSendFT1Down – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownTests 10]   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-15   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Where these object identifiers are defined as follows:   
					Generic Interface Test Table –   
					“ifExtnsTestResult” Object (ifExtnsTestEntry 5)   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					• 
					wellKnownCodes – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[ifExtensions 5]   
					This object contains the result of the most recently   
					requested test. Only the following values are supported by   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					none – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownCodes 1]   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					none(1) – No test currently active.   
					inSyncNoBitErrors – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownCodes 2]   
					inProgress(3) – A test is currently in progress.   
					inSyncWithBitErrors – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownCodes 3]   
					notSupported(4) – The requested test is not   
					supported.   
					notInSync – OBJECT IDENTIFIER ::=   
					[wellKnownCodes 4]   
					• 
					unAbleToRun(5) – The requested test cannot run   
					due to the state of the unit.   
					Generic Interface Test Table –   
					“ifExtnsTestCode” Object   
					(ifExtnsTestEntry 6)   
					Enterprise MIB   
					The variable devConfigAreaCopy under the   
					devConfigAreaCopy group in the common area of the   
					Enterprise MIB will be fully supported. This variable   
					allows the entire contents of one configuration area to be   
					copied into another configuration area.   
					This object contains a code that contains more specific   
					information on the test result. This object is defined as an   
					object identifier. Only the following values are supported   
					by the DSU/CSU.   
					• 
					none – No further information is available. Used for   
					the send pattern/code and loopback tests.   
					Correlation between Menu   
					Commands and SNMP Objects   
					
					function is performed or status is displayed on the front   
					panel and how the same function is accomplished using   
					access to the SNMP database. SNMP objects are   
					displayed in bold type while values for SNMP objects are   
					displayed in italics.   
					• 
					inSyncNoBitErrors – A monitor pattern (QRSS or   
					511) test has synchronized on the pattern and has   
					not detected any bit errors.   
					• 
					• 
					inSyncWithBitErrors – A monitor pattern (QRSS or   
					511) test has synchronized on the pattern and has   
					detected bit errors.   
					notInSync – A monitor pattern (QRSS or 511) test   
					has not synchronized on the requested pattern.   
					E-16   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					Table E-1   
					(1 of 3)   
					SNMP MIB to Front Panel Command Cross-Reference   
					Front Panel Command   
					SNMP MIB Object   
					Stat–>DevHS:   
					Read the dsx1LineStatus object for NET T1   
					dsx1LossOfSignal   
					LOS at NET   
					OOF at NET   
					Yellow at NET   
					AIS at NET   
					dsx1LossOfFrame   
					dsx1RcvFarEnd   
					dsx1RcvAIS   
					EER at NET   
					dsx1OtherFailure   
					Stat–>DevHS:   
					Read the dsx1LineStatus object for DTE T1   
					dsx1LossOfSignal   
					LOS at DTE   
					OOF at DTE   
					Yellow at DTE   
					AIS at DTE   
					dsx1LossOfFrame   
					dsx1RcvFarEnd   
					dsx1RcvAIS   
					Stat–>Perf–>Telco–>Cur:   
					Read the value in the following objects for NET T1   
					dsx1TimeElapsed   
					CurTimer   
					ES   
					dsx1CurrentES   
					UAS   
					dsx1CurrentUAS   
					SES   
					dsx1CurrentSES   
					BES   
					dsx1CurrentBES   
					CSS   
					dsx1CurrentCSS   
					Stat–>Perf–>Telco–>Intvl–>Dsply:   
					Select the interval number with dsx1IntervalNumber. Read the value   
					in the following objects for NET T1   
					dsx1IntervalES   
					ES   
					UAS   
					SES   
					BES   
					CSS   
					VldIntvl   
					dsx1IntervalUAS   
					dsx1IntervalSES   
					dsx1IntervalBES   
					dsx1IntervalCSS   
					dsx1ValidIntervals   
					Stat–>Perf–>Telco–>24Tot:   
					Read the value in the following objects for NET T1   
					dsx1ValidIntervals   
					dsx1TotalES   
					VldIntvl   
					ES   
					UAS   
					SES   
					BES   
					CSS   
					dsx1TotalUAS   
					dsx1TotalSES   
					dsx1TotalBES   
					dsx1TotalCSS   
					Stat–>Tstat:   
					Read:   
					LLB Test Active   
					PLB Test Active   
					RLB Test Active   
					DLB Test Active   
					DCLB on Port n   
					DTLB on Port n   
					1–8 Test Active   
					QRSS Test Active   
					QRSS on Port n   
					511 on Port n   
					dsx1LineLoop from dsx1LoopbackConfig for Net T1   
					dsx1PayloadLoop from dsx1LoopbackConfig for Net T1   
					dsx1PayloadLoop from dsx1LoopbackConfig for DTE T1   
					dsx1LineLoop from dsx1LoopbackConfig for DTE T1   
					testFullDuplexLoopback from IfExtnsTestType for Port n   
					testLoopDTLB from IfExtnsTestType for Port n   
					dsx1SendOtherTestPattern from dsx1SendCode for Net T1   
					dsx1SendQRS from dsx1SendCode for Net T1   
					testSendQRSS from IfExtnsTestType for Port n   
					testSend511 from IfExtnsTestType for Port n   
					testMonQRSS from ifExtnsTestType for Net T1   
					testMonQRSS from ifExtnsTestType for Port n   
					testMon511 from ifExtnsTestType for Port n   
					Monitoring QRSS   
					Mon QRSS, Port n   
					Mon511, Port n   
					Stat–>LED–>Prtn:   
					Read:   
					DTR   
					CTS   
					RTS   
					rs232InSigState from rs232InSigName == dtr   
					rs232outSigState from rs232OutSigName == cts   
					rs232InSigState from rs232InSigName == rts   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					E-17   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Table E-1   
					(2 of 3)   
					SNMP MIB to Front Panel Command Cross-Reference   
					Front Panel Command   
					SNMP MIB Object   
					Stat–>ID:   
					Ser   
					Mod   
					Read the sysDescr object from the System Group   
					SRev   
					HRevCCA1   
					HRevCCA2   
					Test–>Rlpbk–>LLBUP   
					Set dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendLineCode   
					Test–>Rlpbk–>LLBDN   
					Set dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendResetCode   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testSendV54Up   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testSendV54Down   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testSendFT1UP   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testSendFT1Down   
					Test–>Rlpbk–>54UP–>Prtn   
					Test–>Rlpbk–>54DN–>Prtn   
					Test–>Rlpbk–>FT1UP–>Prtn   
					Test–>Rlpbk–>FT1DN–>Prtn   
					Test–>Lpbk–>LLB   
					Test–>Lpbk–>Abort–>LLB   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for Net T1 to dsx1LineLoop   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for Net T1 to dsx1NoLoop   
					Test–>Lpbk–>PLB   
					Test–>Lpbk–>Abort–>PLB   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for Net T1 to dsx1PayloadLoop   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for Net T1 to dsx1NoLoop   
					Test–>Lpbk–>DLB   
					Test–>Lpbk–>Abort–>DLB   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for DTE T1 to dsx1LineLoop   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for DTE T1 to dsx1NoLoop   
					Test–>Lpbk–>RLB   
					Test–>Lpbk–>Abort–>RLB   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for DTE T1 to dsx1PayloadLoop   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for DTE T1 to dsx1NoLoop   
					Test–>Lpbk–>DCLB–>Prtn   
					Test–>Lpbk–>Abort–>DCLB–>Prtn   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testFullDuplexLoopBack   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for port n to noTest   
					Test–>Lpbk–>DTLB–>Prtn   
					Test–>Lpbk–>Abort–>DTLB–>Prtn   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testLoopDTLB   
					Set dsx1LoopbackConfig for port n to noTest   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Send–>QRSS–>NET   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Send–>NET   
					Set dsx1SendCode for Net T1 to dsx1SendQRSS   
					Set dsx1SendCode for Net T1 to dsx1SendNoCode   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Send–>QRSS–>Prtn   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Send–>Prtn   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testSendQRS   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to noTest   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Send–>1in8   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Send–>NET   
					Set dsx1SendCode for Net T1 to dsx1SendOtherTestPattern   
					Set dsx1SendCode for Net T1 to dsx1SendNoCode   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Send–>511–>Prtn   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Send–>Prtn   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to testSend511   
					Set IfExtnsTestType for port n to noTest   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Mon–>QRSS–>NET   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Mon–>NET   
					Set ifExtnsTestType for Net T1 to testMonQRSS   
					Set ifExtnsTestType for Net T1 to noTest   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Mon–>QRSS–>Prtn   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Mon–>Prtn   
					Set ifExtnsTestType for port n to testMonQRSS   
					Set ifExtnsTestType for port n to noTest   
					E-18   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				SNMP MIB Objects   
					Table E-1   
					(3 of 3)   
					SNMP MIB to Front Panel Command Cross-Reference   
					Front Panel Command   
					SNMP MIB Object   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Mon–>511–>Prtn   
					Test–>Ptrns–>Abort–>Mon–>Prtn   
					Set ifExtnsTestType for port n to testMon511   
					Set ifExtnsTestType for port n to noTest   
					Cnfig–>Load Cnfig–>Save   
					Set devConfigAreaCopy to the desired choice(Active to   
					Customer1, etc.)   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>DTE–>DTE–>Framing   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>DTE–>DTE–>Coding   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Port–>Prtn->Port Type   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Port–>Prtn–>TxClock   
					Set/Display dsx1LineType for DTE T1 to dsx1ESF or dsx1D4   
					Set/Display dsx1LineCoding for DTE T1 to dsx1B8ZS or dsx1AMI   
					Display rs232PortType for port n to rs422 or v35   
					Set/Display rs232SyncPortClockSource for port n to internal or   
					external   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>NET–>NET Framing   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>NET–>NET Coding   
					Set/Display dsx1LineType for NET T1 to dsx1ESF or dsx1D4   
					Set/Display dsx1LineCoding for NET T1 to dsx1B8ZS or dsx1AMI   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>NET–>ANSI PRM   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>NET–>Mgmt Link   
					Set/Display dsx1Fdl for NET T1 to dsx1Ansi–T1–403 or   
					dsx1Att–54016 or dsx1other   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Chan–>DTE–>Assign   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Chan–>DTE–>Voice   
					Set/Display dsx1FracNumber and dsx1FracIfindex for DTE T1   
					Display dsx1SignalMode for DTE T1 to none or robbedBit   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Chan–>Prtn–>Assign To   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Chan–>Display   
					Set/Display dsx1FracNumber and dsx1Fracifindex for DTE or   
					Net T1   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Chan–>Prtn–>Port Rate   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>Gen–>Clock Src   
					Display rs232PortInSpeed or rs232PortOutSpeed for port n   
					Display dsx1TransmitClockSource for DTE T1 or NET T1   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>Com Rate   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>Aux Rate   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>Modem Rate   
					Set/Display rs232PortInSpeed or rs232PortOutSpeed for COM,   
					AUX, or MODEM port   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>Char Length   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>MChar Len   
					Set/Display rs232AyncPortBits for COM or MODEM port   
					Set/Display rs232AyncPortParity for COM or MODEM port   
					Set/Display rs232AyncPortStopBits for COM or MODEM port   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>CParity   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>MParity   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>CStop Bits   
					Cnfig–>Activ–>Edit–>User–>MStop Bits   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					E-19   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				IP Network Addressing Scenarios   
					F 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-1   
					Scenario 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-2   
					Scenario 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-3   
					Scenario 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-4   
					Scenario 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-5   
					Scenario 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-6   
					• 
					• 
					• 
					Although routing table entries are maintained   
					Overview   
					automatically by 31xx Series devices, without the   
					need for user configuration, only a maximum of   
					100 routes is supported for a given device.   
					This appendix describes a means of configuring 31xx   
					Series devices in an Internet Protocol (IP) network to   
					provide SNMP or Telnet connectivity. Since there are   
					many possible network addressing schemes, this appendix   
					describes an addressing scheme for typical customer   
					network management system (NMS) scenarios. This   
					appendix is not intended to be an IP addressing or routing   
					tutorial, and a basic understanding of IP and 31xx Series   
					devices is assumed.   
					The choice of a host address within a given subnet   
					is completely arbitrary. Choose any legal host   
					address for a given subnet, without regard to the   
					local or remote devices.   
					Although the default route (to the NMS) is   
					configurable for all devices, only devices that have   
					a direct external connection to an NMS (via the   
					COM or AUX ports) need a default route set. In the   
					following examples, the default port (COM or   
					AUX) is set in the device connected to the LAN   
					Adapter.   
					The following notes apply to these scenarios:   
					• 
					Connections to remote devices may be via EDL   
					(for 2-port and 4-port DSU/CSUs) or FDL;   
					however, the FDL is only available on full T1 links   
					(not fractional T1s). Check with the service   
					provider to be sure that the FDL is end-to-end (i.e.,   
					not terminated at an intermediate point within the   
					network).   
					• 
					Interconnected 31xx Series devices automatically   
					pass routing information between them; however, a   
					static route to the subnet(s) must be set in the   
					routing table of the NMS host. This route uses the   
					31xx Series device connected to the LAN (via the   
					LAN Adapter), or the NMS (via a direct PPP or   
					SLIP connection) as a gateway to the subnet(s). In   
					all instances, the addressing scheme presented   
					works for both the LAN and the direct connections.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					F-1   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Scenario 1   
					
					31xx Series devices daisy chained together, with remotes   
					connected via the FDL. In this scenario, all 31xx Series   
					devices are on the same subnet (135.18.1.0). The subnet   
					mask for each device is FF.FF.FF.00. A static route is set   
					in the NMS host to subnet 135.18.1.0.   
					ETHERNET   
					135.18.40.1   
					135.18.1.2   
					NETWORK   
					135.18.1.3   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					SUBNET 135.18.40.0   
					AUX/COM IP ADDRESS: 135.18.40.2   
					135.18.1.4   
					135.18.1.5   
					SUBNET 135.18.1.0   
					135.18.1.1   
					135.18.1.7   
					135.18.1.6   
					496-14645-03   
					Figure F-1. Daisy-Chained Standalone at the Central Site   
					F-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				IP Network Addressing Scenarios   
					Scenario 2   
					
					communicating with standalone remotes. This scenario is   
					similar to the previous one, treating the carrier devices as   
					the daisy-chained devices. All devices are still on the   
					same subnet, and the subnet mask is FF.FF.FF.00. A static   
					route still must be set in the NMS host to subnet   
					135.18.2.0.   
					ETHERNET   
					135.18.40.1   
					135.18.2.17   
					NETWORK   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					SUBNET 135.18.40.0   
					135.18.2.18   
					COM IP ADDRESS: 135.18.40.3   
					FT1   
					SUBNET 135.18.2.0   
					T1   
					135.18.2.26   
					135.18.2.1   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					135.18.2.16   
					496-14646-02   
					Figure F-2. Local Carrier with Remote Standalone   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					F-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Scenario 3   
					This third scenario (Figure F-3) shows a local carrier   
					connected to remote carriers that have remote standalones.   
					Each carrier must be on a separate subnet but, as in the   
					previous scenario, the carrier-remote combination can   
					share a common subnet. Once again, the subnet mask is   
					FF.FF.FF.00 for all devices. A static route must be set up   
					in the NMS host for each subnet: 135.18.4.0, 135.18.6.0,   
					135.18.20.0.   
					135.18.6.22   
					T1   
					135.18.20.23   
					135.18.20.45   
					T1   
					T1   
					T1   
					135.18.20.1 . . . . 135.18.20.16   
					135.18.6.1 . . . . 135.18.6.16   
					135.18.6.34   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					SUBNET 135.18.6.0   
					SUBNET 135.18.20.0   
					T1   
					ETHERNET   
					T1   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					COM IP   
					ADDRESS:   
					135.18.40.4   
					135.18.4.1 . . . . 135.18.4.16   
					135.18.40.1   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					SUBNET 135.18.40.0   
					SUBNET 135.18.4.0   
					Figure F-3. Local Carrier Connection to Remote Carriers   
					F-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				IP Network Addressing Scenarios   
					Scenario 4   
					An alternative addressing scheme, for the network is   
					
					FF.FF.00.00 for the COM port in the central-site carrier   
					(only), with all of the remaining subnet masks set to   
					FF.FF.FF.00. The advantage to this scheme is that only   
					one route must be added to the NMS host (135.18.0.0).   
					135.19.6.22   
					T1   
					135.19.20.23   
					T1   
					T1   
					T1   
					135.19.20.1 . . . . 135.19.20.16   
					135.19.6.1 . . . . 135.19.6.16   
					135.19.6.34   
					135.19.20.45   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					T1   
					ETHERNET   
					T1   
					COM IP   
					ADDRESS:   
					135.18.40.4   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					COM   
					SUBNET MASK:   
					FF:FF:00:00   
					135.19.1.1 . . . . 135.19.1.16   
					135.18.40.1   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					SUBNET 135.18.40.0   
					SUBNET 135.19.0.0   
					496-14648-02   
					Figure F-4. Local Carrier Connected to Remote Carriers – an Alternative   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					F-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Scenario 5   
					
					carrier connected to different NMSs. This might be used   
					in service-provider applications, where some of the   
					carrier’s circuit cards (and their remotes) are managed by   
					one NMS and other cards are managed by a different   
					NMS. In this example, each card and remote is on a   
					separate subnet. Also, note that each LAN Adapter   
					connection is on a different subnet. The subnet mask is   
					FF.FF.FF.00. The NMS hosts would only need routes   
					added for the subnets that they are to manage.   
					SUBNET 135.18.23.0   
					SUBNET 135.18.34.0   
					T1   
					T1   
					135.18.23.2   
					135.18.34.2   
					COM IP   
					ADDRESS:   
					135.140.22.95   
					COM IP   
					ADDRESS:   
					135.18.40.5   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					LAN   
					ADAPTER   
					COMSPHERE 3000   
					135.140.22.79   
					ETHERNET   
					135.18.40.1   
					ETHERNET   
					SUBNET 135.140.22.0   
					SUBNET 135.18.40.0   
					496-14649-02   
					Figure F-5. Multiple COM Ports Connected to Different NMSs.   
					F-6   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Front Panel Emulation   
					G 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G-1   
					Installing Front Panel Emulation Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G-1   
					Starting Front Panel Emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G-2   
					Overview   
					Installing Front Panel   
					Emulation Software   
					The Front Panel Emulation software is supplied on a   
					3.5-inch, 1.44 MB, double-sided, high-density,   
					write-protected diskette, with 15 sectors per track,   
					80 tracks per side, and 96 tracks per inch.   
					The DSU/CSU offers functionality through Front Panel   
					Emulation software that is similar to that provided by the   
					DSU/CSU front panel. The DSU/CSU can either be   
					locally or remotely attached to a 386 or higher PC that has   
					at least 4 MB of RAM. A copy of the DSU/CSU front   
					panel appears on the PC. The functionality of the front   
					panel is available by clicking on the Function keys with   
					the mouse rather than by pressing keys from the actual   
					front panel.   
					This software must be installed on a 386 or higher PC   
					with Microsoft Windows Release 3.1 or higher, MS-DOS   
					3.3 or higher, and at least 4 MB of RAM. A VGA color   
					monitor with VGA adapter (or higher resolution) is   
					required. A mouse is also required. The following   
					procedures must be performed in the Windows   
					environment.   
					For carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs, a single PC is used to   
					access all of the slots in the carrier. The PC is connected   
					locally to a single slot containing either a 3151 CSU or   
					3161 DSU/CSU that has been configured to enable a   
					shared COM port on the Auxiliary Backplane. The   
					attached PC can access any 3151/3161 device attached to   
					the Auxiliary Backplane. For more information about   
					using the COM port on the carrier, refer to the   
					ACCULINK 3151 CSU and 3161 DSU/CSU General   
					Information Guide.   
					To install Front Panel Emulation software,   
					1. Insert the diskette into the appropriate drive.   
					2. Select File from Program Manager.   
					3. Choose Run.   
					4. Type A:INSTALLand click OK.   
					5. An Information screen appears. Choose Continue   
					to continue the installation.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					G-1   
					 
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					6. Type the letter of the destination drive, followed   
					by a colon (default is C:), then the appropriate   
					directory name (default is C:\FRONTPAN).   
					3. Double click on the Front Panel icon that appears   
					in the Front Panel window. The Front Panel   
					Emulation screen appears.   
					If the selected directory already exists, the   
					following message appears: The specified   
					directory already exists. Do you want to   
					overwrite the directory?   
					4. Enter the Com Port and Speed from the   
					drop-down selection list boxes.   
					If the selected directory is new, the following   
					message appears: The specified directory does   
					not exist. Do you want to create the directory?   
					7. Select Yes. A confirmation screen appears. Select   
					Install to continue the installation.   
					8. A Setup Completed screen appears. Select   
					Continue. The Program Manager screen appears   
					with the Front Panel icon.   
					The Com Port field needs to contain the actual   
					communications port name as recorded in the   
					Windows information file (INI).   
					Starting Front Panel   
					Emulation   
					If the DSU/CSU selected is not locally attached to the   
					PC, you must first dial to the remote DSU/CSU before   
					starting front panel emulation. The modem attached to the   
					PC must support AT commands for the Front Panel   
					Emulation software to successfully place the call.   
					The Speed field needs to contain one of the   
					following communications speeds: 1200, 2400,   
					4800, 9600, 14400, 19200, or 38400 and should   
					match the DSU/CSU’s COM port configuration.   
					5. Choose either a Local (for near-end DSU/CSU) or   
					Remote (for far-end DSU/CSU) destination.   
					To start front panel emulation,   
					6. If you chose a Local destination, click on the   
					Execute button. If you chose a Remote   
					destination, enter the telephone number of the   
					far-end DSU/CSU in the Phone Number field,   
					then click on the Dial button.   
					1. From the PC, open Program Manager from   
					Windows.   
					2. Double click on the Front Panel icon that appears   
					after the Front Panel Emulation program is   
					installed on the PC. The Front Panel window   
					opens.   
					7. The front panel of the selected DSU/CSU appears   
					on the PC.   
					NOTE   
					When using Front Panel   
					Emulation, no LEDs are shown on   
					the PC’s screen; you must use   
					the Stat command procedure to   
					get LED information (see the   
					Displaying LED Conditions   
					section in Chapter 3, Operation).   
					G-2   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					H 
					Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-1   
					Before Using the Async Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-1   
					Initiating an Async Terminal Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-2   
					Ending an Async Terminal Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-2   
					Menu Organization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-3   
					Using Async Terminal Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-4   
					Setting Customer Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-5   
					Displaying LED Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-6   
					Changing Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-7   
					Displaying or Editing Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-7   
					Saving Edit Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-9   
					Establishing Access Security on a Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-10   
					Setting a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-11   
					Entering a Password to Gain Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-12   
					Configuration Worksheets for the Async Terminal Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-13   
					Before using the async terminal, you may use the   
					DSU/CSU’s front panel to set certain configuration   
					options for async terminal operation. Use the   
					Configuration (Cnfig) branch of the front panel menu and   
					edit the User Interface (User) configuration options for   
					
					
					
					Overview   
					You can configure and manage the DSU/CSU from an   
					asynchronous (async) terminal that is configured for   
					9.6 kbps, 8 characters, no parity, and 1 stop bit.   
					This appendix provides operational examples to help   
					you become familiar with the use of the async terminal for   
					DSU/CSU control.   
					To connect the async terminal to the DSU/CSU using   
					
					
					By convention throughout this appendix, examples of   
					screens are shown as they appear with the standalone   
					4-port DSU/CSU.   
					If the DSU/CSU is misconfigured, leaving it in a state   
					that does not support async terminal operation, the   
					recovery procedure consists of power cycling the   
					DSU/CSU, waiting for the completion of the power-up   
					self-test, and then pressing the async terminal’s Return   
					key five times in succession. (Begin pressing the Return   
					key within two seconds after the completion of power-up   
					self-test, and do not wait longer than one second between   
					each successive key press.) This procedure allows you to   
					use the System Paused screen to reset the COM port   
					configuration options or to reload all factory default   
					configuration options.   
					Before Using the Async   
					Terminal   
					You can connect the async terminal directly to the   
					COM port of the DSU/CSU, or you can establish a remote   
					connection using dial-in (via the integral modem) or   
					Telnet access.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					H-1   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					If a password is required, the Login screen displays the   
					
					
					Initiating an Async Terminal   
					Session   
					To move between the Screen area and the Screen   
					
					and a).   
					Once the appropriate configuration option changes   
					have been made and access is established, the Main Menu   
					screen appears (unless a password is required).   
					From the Screen area, you may select the Status, Test,   
					Configuration, or Control branches.   
					
					standalone DSU/CSU.   
					The carrier-mounted DSU/CSU shows the 3000 Series   
					carrier slot number under the Customer ID. The slot   
					number field (e.g., Slot: 1) is changed to access specific   
					DSU/CSUs in the carrier. For Telnet or SNMP access to   
					the carrier, specify the IP address of the applicable   
					
					
					Ending an Async Terminal   
					Session   
					To end the async terminal session from any screen,   
					
					Function Keys area (Figure H-1), and then select Exit.   
					NOTE   
					By convention throughout this   
					appendix, examples of screens   
					are shown as they appear with   
					the standalone DSU/CSU.   
					main   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					MAIN MENU   
					Status   
					Test   
					Configuration   
					Control   
					Screen   
					Area   
					Screen   
					Function   
					Keys   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions Exit   
					Area   
					Figure H-1. Main Menu Screen   
					H-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					cases, provide a more direct access to an option or   
					function.   
					Menu Organization   
					Async terminal menus differ from front panel menus in   
					that they typically do not use abbreviations and, in some   
					
					terminal menu tree.   
					Main   
					Status   
					Test   
					Configuration   
					Control   
					Call   
					Directories   
					Start   
					Download   
					Select   
					LEDs   
					Administer   
					Password   
					Cross Connect   
					Status   
					Display   
					LEDs   
					Performance   
					Statistics   
					Identity   
					Call   
					Setup   
					Customer ID   
					Reset   
					Device   
					System and   
					Test Status   
					System   
					Alarm   
					Relay   
					Select   
					Monitor   
					Jack   
					Cut-Off   
					DTE Channel   
					Display   
					Network &   
					DTE Tests   
					Sync Data   
					Port Tests   
					Device   
					Tests   
					Network   
					Channel   
					Display   
					Port   
					Assignment   
					Display   
					Abort   
					Tests   
					Configuration   
					Edit/Display   
					Sync Data   
					Port   
					Network   
					Clear   
					Statistics   
					Network   
					DTE   
					Sync Data   
					Ports   
					Copy   
					Ports   
					Cross   
					Connect   
					General   
					User   
					Alarms Management   
					Options Interface & Traps   
					and   
					Communication   
					DTE to   
					Network   
					Sync Data   
					Port   
					Clear   
					Assignments   
					Assignments Assignments   
					Communication   
					Port   
					Front   
					Panel   
					Telnet   
					Sessions   
					Auxiliary Internal   
					Port Modem   
					External   
					Device   
					Communication General SNMP   
					Protocol Management   
					SNMP NMS   
					Security   
					SNMP   
					Traps   
					496-14997   
					Figure H-2. Menu Organization   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Using Async Terminal Screens   
					Table H-2   
					Keyboard Keys   
					There are three types of async terminal screens.   
					Keyboard Key   
					Usage   
					• 
					• 
					Menu screens list selections available through the   
					menu system.   
					Ctrl-a   
					Moves the cursor between   
					the Screen area and the   
					Screen Function Keys   
					area.   
					Input screens allow you to edit or change   
					information on a screen using screen function keys   
					(Table H-1) or keyboard keys (Table H-2).   
					Esc   
					Tab   
					Returns to the previous   
					screen.   
					• 
					Display screens show the results from a data   
					collection operation or they display device-specific   
					information.   
					Moves the cursor to the   
					next field.   
					The async terminal supports character matching for   
					entering values in fields. For example, if the values for a   
					field can be DTE, NET, or PORT and you enter a ‘D’   
					and press Return (Enter), then the field automatically   
					populates with the value DTE.   
					Back (Shift) Tab or Ctrl-k   
					Backspace   
					Moves the cursor to the   
					previous field.   
					Moves the cursor one   
					position to the left or to the   
					last character of the   
					previous field.   
					Once an operation is initiated, status messages appear   
					in the last row of the screen. These include Please Wait   
					(when a command takes longer than five seconds) and   
					Command Complete.   
					Spacebar   
					Selects the next valid value   
					for the field.   
					Delete   
					Deletes the character that   
					the cursor is on.   
					Up Arrow key or Ctrl-u   
					Moves the cursor up one   
					field within a column on the   
					same screen.   
					Table H-1   
					Screen Function Keys   
					Screen Function Key   
					Usage   
					Down Arrow key or Ctrl-d   
					Moves the cursor down   
					one field within a column   
					on the same screen.   
					M (MainMenu)   
					Returns to the Main Menu   
					screen.   
					Right Arrow key or Ctrl-f   
					Left Arrow key or Ctrl-b   
					Ctrl-l   
					Moves the cursor back one   
					character to the right.   
					E (Exit)   
					Terminates the async   
					terminal session.   
					Moves the cursor back one   
					character to the left.   
					R (Refresh)   
					U (PgUp)   
					Updates the screen with   
					the current information.   
					Redraws the screen   
					display.   
					Pages up to the previously   
					displayed page of   
					information.   
					Return (Enter)   
					Accepts entry.   
					D (PgDn)   
					S (Save)   
					Pages down to the   
					previously displayed page   
					of information.   
					Stores changes in   
					nonvolatile memory.   
					NOTE   
					Some Telnet applications may   
					require the use of Ctrl-u, Ctrl-d,   
					Ctrl-f, and Ctrl-b as an alternative   
					to the use of the Up, Down, Right,   
					and Left Arrow keys.   
					H-4   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					2. From the Control screen, select Customer ID.   
					NOTE   
					
					The following procedures are   
					examples only. This appendix   
					uses examples to help you   
					become familiar with the use of   
					the async terminal for DSU/CSU   
					control.   
					3. Use the Customer ID field to set the customer   
					identification.   
					The customer identification may be up to   
					8 characters long.   
					Select Clear to remove all the characters in the   
					associated field.   
					4. Select Save to store the information in nonvolatile   
					Setting Customer   
					memory.   
					Identification   
					The customer identification is used to uniquely identify   
					the DSU/CSU.   
					In addition to the customer identification, you may also   
					enter a system name, system location, and system contact.   
					Although only 40 characters are displayed for these fields,   
					you may enter up to 255 characters. The fields scroll as   
					the additional characters are added.   
					To change the customer identification (Customer ID),   
					1. From the Main Menu screen, select Control.   
					The Control screen appears.   
					main/control/customer id   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Customer   
					Identification   
					Field   
					Model: 31xx   
					CUSTOMER ID   
					Customer ID:   
					System Name:   
					System Location:   
					System Contact:   
					Clear   
					Clear   
					Clear   
					Clear   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					Save   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-3. Customer Identification Screen   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					2. From the Status screen, select Display LEDs.   
					Displaying LED Conditions   
					
					The same conditions monitored by the front panel   
					LEDs can also be monitored by the Display LEDs screen.   
					This screen is most useful when the DSU/CSU is being   
					accessed remotely.   
					The screen shows a snapshot of the LEDs every   
					5 seconds. LEDs that are illuminated are displayed by   
					inverse video.   
					To display LED conditions,   
					Select Refresh to update the screen.   
					1. From the Main Menu screen, select Status.   
					The Status screen appears.   
					main/status/leds   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					DISPLAY LEDs   
					GENERAL   
					NETWORK   
					DTE   
					PORT 1 PORT 2 PORT 3 PORT 4   
					OK   
					Fail   
					Test   
					Sig   
					OOF   
					Alm   
					EER   
					Sig   
					OOF   
					Alm   
					PDV   
					BPV   
					DTR   
					TXD   
					RXD   
					CTS   
					RTS   
					DTR   
					TXD   
					RXD   
					CTS   
					RTS   
					DTR   
					TXD   
					RXD   
					CTS   
					RTS   
					DTR   
					TXD   
					RXD   
					CTS   
					RTS   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					Refresh   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-4. Example of Display LEDs Screen   
					H-6   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					Displaying or Editing Configuration Options   
					Changing Configuration   
					Options   
					To display or edit configuration options,   
					Use the Configuration branch of the main menu to   
					display or change DSU/CSU configuration options. Refer   
					
					
					
					1. From the Main Menu screen, select   
					Configuration.   
					The Load Configuration From screen appears   
					
					If the access level is not Level 1, the message “Access   
					level is 2, Configuration is read-only” is displayed on   
					line 24.   
					2. From the Load Configuration From screen, select   
					a configuration option set to load (Current,   
					Customer 1, Customer 2, Default Factory 1, or   
					Default Factory 2). You cannot edit the Default   
					Factory configuration options, but you can display   
					them.   
					main/config   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					LOAD CONFIGURATION FROM:   
					Current Configuration   
					Customer Configuration 1   
					Customer Configuration 2   
					Default Factory Configuration 1   
					Default Factory Configuration 2   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-5. Configuration Load Screen   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					After selecting the set of configuration options to   
					load, the Configuration Edit/Display screen   
					
					NOTE   
					Screen displays may vary   
					depending on the model and   
					configuration of the DSU/CSU.   
					For example, DTE and Copy   
					Ports are not displayed for the   
					single-port DSU/CSU.   
					3. Select a functional group to display or edit.   
					main/config/edit   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					CONFIGURATION EDIT/DISPLAY   
					Network   
					DTE   
					Sync Data Ports   
					Copy Ports   
					Cross Connect   
					General Options   
					User Interface   
					Alarms & Traps   
					Management and Communication   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					Save   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-6. Configuration Edit/Display Screen   
					H-8   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					Save edit changes to the Current area when you want   
					those changes to take effect immediately. Save edit   
					changes to the Customer area when you want to overwrite   
					the existing Customer configuration options and store   
					these changes for future use.   
					Saving Edit Changes   
					To save edit changes,   
					1. From the last edit screen, select Save.   
					The Save Configuration To screen appears   
					
					To protect you from accidentally exiting an edit session   
					before saving your changes, the system displays the Save   
					Changes? field if you select either MainMenu or Exit   
					from an edit screen. If you respond No, the system exits   
					without saving the changes. If you respond Yes, you are   
					prompted to specify where the changes should be saved.   
					2. From the Save Configuration To screen, select a   
					configuration option set (Current, Customer 1,   
					or Customer 2).   
					main/config/save   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					SAVE CONFIGURATION TO:   
					Current Configuration   
					Customer Configuration 1   
					Customer Configuration 2   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-7. Configuration Save Screen   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-9   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					3. From the Configuration Edit/Display screen,   
					Establishing Access Security   
					on a Port   
					select User Interface.   
					The User Interface Options screen appears.   
					Although the password feature is available, it is not   
					required. If used, it ensures access security before control   
					is passed to a device connected to a port. The following   
					procedure is an example only. It shows how to enable the   
					password for the communication port. Passwords can also   
					be enabled for the internal modem and for Telnet sessions.   
					4. From the User Interface Options screen, select   
					Communication Port.   
					The Communication Port Options screen appears.   
					5. In the Password Required field, enter Enable   
					To establish access security on the communication   
					port,   
					
					6. Select Save to store this setting in nonvolatile   
					1. From the Main Menu screen, select   
					memory.   
					Configuration.   
					The Save Configuration To screen appears.   
					The Load Configuration From screen appears.   
					7. From the Save Configuration To screen, select   
					2. From the Load Configuration From screen, select   
					Current.   
					Current.   
					The password itself is set separately. Refer to the   
					
					The Configuration Edit/Display screen appears.   
					main/config/user/com   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					COMMUNICATION PORT OPTIONS   
					Port Use:   
					Terminal   
					Port Type:   
					Asynchronous   
					Data Rate (Kbps):   
					Character Length:   
					Parity:   
					9.6   
					8 
					None   
					Enable   
					Stop Bits:   
					1 
					Password   
					Ignore Control Leads:   
					Disable   
					Password Required:   
					Inactivity Timeout:   
					Disconnect Time (Minutes):   
					Enable   
					Enable   
					5 
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					Save   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-8. Enabling a Password   
					H-10   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					This screen is used to add a new password or   
					modify an existing password.   
					Setting a Password   
					In addition to establishing access security on a port   
					
					
					specify otherwise, the password is null.   
					3. Enter a new password in the Password field.   
					The password may be 1 to 8 characters long and   
					may contain the characters 0 through 9, a   
					through z, and/or A through Z.   
					To set a password,   
					4. Use the Re-Enter Password field to verify the   
					1. From the Main Menu screen, select Control.   
					new password.   
					The Control screen appears.   
					5. Select Save.   
					2. From the Control screen, select Administer   
					Once a password is saved, the Login Records Saved   
					message appears at the bottom of the screen.   
					Password.   
					
					main/control/admin_password   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					Enter New   
					Password   
					PASSWORD ENTRY   
					Password:   
					Re-Enter Password:   
					Re-Enter   
					Password   
					Save   
					Password   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu   
					Save   
					MainMenu   
					Exit   
					Figure H-9. Setting a Password   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-11   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					• 
					• 
					If the password is invalid, an invalid password   
					message appears and the screen reappears and waits   
					for password entry.   
					Entering a Password to   
					Gain Access   
					When access security is required, the Login screen   
					
					Menu screen. The password must be entered.   
					If an invalid password is entered three consecutive   
					times, the message User Interface Idle appears,   
					Telnet sessions are closed, dial-in connections are   
					disconnected, and an SNMP trap is generated.   
					• 
					If the password is valid, the DSU/CSU’s top-level   
					menu appears.   
					login   
					Customer ID: Node A   
					Slot: xx   
					Model: 31xx   
					Enter   
					Password   
					LOGIN   
					Enter Password   
					––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––   
					Ctrl-a to access these functions Exit   
					Figure H-10. Entering a Password   
					H-12   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Async Terminal Operation   
					Configuration Worksheets for   
					the Async Terminal Interface   
					This section contains one set of blank worksheets to be   
					used when configuring your DSU/CSU using the async   
					terminal interface. In the tables, default settings for   
					Default Factory 1 are indicated by bold type. It is   
					recommended that you copy these blank worksheets   
					before using them.   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Network Interface Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Line Framing Format   
					NET Framing   
					D4, ESF   
					Line Coding Format   
					Line Build Out (LBO)   
					Management Link   
					NET Coding   
					LBO   
					AMI, B8ZS   
					0.0, –7.5, –15, –22.5   
					Enable, Disable   
					62411, Part68, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Mgmt Link   
					BitStuff   
					Bit Stuffing   
					Network Initiated LLB   
					Network Initiated PLB   
					ANSI Performance Report Messages   
					Circuit Identifier   
					NET LLB   
					NET PLB   
					ANSI PRM   
					Circuit Ident   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					DTE Interface Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Interface Status   
					DTE Port   
					Enable, Disable   
					D4, ESF   
					Line Framing Format   
					Line Coding Format   
					Line Equalization   
					DTE Framing   
					DTE Coding   
					Equal   
					AMI, B8ZS   
					0–133, 133–266, 266–399, 399–533,   
					533–655   
					DTE LB on External Contact   
					Send All Ones on DTE Failure   
					Extrn DLB   
					Send Ones   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-13   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Sync Data Port Options (Port 1)   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Port Type   
					Port Type   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Port Base Rate   
					Base Rate   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					All Ones   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Transmit Clock Source   
					Internal, External   
					Invert Transmit Clock   
					Enable, Disable   
					Invert Transmit and Received Data   
					Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready   
					Action on Network Yellow Alarm   
					Network Init. Data Channel Loopback   
					Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks   
					Embedded Data Link   
					Enable, Disable   
					Disable, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					Disable, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disable, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Enable, Disable   
					EDL   
					EDL Management Link   
					Mgmt Link   
					Err Rate   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Enable, Disable   
					Excessive Error Rate Threshold   
					Near-End Performance Statistics   
					Far-End Performance Statistics   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7, 10E–8, 10E–9   
					Disable, Maintain, Send, Both   
					Disable, Maintain   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Sync Data Port Options (Port 2)   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Port Type   
					Port Type   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Port Base Rate   
					Base Rate   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					All Ones   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Transmit Clock Source   
					Internal, External   
					Invert Transmit Clock   
					Enable, Disable   
					Invert Transmit and Received Data   
					Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready   
					Action on Network Yellow Alarm   
					Network Init. Data Channel Loopback   
					Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks   
					Embedded Data Link   
					Enable, Disable   
					Disable, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					Disable, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disable, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Enable, Disable   
					EDL   
					EDL Management Link   
					Mgmt Link   
					Err Rate   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Enable, Disable   
					Excessive Error Rate Threshold   
					Near-End Performance Statistics   
					Far-End Performance Statistics   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7, 10E–8, 10E–9   
					Disable, Maintain, Send, Both   
					Disable, Maintain   
					H-14   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				Async Terminal Operation   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Sync Data Port Options (Port 3)   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Port Type   
					Port Type   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Port Base Rate   
					Base Rate   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					All Ones   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Transmit Clock Source   
					Internal, External   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					Disable, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					Invert Transmit Clock   
					Invert Transmit and Received Data   
					Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready   
					Action on Network Yellow Alarm   
					Network Init. Data Channel Loopback   
					Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks   
					Embedded Data Link   
					Disable, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disable, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Enable, Disable   
					EDL   
					EDL Management Link   
					Mgmt Link   
					Err Rate   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Enable, Disable   
					Excessive Error Rate Threshold   
					Near-End Performance Statistics   
					Far-End Performance Statistics   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7, 10E–8, 10E–9   
					Disable, Maintain, Send, Both   
					Disable, Maintain   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Sync Data Port Options (Port 4)   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Port Type   
					Port Type   
					E530, V.35, RS449, X.21   
					Nx64, Nx56   
					Port Base Rate   
					Base Rate   
					Tx Clock   
					InvertTxC   
					InvrtData   
					All Ones   
					Rcv Yellow   
					Net DCLB   
					Port LB   
					Transmit Clock Source   
					Internal, External   
					Invert Transmit Clock   
					Enable, Disable   
					Invert Transmit and Received Data   
					Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready   
					Action on Network Yellow Alarm   
					Network Init. Data Channel Loopback   
					Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks   
					Embedded Data Link   
					Enable, Disable   
					Disable, DTR, RTS, Both   
					None, Halt   
					Disable, V.54, FT1, Both   
					Disable, DTLB, DCLB, Both   
					Enable, Disable   
					EDL   
					EDL Management Link   
					Mgmt Link   
					Err Rate   
					Near-end   
					Far-end   
					Enable, Disable   
					Excessive Error Rate Threshold   
					Near-End Performance Statistics   
					Far-End Performance Statistics   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7, 10E–8, 10E–9   
					Disable, Maintain, Send, Both   
					Disable, Maintain   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					H-15   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					General Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Generate Yellow Alarm Signals   
					Initial Self Test   
					Gen Yellow   
					Enable, Disable   
					Self-Test   
					Enable, Disable   
					Primary Clock Source   
					External Clock Rate (KHz)   
					Test Timeout   
					Clock Src   
					Clock Rate   
					Tst Timeout   
					Tst Duration   
					Network, DTE, Internal, External, Port 1   
					2048, 1544, 8   
					Enable, Disable   
					Test Duration   
					1–120 (Default = 10)   
					User Interface:   
					Front Panel Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Front Panel Access   
					FP Access   
					FP Pass   
					Enable, Disable   
					Front Panel Pass-Through   
					Enable, Disable   
					User Interface:   
					Communication Port Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Port Use   
					Com Use   
					Mgmt, ASCII, Daisy, Terminal   
					Asynchronous, Synchronous   
					Internal, External   
					1.2, 2.4, 4.8, 9.6, 14.4, 19.2, 38.4   
					7, 8   
					Port Type   
					Com Type   
					Com Clk   
					Clock Source   
					Data Rate   
					Com Rate   
					Char Length   
					CParity   
					Character Length   
					Parity   
					None, Even, Odd   
					1, 1.5, 2   
					Stop Bits   
					CStop Bits   
					Ignore DTR   
					Password   
					CmInActTm   
					CmDiscTm   
					Ignore Control Leads   
					Password Required   
					Inactivity Timeout   
					Disconnect Time   
					Disable, DTR   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					1–60 (Default = 5)   
					H-16   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				Async Terminal Operation   
					User Interface:   
					External Device Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Nest COM Port Access   
					Com Port   
					Enable, Disable   
					External Device Commands   
					Dial-In Access   
					ComExtDev   
					Disable, AT, Other   
					Enable, Disable   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Dial-In   
					Connect Prefix   
					ComConnPrefix   
					ComConnected   
					ComEscapeSeq   
					ComEscDel   
					Connect Indication String   
					Escape Sequence   
					Escape Sequence Delay (Sec)   
					Disconnect String   
					None, 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1.0   
					ComDisconnect   
					Text Field, Clear   
					User Interface:   
					Telnet Sessions Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Telnet Session   
					TnSession   
					TnPaswd   
					TnInActTm   
					TnDiscTm   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					1–60 (Default = 5)   
					Password Required   
					Inactivity Timeout   
					Disconnect Time   
					User Interface:   
					Internal Modem Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Modem Use   
					Modem Use   
					Dial-In   
					Terminal, Mgmt, ASCII   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enable, Disable   
					1–60 (Default = 5)   
					Asynchronous, Synchronous   
					1.2, 2.4   
					Dial-In Access   
					Password Required   
					Inactivity Timeout   
					Disconnect Time   
					Modem Type   
					Password   
					MInActTm   
					MDiscTm   
					Modem Type   
					Modem Rate   
					MChar L   
					Modem Rate   
					Character Length   
					Parity   
					7, 8   
					MParity   
					None, Even, Odd   
					1, 1.5, 2   
					Stop Bits   
					MStop Bits   
					LSpaceDisc   
					Long Space Disconnect   
					Enable, Disable   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-17   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					User Interface:   
					Auxiliary Port Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Port Use   
					Data Rate (Kbps)   
					Aux Use   
					Aux Rate   
					None, Mgmt, Daisy   
					9.6, 14.4, 19.2, 38.4   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Alarm & Trap Options   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					ASCII Alarm Messages   
					Alarm & Trap Dial-Out   
					Trap Disconnect   
					Alrm Msg   
					Disable, Com Port   
					DialOut   
					Enable, Disable   
					Trap Disc   
					Call Retry   
					Dial Delay   
					AltDialDir   
					Err Rate   
					Enable, Disable   
					Call Retry   
					Enable,Disable   
					Dial Out Delay Time (Min)   
					Alternate Dial-Out Directory   
					Excessive Error Rate Threshold   
					System Alarm Relay   
					1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10   
					None, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5   
					10E–4, 10E–5, 10E–6, 10E–7, 10E–8, 10E–9   
					Enable,Disable   
					Alrm Relay   
					H-18   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				Async Terminal Operation   
					Management and Communication:   
					Communication Protocol Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					Node IP Address   
					IP Adr   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Node Subnet Mask   
					NetMask   
					Default Net Destination   
					Communication Port IP Adr   
					Communication Port Subnet Mask   
					Com Link Protocol   
					Def Netwk   
					None, Com, Aux, FDL, EDL1, EDL2   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					PPP, SLIP   
					Com IP Adr   
					Com NetMask   
					Com Link   
					Modem IP Address   
					Modem IP Adr   
					Mdm NetMask   
					Alt Mdm IP Adr   
					Alt Mdm NetMask   
					Modem Link   
					Aux IP Adr   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					PPP, SLIP   
					Modem Subnet Mask   
					Modem Alt IP Adr   
					Modem Alt Subnet Mask   
					Modem Link Protocol   
					Auxiliary Port IP Address   
					Auxiliary Port Subnet Mask   
					IPBusMast   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Enable,Disable   
					Aux NetMask   
					IPBusMast   
					Management and Communication:   
					General SNMP Management Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					SNMP Management   
					Community Name 1   
					Name 1 Access   
					SNMP Mgt   
					Enable, Disable   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Read, R/W   
					CommunityName1   
					Access 1   
					Community Name 2   
					Name 2 Access   
					CommunityName2   
					Access 2   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Read, R/W   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					H-19   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Management and Communication:   
					SNMP NMS Security Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					NMS IP Validation   
					Number of Managers   
					NMS n IP Address   
					Access Level   
					NMS Valid   
					Enable, Disable   
					Num Sec Mgrs   
					NMS n IP Adr   
					NMS n Access   
					1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10   
					Text Field, Clear   
					Read, R/w   
					Management and Communication:   
					SNMP Traps Options   
					Front Panel   
					Equivalent   
					Value (Default in Bold)   
					SNMP Traps   
					SNMP Trap   
					Num Trap Mgrs   
					Trapn IP Adr   
					Trapn Dst   
					Gen Trap   
					Enable, Disable   
					Number of Trap Managers   
					Trap n IP Address   
					Trap Manager n Destination   
					General Traps   
					1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6   
					Text Field, Clear   
					None, Com, Aux, FDL, EDL1, EDL2   
					Disable, Warm, AuthFail, Both   
					Enable, Disable   
					Enterprise Specific Traps   
					Link Traps   
					Entp Trap   
					Link Trap   
					Disable, Up, Down, Both   
					Network, DTE, T1s, Ports, All   
					Link Trap Interfaces   
					Trap I/F   
					H-20   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Equipment List   
					I 
					Equipment   
					Feature Number   
					Model 3160 DSU/CSU   
					Model 3164 DSU/CSU   
					Model 3165 DSU/CSU   
					3160-A2-210   
					3164-A2-210   
					3165-A2-210   
					3100-F1-500   
					3100-F1-510   
					3100-F1-550   
					3100-F1-540   
					3100-F1-520   
					3100-F1-100   
					3100-C1-010   
					3100-F1-580   
					3100-F1-570   
					3100-F1-571   
					3100-F1-400   
					3161-B3-010   
					3100-F1-900   
					T1 Line Interface Cable, RJ48C-to-RJ48C   
					T1 Line Interface Cable, RJ48C-to-DA15P (Canada)   
					COM Port-to-PC Cable, 8-pin modular to DB9S   
					COM Port-to-Terminal/Printer Cable, 8-pin modular to DB25P   
					DC Power Cable   
					115 Vac Power Module   
					Front Panel Emulation Software   
					EIA 530A-to-RS449/422 Cable   
					EIA 530A-to-V.35 Cable   
					EIA 530A-to-X.21 Cable   
					Wall-Mount/Rack-Mount Adapter   
					Model 3161 DSU/CSU   
					Auxiliary Backplane   
					NOTE   
					Cable numbers for the 3161   
					DSU/CSU are located in the   
					ACCULINK 3151 CSU and 3161   
					DSU/CSU General Information   
					Guide and the COMSPHERE   
					3000 Series Carrier Installation   
					Manual.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					I-1   
					 
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					I-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Glossary   
					ACAMI allocation method   
					Alternate Channel Alternate Mark Inversion. A method of allocating DS0 channels   
					as a group, so that every alternate DS0 channel does not carry data, but instead   
					transmits and receives all ones.   
					ACCULINK   
					ACO   
					A product family and a registered trademark.   
					Alarm Cut-off command. A command for carrier-mounted DSU/CSUs that forces a   
					deactivation of the alarm relay on the 3000 Series Carrier.   
					Activ   
					Active configuration area. The configuration option set that is currently active for   
					the device. Before a configuration option set becomes active, you must save the set   
					to the Active configuration area.   
					adapter   
					Hardware that provides some transitional function between two or more devices.   
					A symbol (usually numeric) that identifies the interface attached to a network.   
					address   
					agent (SNMP)   
					A software program housed within a device to provide SNMP functionality. Each   
					agent stores management information and responds to the manager’s request for   
					this information.   
					aggregate   
					AIS   
					A single bit stream that combines two or more bit streams.   
					Alarm Indication Signal. A signal transmitted instead of the normal signal to   
					maintain transmission continuity and to indicate to the receiving device that a   
					transmission fault exists.   
					AMI   
					Alternate Mark Inversion. A line coding technique used to accommodate the ones   
					density requirements of T1 lines.   
					ANSI   
					American National Standards Institute. An organization devoted to the development   
					of voluntary standards.   
					application   
					ASCII   
					The use to which a device is put.   
					American Standard Code for Information Interchange. A 7-bit code which   
					establishes compatibility between data services.   
					ASCII terminal/printer   
					asynchronous data   
					authenticationFailure trap   
					AUX port   
					Devices that can be attached, either locally or remotely, to the DSU/CSU to display   
					or print alarm messages.   
					Data transmission that is synchronized by a transmission start bit at the beginning   
					of a character (five to eight bits) and one or more stop bits at the end.   
					An SNMP trap that indicates that the device has received an SNMP protocol   
					message that has not passed the active security measures.   
					The auxiliary communications port on the DSU/CSU.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Glossary-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					Auxiliary Backplane   
					An 8-slot backplane that fits over one half of the open section of the 3000 Series   
					Carrier. This is a passive assembly that provides interconnect capability between   
					3151 CSUs and 3161 DSU/CSUs and provides all interface connectors.   
					AWG   
					American Wire Gauge. An indication of wire size.   
					backup capability   
					The ability to reconfigure the DSU/CSU and restore data circuits through an   
					external backup device.   
					bandwidth   
					BES   
					The range of frequencies that a circuit can pass. The greater the bandwidth, the   
					more information that can be sent in a given amount of time.   
					Bursty Errored Seconds. Seconds with more than one, but less that 320 CRC6   
					errors.   
					bipolar signal   
					bit   
					A signal in which successive “ones” (marks, pulses) are of alternating, positive and   
					negative polarity, and in which a “zero” (space, no pulse) is of zero amplitude.   
					Binary digit. The smallest unit of information, representing a choice between a one   
					or a zero (sometimes called mark or space).   
					bit stuffing   
					The insertion of ones into the outgoing bit stream to enforce ones density   
					requirements.   
					block allocation method   
					bps   
					A method of allocating DS0 channels as a group rather than individually.   
					Bits per second. Indicates the speed at which bits are transmitted across a data   
					connection.   
					BPV   
					Bipolar Violation. In a bipolar signal, a “one” (mark, pulse) which has the same   
					polarity as its predecessor.   
					byte   
					A small group of bits (usually 8) that is handled as a unit of data.   
					B8ZS   
					Bipolar with Eight Zero Substitution. A line coding technique used to accommodate   
					the ones density requirement of T1 lines.   
					CCITT   
					The International Consultative Committee for Telegraphy and Telephony. (It is now   
					renamed as the ITU.)   
					CD   
					Carrier Detect. The received line signal detector. V.24 circuit 109.   
					An independent data path.   
					channel   
					channel allocation   
					Assigning specific DS0 channels in the DSU/CSU to specific interfaces (network,   
					DTE Drop/Insert, etc.).   
					CHAP   
					Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol.   
					character   
					CID branch   
					client   
					A letter, figure, number, punctuation, or other symbol.   
					Customer Identification branch or the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A device that receives a specific service, such as database management, from a   
					server.   
					CLOCK IN interface   
					ClrReg branch   
					Cnfig branch   
					coding   
					The external clock interface on the DSU/CSU.   
					Clear Performance Registers branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Configuration branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A technique used to accommodate the ones density requirements of T1 lines.   
					The communications port on the DSU/CSU.   
					COM port   
					community name   
					COMSPHERE   
					An identification used by SNMP to grant an SNMP server access rights to a MIB.   
					A product family and a registered trademark.   
					Glossary-2   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Glossary   
					configuration   
					configuration option   
					CPU fail   
					The arrangement of a system or network as defined by the characteristics of its   
					functional units.   
					Device firmware that establishes specific operating parameters for the device.   
					Sometimes referred to as straps.   
					Central Processing Unit failure. A Self-Test Health message indicating a failure in   
					the device’s central processing unit.   
					CRC   
					Cyclic Redundancy Check. A mathematical method of confirming the integrity of   
					received digital data.   
					CRC6   
					CSA   
					CRC using six check bits.   
					Canadian Standards Association.   
					CSU   
					Channel Service Unit. Protects the T1 line from damage and regenerates the T1   
					signal.   
					Ctrl branch   
					CTS   
					Control branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Clear-to-Send. V.24 circuit 106.   
					Cust1   
					Customer 1 configuration area. The first of two sets of customer-defined   
					configuration options.   
					Cust2   
					Customer 2 configuration area. The second of two sets of customer-defined   
					configuration options.   
					daisy chaining   
					data port   
					Connecting the COM port of one DSU/CSU to the AUX port of another DSU/CSU   
					to provide SNMP connectivity.   
					The electrical interface between the DSU/CSU and the synchronous data terminal   
					equipment.   
					database   
					An organized compilation of computerized data.   
					A 15-position connector used on cables or devices.   
					A 25-position connector used on cables or devices.   
					DB15 connector   
					DB25 connector   
					DCE   
					Data Circuit-terminating Equipment or Data Communications Equipment. A device   
					which provides signal conversion for communication between the DTE and the   
					network.   
					DCLB   
					Data Channel Loopback. Loops the data received from the network interface, for all   
					DS0 channels allocated to the selected port, back to the network.   
					default   
					A preset value that is assumed to be correct unless changed by the user.   
					DevFail   
					Device Failure. A message that indicates that an internal failure has been detected   
					by the operating firmware. An 8-digit code appears for use by service personnel.   
					DevHS branch   
					device   
					Device Health and Status branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A mechanical, electrical, or electronic unit with a special purpose.   
					digital signal   
					A signal composed of discrete elements (zeros and ones) instead of a great   
					multitude of analog elements.   
					diskette   
					DL branch   
					DLB   
					A thin, flexible magnetic disk enclose in a protective jacket.   
					Download branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					DTE Loopback. Loops the received signal on the DTE Drop/Insert port back to the   
					DTE without change.   
					download   
					A process that transfers device firmware from a locally-attached PC to a device, or   
					allows the duplication of firmware from a local device to a remote device.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Glossary-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					downstream device   
					drop/insert   
					A device that is connected farther from the host computer.   
					An interconnection point for terminals, multiplexers, and transmission facilities.   
					Individual channels may be inserted into the aggregate stream or dropped out to   
					accommodate specific applications.   
					DSR   
					DSU   
					Data Set Ready. V.24 circuit 107.   
					Data Service Unit. Data communications equipment which transmits digital data   
					over a private line. Also used for limited distance communications over the local   
					area network when a high-speed modem is not needed.   
					DSX-1   
					Digital Signal Cross Connect level 1. An interconnection point for terminals,   
					multiplexers and transmission facilities.   
					DS0   
					Digital Signal Level 0. A 64 kbps standard signal or channel.   
					DS0 channel allocation   
					Assigning specific DS0 channels in the DSU/CSU to specific interfaces (network,   
					DTE Drop/Insert, etc.).   
					DS1   
					Digital Signal level 1. A signal of 1.544 Mbps in North America.   
					DS1/E1 MIB   
					Defines objects for managing the network and DTE Drop/Insert interfaces on the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					DTE   
					Data Terminal Equipment. The equipment, such as a computer or terminal, that   
					provides data in the form of digital signals.   
					DTE Drop/Insert interface   
					DTLB   
					The Drop/Insert (DSX-1) interface on the rear panel of the DSU/CSU.   
					Data Terminal Loopback. Loops the data received from the selected port, for all   
					DS0 channels allocated to the port, back out the port.   
					DTMF   
					DTR   
					D4   
					Dual Tone Multifrequency. The basis of operation for a pushbutton telephone.   
					Data Terminal Ready. V.24 circuit 108/1, /2.   
					The transmission standard that specifies 12 frames as a superframe that is used for   
					frame synchronization and to locate signaling bits.   
					EDL   
					EER   
					EIA   
					Embedded Data Link. The 8 kbps in-band performance channel that provides   
					4 kbps of user bandwidth for the support of an SNMP management link.   
					Excessive Error Rate. An error rate that is greater than the threshold in the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					Electronic Industries Association. An organization providing standards for the data   
					communication industry.   
					EIA 530A   
					An EIA standard for a high-speed, 25-position, DCE/DTE interface.   
					MIB objects unique to Paradyne devices.   
					A trap unique to Paradyne devices.   
					Enterprise MIB   
					enterprise-specific trap   
					EON   
					End of Number.   
					error   
					A discrepancy between a measured or computed value or condition and the true or   
					specified value or condition.   
					ES   
					Errored seconds. Seconds with one or more ESF error events.   
					ESD   
					Electrostatic discharge. An undesirable discharge of static electricity that can   
					damage equipment and degrade electrical circuitry.   
					ESF   
					E1   
					Extended Superframe. The T1 transmission standard that specifies 24 frames as an   
					extended superframe to be used for frame synchronization and to locate signaling   
					bits.   
					A wideband digital interface operating at 2.048 Mbps.   
					Glossary-4   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Glossary   
					Fact1   
					Fact2   
					Factory 1 configuration area. The first of two configuration option sets that are   
					preset at the factory (read-only options).   
					Factory 2 configuration area. The second of two configuration option sets that are   
					preset at the factory (read-only options).   
					failure   
					fault   
					An uncorrected hardware error.   
					An accidental condition that causes a functional unit to fail to perform its required   
					function.   
					FCC   
					Federal Communications Commission. A board of commissioners that regulates   
					electrical communication systems that originate in the United States.   
					FDL   
					Facility Data Link. The selected framing bits in a wide-area link that are used for   
					control, monitoring, and testing.   
					Fractional T1   
					frame   
					Individual DS0 channels that may be sold separately or in groups to provide   
					bandwidth that is some fraction of the total T1 capability.   
					One identifiable group of bits that includes a sequence of bits for control,   
					framing, etc.   
					frame relay   
					framing   
					A switching interface that is designed to get frames from one part of the network to   
					another as quickly as possible.   
					A technique that separates bits into identifiable groups.   
					Generic-Interface Extension   
					MIB   
					An extension to MIB II that defines additional objects for control of generic   
					interfaces in MIB II.   
					Get command (SNMP)   
					ground   
					Read-only access to SNMP MIB objects.   
					A physical connection to earth or other reference point.   
					HDLC   
					High-level Data Link Control. A communications protocol defined by the   
					International Standards Organization (ISO).   
					host   
					Hz   
					A computer system used for application processing on a network.   
					Hertz. A unit of frequency that equals one cycle per second.   
					ICMP   
					Internet Control Management Protocol. The protocol that enables in-band control,   
					diagnostic, and error messages to be passed between nodes in an IP internetwork.   
					ID branch   
					interface   
					Internet   
					Identity branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A shared boundary between functional units.   
					The worldwide interconnected collection of networks that predominantly use the   
					TCP/IP protocol.   
					internetwork   
					IP address   
					An interconnected collection of networks (also called an internet).   
					Internet Protocol address. The address used by the SNMP manager to access the   
					device.   
					ISO   
					ITU   
					International Standards Organization.   
					International Telecommunications Union. The telecommunications agency of the   
					United Nations, established to provide standardized communications procedures   
					and practices.   
					kbps   
					LAN   
					Kilobits per second (thousand bits per second).   
					Local Area Network. A network that spans a small geographic area (e.g., a   
					building).   
					LBO   
					Line Build-out. The amount of attenuation of the transmitted signal that is used to   
					compensate for the length of wire between the transmitter and the receiver.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Glossary-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					LCD   
					Liquid Crystal Display. Sealed glass plates containing liquid crystal material. When   
					voltage is applied, the amount of light passing through the plates is altered so that   
					messages may be displayed.   
					LCP   
					LED   
					Link Control Protocol.   
					Light-Emitting Diode. A status indicator that glows in response to the application of   
					a voltage.   
					link   
					A communication path between two network nodes.   
					link layer protocol   
					link trap   
					The protocol that regulates the communication between two network nodes.   
					A trap that identifies the condition of the communications interface (linkDown or   
					linkUp traps).   
					LLB   
					Line Loopback. Loops the received signal on the network interface back to the   
					network without change.   
					LOF   
					Loss Of Frame. The inability to maintain frame synchronization.   
					Loss Of Frame Count. A count of the number of LOFs declared.   
					LOFC   
					loopback test   
					A test that verifies a device’s operation by connecting the device’s output to the   
					device’s input.   
					LOS   
					Loss Of Signal. The T1 line condition where there are no pulses.   
					Local Loopback branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Link Quality Reports.   
					Lpbk branch   
					LQR   
					manager (SNMP)   
					The device that queries agents for management information, or receives unsolicited   
					messages (traps) indicating the occurrence of specific events.   
					master clock   
					MB   
					The master timing source used to synchronize all of the T1 and data port interfaces   
					on the DSU/CSU.   
					Megabytes. A unit of memory measurement equal to approximately one million   
					bytes (typically 1,048,576 bytes).   
					Mbps   
					Megabits per second (million bits per second).   
					menu tree   
					A display of DSU/CSU functions that are accessed by selecting various branches   
					(Status, Test, etc.).   
					MIB   
					Management Information Base. A database of managed objects used by SNMP to   
					provide network management information.   
					MIB II   
					MIB Release 2. The current Internet-standard MIB.   
					module   
					A compact assembly functioning as a component in a larger system or unit.   
					Maximum Request Unit.   
					MRU   
					multiplex   
					network   
					network interface   
					NMS   
					To interleave or simultaneously transmit two or more messages on a single circuit.   
					A configuration of data processing devices for information exchange.   
					The T1 network interface connector on the rear panel of the DSU/CSU.   
					Network Management System. A computer system used for monitoring and   
					controlling network devices.   
					node   
					A connection or switching point on the network.   
					object (SNMP)   
					OOF   
					A specific item within a Management Information Base (MIB).   
					Out Of Frame. An error condition in which frame synchronization bits are in error.   
					option   
					A hardware or software function that can be selected or enabled as part of a   
					configuration process.   
					Glossary-6   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Glossary   
					PAP   
					Password Authentication Protocol.   
					parity   
					A way of checking data accuracy by counting the number of bits that have a value   
					of one.   
					payload   
					PBX   
					The information bits in a frame.   
					Private Branch Exchange. Telephone switching equipment dedicated to one   
					customer. A PBX connects private telephones to each other and to the public   
					network.   
					PC   
					Personal computer. In this document, references to a PC imply an IBM PC or an   
					IBM-compatible PC.   
					PDU   
					PDV   
					Protocol Data Unit. Used when adding routes in the Internet.   
					Pulse Density Violation. The number of “ones” (marks, pulses) is not adequate for   
					the line requirement.   
					Perf branch   
					PLB   
					Performance Report branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Payload Loopback. Loops the received signal on the network interface back to the   
					network after it has passed through the framing circuity of the DSU/CSU.   
					port   
					An access point for data entry or exit.   
					PORT (1–4) interface   
					POWER connector   
					power-up self-test   
					The synchronous data port interface on the DSU/CSU.   
					The power input connector on the DSU/CSU.   
					A test that checks most hardware components when power is applied to the device   
					or a reset is initiated.   
					PPP   
					Point-to-Point Protocol. A link layer protocol used by SNMP.   
					PRBS   
					Psuedo-Random Bit Sequence. A test pattern containing any possible combination   
					of digital ones and zeros for a given string length.   
					PRM   
					Performance Report Message. A message indicating performance data such as   
					errored seconds, unavailable seconds, etc.   
					protocol   
					A set of rules that determines the behavior of functional units in achieving   
					communication.   
					PSTN   
					Public Switched Telephone Network.   
					Ptrns branch   
					pulse density   
					Test Patterns branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A measure of the number of “ones” (marks, pulses) in relation to the total number   
					of bits transmitted.   
					QRSS Test   
					RAM   
					Quasi-Random Signal Source Test. A test pattern simulating a random pattern of   
					digital ones and zeros used to simulate normal transmission.   
					Random-access memory. Read/write memory that is volatile and loses its contents   
					when power is removed.   
					register   
					Rel branch   
					reset   
					A part of the device’s memory that holds stored values.   
					Release branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A reinitialization of the DSU/CSU that occurs at power-up or in response to a reset   
					command.   
					RFC   
					Request for Comments. The set of documents that describes the standard   
					specifications for the TCP/IP protocol suite.   
					RIP   
					Routing Information Protocol. A protocol used to add routes in the Internet.   
					An 8-position modular connector.   
					RJ48C   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Glossary-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					RLB   
					Repeater Loopback. Loops the signal being sent to the network back to the DTE   
					Drop/Insert and data ports after it has passed through the framing circuitry of the   
					DSU/CSU.   
					Rlpbk branch   
					router   
					Remote Loopback branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					A device that connects LAN segments.   
					RS-232   
					An EIA standard for a low-speed, 25-position, DCE/DTE interface.   
					RS-232-like MIB   
					Defines objects for managing RS-232-type interfaces and supports synchronous   
					data ports and management communication ports on the DSU/CSU.   
					RS-449   
					RTS   
					An EIA standard for a general-purpose, 37-position, DCE/DTE interface.   
					Request-to-Send. V.24 circuit 105.   
					RX   
					Receive. To obtain signals that have been transmitted.   
					Receive Clock. V.24 circuit 115.   
					RXC   
					RXD   
					Receive Data. V.24 circuit 104.   
					SDCP   
					self-test   
					Shared Diagnostic Control Panel.   
					A test that checks most hardware components when power is applied to the device   
					or a reset is initiated.   
					server   
					SES   
					A device that offers a specific service, such as database management, to a client.   
					Severely Errored Seconds. For T1 data, seconds with 320 or more CRC6 errors or   
					errored frame alignment signals.   
					Set command (SNMP)   
					Write access to SNMP MIB objects.   
					SLIP   
					Serial Line Internet Protocol. A link layer protocol used by SNMP.   
					SNMP   
					Simple Network Management Protocol. A generic network management system   
					that allows the device to be managed by any industry-standard SNMP manager.   
					Stat branch   
					STest branch   
					StEvnt   
					Status branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Self Test Health branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Status Event Register. Records the occurrence of certain alarm conditions.   
					subnet   
					An IP addressing standard in which a portion of the host address can be used to   
					create multiple network addresses that are logically a subdivision of the network   
					address.   
					subnet mask   
					synchronous data   
					TCP/IP   
					An integer used with the IP address of the host to determine which bits in the host   
					address are used in the subnet address.   
					Data transmission that is synchronized by timing signals. Characters are sent at a   
					fixed rate.   
					Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol. The dominant protocol in the   
					worldwide Internet.   
					Telnet   
					A TCP/IP protocol that allows you to access a remote device as if you were   
					connected locally to that device.   
					time slot   
					The allocated DS0 channel slot when DS0 channels are combined to form an   
					aggregate bit stream.   
					trap (SNMP)   
					A notification message to the SNMP manager when an unusual event occurs on a   
					network device, such as a reinitialization.   
					TStat branch   
					TX   
					Test Status branch of the DSU/CSU menu tree.   
					Transmit. To send signals from a device.   
					Glossary-8   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Glossary   
					TXC   
					TXD   
					T1   
					Transmit Clock. V.24 circuit 114.   
					Transmit Data. V.24 circuit 103.   
					A wideband digital interface operating at 1.544 Mbps.   
					UAS   
					UDP   
					Unavailable Seconds. A count of 1-second intervals when service is unavailable.   
					User Datagram Protocol. A TCP/IP protocol describing how messages reach   
					application programs within a destination computer.   
					UL   
					Underwriter’s Laboratories, Inc. An organization which promotes product safety.   
					Volts alternating current.   
					Vac   
					Vdc   
					Volts direct current.   
					VF   
					Voice Frequency.   
					V.24   
					A CCITT standard for a low-speed, 25-position, DCE/DTE interface.   
					A CCITT standard for a high-speed, 34-position, DCE/DTE interface.   
					A CCITT standard for local and remote diagnostic loopback tests.   
					A CCITT standard for a data channel loopback (DCLB).   
					A CCITT standard for a data terminal loopback (DTLB).   
					Wide Area Network. A network that spans a large geographic area (e.g., a country).   
					An SNMP trap that indicates that the device has reinitialized itself.   
					External Transmit Clock. V.24 circuit 113.   
					V.35   
					V.54   
					V.54 Loop 2   
					V.54 Loop 3   
					WAN   
					warmStart trap   
					XTXC   
					Yellow Alarm   
					An outgoing signal transmitted when a DS1 terminal has determined that it has lost   
					the incoming signal.   
					1in8 Test   
					A test pattern consisting of a one (1) followed by seven zeros (on the network   
					only).   
					3000 Series Carrier   
					511 Test   
					A rack-mounted device containing 17 slots in which to place circuit cards.   
					A pseudo-random bit sequence (PRBS) that is 511 bits long (on the data ports   
					9 
					only). This is a PRBS 2 –1 test.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Glossary-9   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					This page intentionally left blank.   
					Glossary-10   
					January 1997   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
				Index   
					BPV (Bipolar Violation) condition   
					
					
					
					A 
					abort   
					lamp test, 4-25   
					
					
					
					
					Activ (Active) configuration area   
					
					
					C 
					cabling   
					
					
					
					Chan (Channel) Configuration branch   
					
					
					option table, C-11–C-14   
					
					channel allocation   
					configuration options, C-11–C-14   
					
					CID (Customer Identification) branch   
					
					addressing. See IP (Internet Protocol) addressing   
					
					AIS (Alarm Indication Signal) condition   
					
					
					
					
					Alarm Configuration branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					CLOCK IN interface   
					alarm messages. See messages, alarm   
					allocation, DS0 channel. See channel allocation   
					
					
					
					
					
					ASCII terminal/printer   
					
					clocking   
					
					
					AUX Port   
					
					
					
					ClrReg (Clear Performance Registers) branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					Cnfig (Configuration) branch. See configuration options   
					
					
					COM Port   
					
					
					B 
					
					
					
					
					used with ASCII terminal/printer, 2-8, 4-9   
					
					B8ZS (Bipolar Eight Zero Substitution) coding   
					
					Self-Test Health message, 4-2   
					backup capability, 3-31   
					
					
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Index-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					community name   
					DTE Configuration branch   
					
					
					
					configuration options   
					
					
					procedure for changing, 3-11–3-14   
					tables   
					DTE Drop/Insert interface   
					
					
					
					
					Channel, C-11–C-14   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					connectors, rear panel   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					E 
					
					Ctrl (Control) branch   
					EER (Excessive Error Rate) condition   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					Cust1 (Customer 1) configuration area   
					
					
					Cust2 (Customer 2) configuration area   
					
					
					
					Embedded Data Link (EDL)   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					error messages. See messages, alarm   
					
					
					D 
					daisy chaining   
					
					connectivity, 1-6, 2-3, 2-4   
					
					data port. See PORT (1–4) interface   
					
					
					
					
					
					DevHS (Device Health and Status) branch   
					
					
					
					DL (Download) branch   
					
					
					DS0 channel allocation. See channel allocation   
					DTE (Drop/Insert) interface. See DTE Drop/Insert   
					interface   
					F 
					Facility Data Link (FDL)   
					
					
					Facility Interface Code, D   
					Facility Interface Codes, D   
					Fact1 (Factory 1) configuration area   
					
					
					Fact2 (Factory 2) configuration area   
					
					
					failure analysis. See troubleshooting   
					failure message   
					during power-up self-test, 2-9, 4-4   
					
					
					Index-2   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				Index   
					
					
					
					
					
					front panel   
					
					
					
					Front Panel Emulation   
					
					
					
					liquid crystal display (LCD)   
					
					
					
					LOF (Loss Of Frame) condition, front panel LED   
					
					
					loopback   
					
					feature number, I-1   
					
					
					
					
					
					G 
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					Gen (General) Configuration branch   
					
					
					
					
					government regulations, Canada, E   
					government requirements, United States, D   
					LOS (Loss Of Signal) condition   
					
					
					
					
					Self-Test Health message, 4-2   
					
					Lpbk (Local Loopback) branch   
					
					
					I 
					ID (Identity) branch   
					
					
					indicators. See LEDs, front panel   
					integral modem, D   
					IP (Internet Protocol) addressing   
					
					
					
					M 
					maintenance   
					
					
					
					
					master clock   
					
					
					
					K 
					L 
					keypad   
					
					
					messages   
					alarm   
					
					
					Self-Test Health, 4-2   
					
					with ASCII terminal/printer, 1-2, 4-9   
					status   
					
					LAN Adapter, 1-2, 1-6, 2-3, 2-4, 3-14, F-1   
					LED Control branch   
					
					
					LED Status branch   
					
					
					LEDs, front panel   
					
					
					Self-Test Health, 2-9, 4-2   
					
					during power-up self-test, 2-9   
					
					
					
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					Index-3   
				ACCULINK 316x DSU/CSU   
					MIBs, SNMP. See SNMP, MIBs   
					
					modem, D   
					MODEM Port   
					
					
					Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP)   
					
					
					PORT (1–4) interface   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					used with ASCII terminal/printer, 4-9   
					
					Mon (Monitor) branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					Port Configuration branch   
					
					
					
					
					power input   
					N 
					NET (Network) Configuration branch   
					
					
					connector, 1-5, 1-6, D-16   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					network interface   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					power-up self-test   
					
					
					
					problem determination. See troubleshooting   
					protocol, link layer, 3-14, 3-16–3-17   
					Ptrns (Test Patterns) branch   
					
					
					O 
					P 
					
					Q 
					R 
					OOF (Out Of Frame) condition   
					
					
					
					
					
					QRSS Test, 4-22   
					options, strap. See configuration options   
					rate   
					
					
					
					
					rear panel   
					
					
					connectors. See connectors, rear panel   
					physical description, 1-5–1-7   
					Rel (Release) branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					PDV (Pulse Density Violation) condition, 3-6   
					Perf (Performance Report) branch   
					
					
					
					Index-4   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
				Index   
					reset   
					
					
					Reset branch   
					
					
					Rlpbk (Remote Loopback) branch   
					
					
					T 
					T1   
					line, D   
					network, connection, D   
					
					Test branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					S 
					self-test   
					
					
					
					
					
					Serial Line Internet Protocol (SLIP)   
					
					
					
					Shared Diagnostic Control Panel (SDCP)   
					
					
					
					test jacks   
					
					
					timing. See clocking   
					traps, SNMP. See SNMP, traps   
					troubleshooting   
					SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol)   
					
					
					diagnostic table, 4-11–4-12   
					
					configuration options   
					
					
					
					
					TStat (Test Status) branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					manager, 1-2   
					MIBs   
					U 
					
					User Configuration branch   
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					
					traps   
					
					
					
					
					
					Stat (Status) branch   
					V 
					
					
					
					V.54 Loop 2. See data channel loopback (DCLB)   
					V.54 Loop 3. See data terminal loopback (DTLB)   
					status messages. See messages, status   
					STest (Self-Test Health) branch   
					
					
					
					straps. See configuration options   
					
					synchronous data port. See PORT (1–4) interface   
					W 
					
					
					
					3160-A2-GB21-50   
					January 1997   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					Index-5   
				 |